blob: 367a4d7af546331e0c8f45f79059170e45f7986d [file] [log] [blame]
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00001//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00003// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
4//
Chris Lattner4ee451d2007-12-29 20:36:04 +00005// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
6// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00007//
John Criswellb576c942003-10-20 19:43:21 +00008//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009//
10// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +000011// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
12// algebraic simplification happens.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013//
14// This pass combines things like:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000015// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
16// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000017// into:
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +000018// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000019//
20// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
21//
Chris Lattner065a6162003-09-10 05:29:43 +000022// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000023// the program:
24// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +000025// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
26// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000027// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
28// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +000029// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
30// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
31// shifts.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000032// ... etc.
Chris Lattner2cd91962003-07-23 21:41:57 +000033//
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000034//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
35
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000036#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
Chris Lattner022103b2002-05-07 20:03:00 +000037#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000038#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000039#include "llvm/LLVMContext.h"
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000040#include "llvm/Pass.h"
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000041#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000042#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +000043#include "llvm/Operator.h"
Chris Lattner79066fa2007-01-30 23:46:24 +000044#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +000045#include "llvm/Analysis/ValueTracking.h"
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000046#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
47#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
48#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000049#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +000050#include "llvm/Support/ConstantRange.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000051#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
Torok Edwin7d696d82009-07-11 13:10:19 +000052#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000053#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000054#include "llvm/Support/InstVisitor.h"
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +000055#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000056#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
Chris Lattnera4f0b3a2006-08-27 12:54:02 +000057#include "llvm/Support/Compiler.h"
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000058#include "llvm/ADT/DenseMap.h"
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000059#include "llvm/ADT/SmallVector.h"
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000060#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
Reid Spencer551ccae2004-09-01 22:55:40 +000061#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000062#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000063#include <algorithm>
Torok Edwin3eaee312008-04-20 08:33:11 +000064#include <climits>
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000065#include <sstream>
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000066using namespace llvm;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000067using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
Brian Gaeked0fde302003-11-11 22:41:34 +000068
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000069STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
70STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
71STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
72STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
73STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
Chris Lattnera92f6962002-10-01 22:38:41 +000074
Chris Lattner0e5f4992006-12-19 21:40:18 +000075namespace {
Chris Lattnerf4b54612006-06-28 22:08:15 +000076 class VISIBILITY_HIDDEN InstCombiner
77 : public FunctionPass,
78 public InstVisitor<InstCombiner, Instruction*> {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000079 // Worklist of all of the instructions that need to be simplified.
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000080 SmallVector<Instruction*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000081 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned> WorklistMap;
Chris Lattnerbc61e662003-11-02 05:57:39 +000082 TargetData *TD;
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000083 bool MustPreserveLCSSA;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000084 public:
Nick Lewyckyecd94c82007-05-06 13:37:16 +000085 static char ID; // Pass identification, replacement for typeid
Dan Gohmanae73dc12008-09-04 17:05:41 +000086 InstCombiner() : FunctionPass(&ID) {}
Devang Patel794fd752007-05-01 21:15:47 +000087
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +000088 LLVMContext *Context;
89 LLVMContext *getContext() const { return Context; }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000090
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000091 /// AddToWorkList - Add the specified instruction to the worklist if it
92 /// isn't already in it.
93 void AddToWorkList(Instruction *I) {
Dan Gohman6b345ee2008-07-07 17:46:23 +000094 if (WorklistMap.insert(std::make_pair(I, Worklist.size())).second)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000095 Worklist.push_back(I);
96 }
97
98 // RemoveFromWorkList - remove I from the worklist if it exists.
99 void RemoveFromWorkList(Instruction *I) {
100 DenseMap<Instruction*, unsigned>::iterator It = WorklistMap.find(I);
101 if (It == WorklistMap.end()) return; // Not in worklist.
102
103 // Don't bother moving everything down, just null out the slot.
104 Worklist[It->second] = 0;
105
106 WorklistMap.erase(It);
107 }
108
109 Instruction *RemoveOneFromWorkList() {
110 Instruction *I = Worklist.back();
111 Worklist.pop_back();
112 WorklistMap.erase(I);
113 return I;
114 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000115
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000116
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000117 /// AddUsersToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add all users of
118 /// the instruction to the work lists because they might get more simplified
119 /// now.
120 ///
Chris Lattner6dce1a72006-02-07 06:56:34 +0000121 void AddUsersToWorkList(Value &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000122 for (Value::use_iterator UI = I.use_begin(), UE = I.use_end();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000123 UI != UE; ++UI)
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000124 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(*UI));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000125 }
126
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000127 /// AddUsesToWorkList - When an instruction is simplified, add operands to
128 /// the work lists because they might get more simplified now.
129 ///
130 void AddUsesToWorkList(Instruction &I) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000131 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
132 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000133 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000134 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000135
136 /// AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist - The specified instruction is about to become
137 /// dead. Add all of its operands to the worklist, turning them into
138 /// undef's to reduce the number of uses of those instructions.
139 ///
140 /// Return the specified operand before it is turned into an undef.
141 ///
142 Value *AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(Instruction &I, unsigned op) {
143 Value *R = I.getOperand(op);
144
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +0000145 for (User::op_iterator i = I.op_begin(), e = I.op_end(); i != e; ++i)
146 if (Instruction *Op = dyn_cast<Instruction>(*i)) {
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000147 AddToWorkList(Op);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000148 // Set the operand to undef to drop the use.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000149 *i = Context->getUndef(Op->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000150 }
151
152 return R;
153 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000154
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000155 public:
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000156 virtual bool runOnFunction(Function &F);
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +0000157
158 bool DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned ItNum);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000159
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000160 virtual void getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +0000161 AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
Chris Lattnercb2610e2002-10-21 20:00:28 +0000162 AU.setPreservesCFG();
Chris Lattner97e52e42002-04-28 21:27:06 +0000163 }
164
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000165 TargetData *getTargetData() const { return TD; }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000166
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000167 // Visitation implementation - Implement instruction combining for different
168 // instruction types. The semantics are as follows:
169 // Return Value:
170 // null - No change was made
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +0000171 // I - Change was made, I is still valid, I may be dead though
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000172 // otherwise - Change was made, replace I with returned instruction
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000173 //
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000174 Instruction *visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000175 Instruction *visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000176 Instruction *visitSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000177 Instruction *visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000178 Instruction *visitMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000179 Instruction *visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000180 Instruction *visitURem(BinaryOperator &I);
181 Instruction *visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I);
182 Instruction *visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +0000183 bool SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +0000184 Instruction *commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
185 Instruction *commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +0000186 Instruction *commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
187 Instruction *commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
188 Instruction *visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
189 Instruction *visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
190 Instruction *visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +0000191 Instruction *FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +0000192 Instruction *FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000193 Instruction *visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +0000194 Instruction *FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I, ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS);
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +0000195 Instruction *FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS, FCmpInst *RHS);
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +0000196 Instruction *FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +0000197 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000198 Instruction *visitOr (BinaryOperator &I);
199 Instruction *visitXor(BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000200 Instruction *visitShl(BinaryOperator &I);
201 Instruction *visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I);
202 Instruction *visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I);
203 Instruction *commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +0000204 Instruction *FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I, Instruction *LHSI,
205 Constant *RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000206 Instruction *visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I);
207 Instruction *visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I);
208 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +0000209 Instruction *visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
210 Instruction *LHS,
211 ConstantInt *RHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +0000212 Instruction *FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
213 ConstantInt *DivRHS);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +0000214
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000215 Instruction *FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
216 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond, Instruction &I);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +0000217 Instruction *FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +0000218 BinaryOperator &I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000219 Instruction *commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
220 Instruction *commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000221 Instruction *commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +0000222 Instruction *visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI);
223 Instruction *visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI);
224 Instruction *visitSExt(SExtInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +0000225 Instruction *visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000226 Instruction *visitFPExt(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +0000227 Instruction *visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI);
228 Instruction *visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000229 Instruction *visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI);
230 Instruction *visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000231 Instruction *visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +0000232 Instruction *visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000233 Instruction *visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +0000234 Instruction *FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
235 Instruction *FI);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +0000236 Instruction *FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value*, Value*);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +0000237 Instruction *visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI);
238 Instruction *visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI, ICmpInst *ICI);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000239 Instruction *visitCallInst(CallInst &CI);
240 Instruction *visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000241 Instruction *visitPHINode(PHINode &PN);
242 Instruction *visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +0000243 Instruction *visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +0000244 Instruction *visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI);
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +0000245 Instruction *visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +0000246 Instruction *visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +0000247 Instruction *visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +0000248 Instruction *visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +0000249 Instruction *visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +0000250 Instruction *visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +0000251 Instruction *visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000252 Instruction *visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000253
254 // visitInstruction - Specify what to return for unhandled instructions...
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +0000255 Instruction *visitInstruction(Instruction &I) { return 0; }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000256
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000257 private:
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +0000258 Instruction *visitCallSite(CallSite CS);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000259 bool transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +0000260 Instruction *transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +0000261 Instruction *transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
262 bool DoXform = true);
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +0000263 bool WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS);
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +0000264 DbgDeclareInst *hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V);
265
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +0000266
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +0000267 public:
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000268 // InsertNewInstBefore - insert an instruction New before instruction Old
269 // in the program. Add the new instruction to the worklist.
270 //
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000271 Instruction *InsertNewInstBefore(Instruction *New, Instruction &Old) {
Chris Lattnere6f9a912002-08-23 18:32:43 +0000272 assert(New && New->getParent() == 0 &&
273 "New instruction already inserted into a basic block!");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000274 BasicBlock *BB = Old.getParent();
275 BB->getInstList().insert(&Old, New); // Insert inst
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000276 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000277 return New;
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000278 }
279
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000280 /// InsertCastBefore - Insert a cast of V to TY before the instruction POS.
281 /// This also adds the cast to the worklist. Finally, this returns the
282 /// cast.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +0000283 Value *InsertCastBefore(Instruction::CastOps opc, Value *V, const Type *Ty,
284 Instruction &Pos) {
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000285 if (V->getType() == Ty) return V;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000286
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000287 if (Constant *CV = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000288 return Context->getConstantExprCast(opc, CV, Ty);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +0000289
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000290 Instruction *C = CastInst::Create(opc, V, Ty, V->getName(), &Pos);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000291 AddToWorkList(C);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000292 return C;
293 }
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +0000294
295 Value *InsertBitCastBefore(Value *V, const Type *Ty, Instruction &Pos) {
296 return InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, V, Ty, Pos);
297 }
298
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +0000299
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000300 // ReplaceInstUsesWith - This method is to be used when an instruction is
301 // found to be dead, replacable with another preexisting expression. Here
302 // we add all uses of I to the worklist, replace all uses of I with the new
303 // value, then return I, so that the inst combiner will know that I was
304 // modified.
305 //
306 Instruction *ReplaceInstUsesWith(Instruction &I, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000307 AddUsersToWorkList(I); // Add all modified instrs to worklist
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000308 if (&I != V) {
309 I.replaceAllUsesWith(V);
310 return &I;
311 } else {
312 // If we are replacing the instruction with itself, this must be in a
313 // segment of unreachable code, so just clobber the instruction.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000314 I.replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getUndef(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +0000315 return &I;
316 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +0000317 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000318
319 // EraseInstFromFunction - When dealing with an instruction that has side
320 // effects or produces a void value, we can't rely on DCE to delete the
321 // instruction. Instead, visit methods should return the value returned by
322 // this function.
323 Instruction *EraseInstFromFunction(Instruction &I) {
324 assert(I.use_empty() && "Cannot erase instruction that is used!");
325 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000326 RemoveFromWorkList(&I);
Chris Lattner954f66a2004-11-18 21:41:39 +0000327 I.eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000328 return 0; // Don't do anything with FI
329 }
Chris Lattner173234a2008-06-02 01:18:21 +0000330
331 void ComputeMaskedBits(Value *V, const APInt &Mask, APInt &KnownZero,
332 APInt &KnownOne, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
333 return llvm::ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne, TD, Depth);
334 }
335
336 bool MaskedValueIsZero(Value *V, const APInt &Mask,
337 unsigned Depth = 0) const {
338 return llvm::MaskedValueIsZero(V, Mask, TD, Depth);
339 }
340 unsigned ComputeNumSignBits(Value *Op, unsigned Depth = 0) const {
341 return llvm::ComputeNumSignBits(Op, TD, Depth);
342 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +0000343
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +0000344 private:
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +0000345
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000346 /// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for
347 /// commutative operators.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000348 bool SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +0000349
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000350 /// SimplifyCompare - This reorders the operands of a CmpInst to get them in
351 /// most-complex to least-complex order.
352 bool SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I);
353
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000354 /// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - Attempts to replace V with a simpler value
355 /// based on the demanded bits.
356 Value *SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
357 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
358 unsigned Depth);
359 bool SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000360 APInt& KnownZero, APInt& KnownOne,
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000361 unsigned Depth=0);
362
363 /// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
364 /// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
365 /// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
366 bool SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst);
367
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +0000368 Value *SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
369 APInt& UndefElts, unsigned Depth = 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +0000370
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +0000371 // FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a
372 // PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI
373 // (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
374 Instruction *FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I);
375
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +0000376 // FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
377 // operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
378 // inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
379 Instruction *FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000380 Instruction *FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +0000381 Instruction *FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN);
382
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +0000383
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000384 Instruction *OptAndOp(Instruction *Op, ConstantInt *OpRHS,
385 ConstantInt *AndRHS, BinaryOperator &TheAnd);
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000386
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000387 Value *FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS, ConstantInt *Mask,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +0000388 bool isSub, Instruction &I);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +0000389 Instruction *InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000390 bool isSigned, bool Inside, Instruction &IB);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +0000391 Instruction *PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI, AllocationInst &AI);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000392 Instruction *MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +0000393 bool SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000394 Instruction *SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +0000395 Instruction *SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI);
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +0000396
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +0000397
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +0000398 Value *EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty, bool isSigned);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000399
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000400 bool CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +0000401 unsigned CastOpc, int &NumCastsRemoved);
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +0000402 unsigned GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
403 unsigned PrefAlign = 0);
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +0000404
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000405 };
406}
407
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +0000408char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
409static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
410X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
411
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000412// getComplexity: Assign a complexity or rank value to LLVM Values...
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000413// 0 -> undef, 1 -> Const, 2 -> Other, 3 -> Arg, 3 -> Unary, 4 -> OtherInst
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +0000414static unsigned getComplexity(LLVMContext *Context, Value *V) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000415 if (isa<Instruction>(V)) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000416 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V) ||
417 BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V) ||
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000418 BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000419 return 3;
420 return 4;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000421 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +0000422 if (isa<Argument>(V)) return 3;
423 return isa<Constant>(V) ? (isa<UndefValue>(V) ? 0 : 1) : 2;
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000424}
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000425
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000426// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
427// it.
428static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +0000429 return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000430}
431
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000432// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
433// though a va_arg area...
434static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000435 if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
436 if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
437 return Type::Int32Ty;
Chris Lattner2b7e0ad2007-05-23 01:17:04 +0000438 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +0000439 return Ty;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +0000440}
441
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000442/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
443/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
444/// operand value, otherwise return null.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000445static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
Dan Gohman016de812009-07-17 23:55:56 +0000446 if (Operator *O = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
447 if (O->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
448 return O->getOperand(0);
449 if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(V))
450 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
451 return GEP->getPointerOperand();
Matthijs Kooijman7e6d9b92008-10-13 15:17:01 +0000452 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +0000453 return 0;
454}
455
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000456/// This function is a wrapper around CastInst::isEliminableCastPair. It
457/// simply extracts arguments and returns what that function returns.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000458static Instruction::CastOps
459isEliminableCastPair(
460 const CastInst *CI, ///< The first cast instruction
461 unsigned opcode, ///< The opcode of the second cast instruction
462 const Type *DstTy, ///< The target type for the second cast instruction
463 TargetData *TD ///< The target data for pointer size
464) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000465
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000466 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType(); // A from above
467 const Type *MidTy = CI->getType(); // B from above
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000468
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +0000469 // Get the opcodes of the two Cast instructions
470 Instruction::CastOps firstOp = Instruction::CastOps(CI->getOpcode());
471 Instruction::CastOps secondOp = Instruction::CastOps(opcode);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000472
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000473 unsigned Res = CastInst::isEliminableCastPair(firstOp, secondOp, SrcTy, MidTy,
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000474 DstTy,
475 TD ? TD->getIntPtrType() : 0);
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +0000476
477 // We don't want to form an inttoptr or ptrtoint that converts to an integer
478 // type that differs from the pointer size.
479 if ((Res == Instruction::IntToPtr && SrcTy != TD->getIntPtrType()) ||
480 (Res == Instruction::PtrToInt && DstTy != TD->getIntPtrType()))
481 Res = 0;
482
483 return Instruction::CastOps(Res);
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000484}
485
486/// ValueRequiresCast - Return true if the cast from "V to Ty" actually results
487/// in any code being generated. It does not require codegen if V is simple
488/// enough or if the cast can be folded into other casts.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000489static bool ValueRequiresCast(Instruction::CastOps opcode, const Value *V,
490 const Type *Ty, TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000491 if (V->getType() == Ty || isa<Constant>(V)) return false;
492
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +0000493 // If this is another cast that can be eliminated, it isn't codegen either.
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000494 if (const CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(V))
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +0000495 if (isEliminableCastPair(CI, opcode, Ty, TD))
Chris Lattner33a61132006-05-06 09:00:16 +0000496 return false;
497 return true;
498}
499
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000500// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
501// operators:
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000502//
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000503// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
504// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
505// binary operators.
506//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000507// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
508// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000509//
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000510bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000511 bool Changed = false;
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +0000512 if (getComplexity(Context, I.getOperand(0)) <
513 getComplexity(Context, I.getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000514 Changed = !I.swapOperands();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000515
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000516 if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
517 Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000518 if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
519 if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
520 if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000521 Constant *Folded = Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a9c8472003-05-27 16:40:51 +0000522 cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
523 cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000524 I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
525 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
526 return true;
527 } else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
528 if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
529 isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
530 Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
531 Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
532
533 // Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000534 Constant *Folded = Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +0000535 Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000536 Op1->getOperand(0),
537 Op1->getName(), &I);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +0000538 AddToWorkList(New);
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000539 I.setOperand(0, New);
540 I.setOperand(1, Folded);
541 return true;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +0000542 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000543 }
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +0000544 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +0000545}
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +0000546
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000547/// SimplifyCompare - For a CmpInst this function just orders the operands
548/// so that theyare listed from right (least complex) to left (most complex).
549/// This puts constants before unary operators before binary operators.
550bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCompare(CmpInst &I) {
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +0000551 if (getComplexity(Context, I.getOperand(0)) >=
552 getComplexity(Context, I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +0000553 return false;
554 I.swapOperands();
555 // Compare instructions are not associative so there's nothing else we can do.
556 return true;
557}
558
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000559// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
560// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000561//
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000562static inline Value *dyn_castNegVal(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000563 if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000564 return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000565
Chris Lattner0ce85802004-12-14 20:08:06 +0000566 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
567 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000568 return Context->getConstantExprNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000569
570 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
571 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000572 return Context->getConstantExprNeg(C);
Nick Lewycky18b3da62008-05-23 04:54:45 +0000573
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000574 return 0;
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +0000575}
576
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000577// dyn_castFNegVal - Given a 'fsub' instruction, return the RHS of the
578// instruction if the LHS is a constant negative zero (which is the 'negate'
579// form).
580//
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000581static inline Value *dyn_castFNegVal(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersonfa82b6e2009-07-13 22:18:28 +0000582 if (BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000583 return BinaryOperator::getFNegArgument(V);
584
585 // Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
586 if (ConstantFP *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000587 return Context->getConstantExprFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000588
589 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
590 if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isFloatingPoint())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000591 return Context->getConstantExprFNeg(C);
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +0000592
593 return 0;
594}
595
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000596static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000597 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +0000598 return BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000599
600 // Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +0000601 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000602 return Context->getConstantInt(~C->getValue());
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +0000603 return 0;
604}
605
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000606// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
607// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000608// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
609// Otherwise, return null.
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000610//
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000611static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000612 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +0000613 if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000614 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000615 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000616 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000617 return I->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000618 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Chris Lattner50e60c72004-11-15 05:54:07 +0000619 if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000620 // The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +0000621 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +0000622 uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000623 CST = Context->getConstantInt(APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +0000624 return I->getOperand(0);
625 }
626 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +0000627 return 0;
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +0000628}
Chris Lattneraf2930e2002-08-14 17:51:49 +0000629
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +0000630/// dyn_castGetElementPtr - If this is a getelementptr instruction or constant
631/// expression, return it.
632static User *dyn_castGetElementPtr(Value *V) {
633 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(V)) return cast<User>(V);
634 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(V))
635 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr)
636 return cast<User>(V);
637 return false;
638}
639
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000640/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000641static Constant *AddOne(Constant *C, LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000642 return Context->getConstantExprAdd(C,
643 Context->getConstantInt(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000644}
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +0000645/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000646static Constant *SubOne(ConstantInt *C, LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000647 return Context->getConstantExprSub(C,
648 Context->getConstantInt(C->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000649}
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000650/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
651/// this size.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000652static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000653 LLVMContext *Context) {
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +0000654 uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
655 APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
656 if (sign) {
657 LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
658 RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
659 } else {
660 LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
661 RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
662 }
663
664 APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
665
666 if (sign) {
667 APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
668 APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
669 return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
670 } else
671 return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
672}
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +0000673
Reid Spencere7816b52007-03-08 01:52:58 +0000674
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000675/// ShrinkDemandedConstant - Check to see if the specified operand of the
676/// specified instruction is a constant integer. If so, check to see if there
677/// are any bits set in the constant that are not demanded. If so, shrink the
678/// constant and return true.
679static bool ShrinkDemandedConstant(Instruction *I, unsigned OpNo,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +0000680 APInt Demanded, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000681 assert(I && "No instruction?");
682 assert(OpNo < I->getNumOperands() && "Operand index too large");
683
684 // If the operand is not a constant integer, nothing to do.
685 ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(OpNo));
686 if (!OpC) return false;
687
688 // If there are no bits set that aren't demanded, nothing to do.
689 Demanded.zextOrTrunc(OpC->getValue().getBitWidth());
690 if ((~Demanded & OpC->getValue()) == 0)
691 return false;
692
693 // This instruction is producing bits that are not demanded. Shrink the RHS.
694 Demanded &= OpC->getValue();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000695 I->setOperand(OpNo, Context->getConstantInt(Demanded));
Reid Spencer6b79e2d2007-03-12 17:15:10 +0000696 return true;
697}
698
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000699// ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given a signed integer type and a
700// set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
701// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
702// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000703static void ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt& KnownZero,
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000704 const APInt& KnownOne,
705 APInt& Min, APInt& Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000706 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
707 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
708 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
709 "KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000710 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000711
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000712 // The minimum value is when all unknown bits are zeros, EXCEPT for the sign
713 // bit if it is unknown.
714 Min = KnownOne;
715 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
716
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000717 if (UnknownBits.isNegative()) { // Sign bit is unknown
718 Min.set(Min.getBitWidth()-1);
719 Max.clear(Max.getBitWidth()-1);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000720 }
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000721}
722
723// ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits - Given an unsigned integer type and
724// a set of known zero and one bits, compute the maximum and minimum values that
725// could have the specified known zero and known one bits, returning them in
726// min/max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000727static void ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(const APInt &KnownZero,
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +0000728 const APInt &KnownOne,
729 APInt &Min, APInt &Max) {
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000730 assert(KnownZero.getBitWidth() == KnownOne.getBitWidth() &&
731 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Min.getBitWidth() &&
732 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == Max.getBitWidth() &&
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +0000733 "Ty, KnownZero, KnownOne and Min, Max must have equal bitwidth.");
Reid Spencer2f549172007-03-25 04:26:16 +0000734 APInt UnknownBits = ~(KnownZero|KnownOne);
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +0000735
736 // The minimum value is when the unknown bits are all zeros.
737 Min = KnownOne;
738 // The maximum value is when the unknown bits are all ones.
739 Max = KnownOne|UnknownBits;
740}
Chris Lattner255d8912006-02-11 09:31:47 +0000741
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000742/// SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits - Inst is an integer instruction that
743/// SimplifyDemandedBits knows about. See if the instruction has any
744/// properties that allow us to simplify its operands.
745bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(Instruction &Inst) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000746 unsigned BitWidth = Inst.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000747 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
748 APInt DemandedMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
749
750 Value *V = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(&Inst, DemandedMask,
751 KnownZero, KnownOne, 0);
752 if (V == 0) return false;
753 if (V == &Inst) return true;
754 ReplaceInstUsesWith(Inst, V);
755 return true;
756}
757
758/// SimplifyDemandedBits - This form of SimplifyDemandedBits simplifies the
759/// specified instruction operand if possible, updating it in place. It returns
760/// true if it made any change and false otherwise.
761bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedBits(Use &U, APInt DemandedMask,
762 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
763 unsigned Depth) {
764 Value *NewVal = SimplifyDemandedUseBits(U.get(), DemandedMask,
765 KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
766 if (NewVal == 0) return false;
767 U.set(NewVal);
768 return true;
769}
770
771
772/// SimplifyDemandedUseBits - This function attempts to replace V with a simpler
773/// value based on the demanded bits. When this function is called, it is known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000774/// that only the bits set in DemandedMask of the result of V are ever used
775/// downstream. Consequently, depending on the mask and V, it may be possible
776/// to replace V with a constant or one of its operands. In such cases, this
777/// function does the replacement and returns true. In all other cases, it
778/// returns false after analyzing the expression and setting KnownOne and known
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000779/// to be one in the expression. KnownZero contains all the bits that are known
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000780/// to be zero in the expression. These are provided to potentially allow the
781/// caller (which might recursively be SimplifyDemandedBits itself) to simplify
782/// the expression. KnownOne and KnownZero always follow the invariant that
783/// KnownOne & KnownZero == 0. That is, a bit can't be both 1 and 0. Note that
784/// the bits in KnownOne and KnownZero may only be accurate for those bits set
785/// in DemandedMask. Note also that the bitwidth of V, DemandedMask, KnownZero
786/// and KnownOne must all be the same.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000787///
788/// This returns null if it did not change anything and it permits no
789/// simplification. This returns V itself if it did some simplification of V's
790/// operands based on the information about what bits are demanded. This returns
791/// some other non-null value if it found out that V is equal to another value
792/// in the context where the specified bits are demanded, but not for all users.
793Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedUseBits(Value *V, APInt DemandedMask,
794 APInt &KnownZero, APInt &KnownOne,
795 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000796 assert(V != 0 && "Null pointer of Value???");
797 assert(Depth <= 6 && "Limit Search Depth");
798 uint32_t BitWidth = DemandedMask.getBitWidth();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000799 const Type *VTy = V->getType();
800 assert((TD || !isa<PointerType>(VTy)) &&
801 "SimplifyDemandedBits needs to know bit widths!");
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000802 assert((!TD || TD->getTypeSizeInBits(VTy->getScalarType()) == BitWidth) &&
803 (!VTy->isIntOrIntVector() ||
804 VTy->getScalarSizeInBits() == BitWidth) &&
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000805 KnownZero.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000806 KnownOne.getBitWidth() == BitWidth &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +0000807 "Value *V, DemandedMask, KnownZero and KnownOne "
808 "must have same BitWidth");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000809 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V)) {
810 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
811 KnownOne = CI->getValue() & DemandedMask;
812 KnownZero = ~KnownOne & DemandedMask;
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000813 return 0;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000814 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000815 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(V)) {
816 // We know all of the bits for a constant!
817 KnownOne.clear();
818 KnownZero = DemandedMask;
819 return 0;
820 }
821
Chris Lattner08d2cc72009-01-31 07:26:06 +0000822 KnownZero.clear();
Zhou Sheng96704452007-03-14 03:21:24 +0000823 KnownOne.clear();
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000824 if (DemandedMask == 0) { // Not demanding any bits from V.
825 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
826 return 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000827 return Context->getUndef(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000828 }
829
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000830 if (Depth == 6) // Limit search depth.
831 return 0;
832
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000833 APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0), LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
834 APInt &RHSKnownZero = KnownZero, &RHSKnownOne = KnownOne;
835
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +0000836 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
837 if (!I) {
838 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
839 return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
840 }
841
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000842 // If there are multiple uses of this value and we aren't at the root, then
843 // we can't do any simplifications of the operands, because DemandedMask
844 // only reflects the bits demanded by *one* of the users.
845 if (Depth != 0 && !I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000846 // Despite the fact that we can't simplify this instruction in all User's
847 // context, we can at least compute the knownzero/knownone bits, and we can
848 // do simplifications that apply to *just* the one user if we know that
849 // this instruction has a simpler value in that context.
850 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
851 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
852 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
853 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
854 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
855 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
856
857 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
858 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and' in this
859 // context.
860 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
861 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
862 return I->getOperand(0);
863 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
864 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
865 return I->getOperand(1);
866
867 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
868 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000869 return Context->getNullValue(VTy);
Chris Lattnerd1b5e3f2009-01-31 08:40:03 +0000870
871 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
872 // We can simplify (X|Y) -> X or Y in the user's context if we know that
873 // only bits from X or Y are demanded.
874
875 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
876 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(1), DemandedMask,
877 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
878 ComputeMaskedBits(I->getOperand(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
879 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1);
880
881 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the
882 // other. These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or' in this
883 // context.
884 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
885 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
886 return I->getOperand(0);
887 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
888 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
889 return I->getOperand(1);
890
891 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
892 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
893 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
894 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
895 return I->getOperand(0);
896 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
897 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
898 return I->getOperand(1);
899 }
900
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +0000901 // Compute the KnownZero/KnownOne bits to simplify things downstream.
902 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, KnownZero, KnownOne, Depth);
903 return 0;
904 }
905
906 // If this is the root being simplified, allow it to have multiple uses,
907 // just set the DemandedMask to all bits so that we can try to simplify the
908 // operands. This allows visitTruncInst (for example) to simplify the
909 // operand of a trunc without duplicating all the logic below.
910 if (Depth == 0 && !V->hasOneUse())
911 DemandedMask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
912
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000913 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000914 default:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000915 ComputeMaskedBits(I, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +0000916 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000917 case Instruction::And:
918 // If either the LHS or the RHS are Zero, the result is zero.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000919 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
920 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
921 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000922 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000923 return I;
924 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
925 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000926
927 // If all of the demanded bits are known 1 on one side, return the other.
928 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'and'.
929 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) ==
930 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000931 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000932 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) ==
933 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000934 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000935
936 // If all of the demanded bits in the inputs are known zeros, return zero.
937 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|LHSKnownZero)) == DemandedMask)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000938 return Context->getNullValue(VTy);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000939
940 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000941 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownZero, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000942 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000943
944 // Output known-1 bits are only known if set in both the LHS & RHS.
945 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
946 // Output known-0 are known to be clear if zero in either the LHS | RHS.
947 RHSKnownZero |= LHSKnownZero;
948 break;
949 case Instruction::Or:
950 // If either the LHS or the RHS are One, the result is One.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000951 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
952 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
953 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000954 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000955 return I;
956 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
957 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000958
959 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
960 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'or'.
961 if ((DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne & RHSKnownZero) ==
962 (DemandedMask & ~LHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000963 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000964 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero) ==
965 (DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownOne))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000966 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000967
968 // If all of the potentially set bits on one side are known to be set on
969 // the other side, just use the 'other' side.
970 if ((DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero) & LHSKnownOne) ==
971 (DemandedMask & (~RHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000972 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000973 if ((DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero) & RHSKnownOne) ==
974 (DemandedMask & (~LHSKnownZero)))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000975 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000976
977 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +0000978 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000979 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000980
981 // Output known-0 bits are only known if clear in both the LHS & RHS.
982 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
983 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in either the LHS | RHS.
984 RHSKnownOne |= LHSKnownOne;
985 break;
986 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000987 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
988 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
989 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000990 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000991 return I;
992 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
993 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000994
995 // If all of the demanded bits are known zero on one side, return the other.
996 // These bits cannot contribute to the result of the 'xor'.
997 if ((DemandedMask & RHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +0000998 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +0000999 if ((DemandedMask & LHSKnownZero) == DemandedMask)
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001000 return I->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001001
1002 // Output known-0 bits are known if clear or set in both the LHS & RHS.
1003 APInt KnownZeroOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownZero) |
1004 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne);
1005 // Output known-1 are known to be set if set in only one of the LHS, RHS.
1006 APInt KnownOneOut = (RHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) |
1007 (RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownZero);
1008
1009 // If all of the demanded bits are known to be zero on one side or the
1010 // other, turn this into an *inclusive* or.
1011 // e.g. (A & C1)^(B & C2) -> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
1012 if ((DemandedMask & ~RHSKnownZero & ~LHSKnownZero) == 0) {
1013 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001014 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001015 I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001016 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001017 }
1018
1019 // If all of the demanded bits on one side are known, and all of the set
1020 // bits on that side are also known to be set on the other side, turn this
1021 // into an AND, as we know the bits will be cleared.
1022 // e.g. (X | C1) ^ C2 --> (X | C1) & ~C2 iff (C1&C2) == C2
1023 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
1024 // all known
1025 if ((RHSKnownOne & LHSKnownOne) == RHSKnownOne) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001026 Constant *AndC = Context->getConstantInt(~RHSKnownOne & DemandedMask);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001027 Instruction *And =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001028 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(I->getOperand(0), AndC, "tmp");
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001029 return InsertNewInstBefore(And, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001030 }
1031 }
1032
1033 // If the RHS is a constant, see if we can simplify it.
1034 // FIXME: for XOR, we prefer to force bits to 1 if they will make a -1.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001035 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001036 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001037
1038 RHSKnownZero = KnownZeroOut;
1039 RHSKnownOne = KnownOneOut;
1040 break;
1041 }
1042 case Instruction::Select:
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001043 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(2), DemandedMask,
1044 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1045 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001046 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001047 return I;
1048 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
1049 assert(!(LHSKnownZero & LHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001050
1051 // If the operands are constants, see if we can simplify them.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001052 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, DemandedMask, Context) ||
1053 ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 2, DemandedMask, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001054 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001055
1056 // Only known if known in both the LHS and RHS.
1057 RHSKnownOne &= LHSKnownOne;
1058 RHSKnownZero &= LHSKnownZero;
1059 break;
1060 case Instruction::Trunc: {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001061 unsigned truncBf = I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001062 DemandedMask.zext(truncBf);
1063 RHSKnownZero.zext(truncBf);
1064 RHSKnownOne.zext(truncBf);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001065 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001066 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001067 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001068 DemandedMask.trunc(BitWidth);
1069 RHSKnownZero.trunc(BitWidth);
1070 RHSKnownOne.trunc(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001071 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001072 break;
1073 }
1074 case Instruction::BitCast:
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001075 if (!I->getOperand(0)->getType()->isIntOrIntVector())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001076 return false; // vector->int or fp->int?
Dan Gohman6cc18fe2009-07-01 21:38:46 +00001077
1078 if (const VectorType *DstVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getType())) {
1079 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy =
1080 dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())) {
1081 if (DstVTy->getNumElements() != SrcVTy->getNumElements())
1082 // Don't touch a bitcast between vectors of different element counts.
1083 return false;
1084 } else
1085 // Don't touch a scalar-to-vector bitcast.
1086 return false;
1087 } else if (isa<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType()))
1088 // Don't touch a vector-to-scalar bitcast.
1089 return false;
1090
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001091 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001092 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001093 return I;
1094 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001095 break;
1096 case Instruction::ZExt: {
1097 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001098 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001099
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001100 DemandedMask.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1101 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1102 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001103 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMask,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001104 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001105 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001106 DemandedMask.zext(BitWidth);
1107 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1108 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001109 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001110 // The top bits are known to be zero.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001111 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001112 break;
1113 }
1114 case Instruction::SExt: {
1115 // Compute the bits in the result that are not present in the input.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00001116 unsigned SrcBitWidth =I->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001117
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001118 APInt InputDemandedBits = DemandedMask &
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001119 APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, SrcBitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001120
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001121 APInt NewBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - SrcBitWidth));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001122 // If any of the sign extended bits are demanded, we know that the sign
1123 // bit is demanded.
1124 if ((NewBits & DemandedMask) != 0)
Zhou Sheng4a1822a2007-04-02 13:45:30 +00001125 InputDemandedBits.set(SrcBitWidth-1);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001126
Zhou Shengd48653a2007-03-29 04:45:55 +00001127 InputDemandedBits.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1128 RHSKnownZero.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
1129 RHSKnownOne.trunc(SrcBitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001130 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InputDemandedBits,
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001131 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001132 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001133 InputDemandedBits.zext(BitWidth);
1134 RHSKnownZero.zext(BitWidth);
1135 RHSKnownOne.zext(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001136 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001137
1138 // If the sign bit of the input is known set or clear, then we know the
1139 // top bits of the result.
1140
1141 // If the input sign bit is known zero, or if the NewBits are not demanded
1142 // convert this into a zero extension.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001143 if (RHSKnownZero[SrcBitWidth-1] || (NewBits & ~DemandedMask) == NewBits) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001144 // Convert to ZExt cast
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001145 CastInst *NewCast = new ZExtInst(I->getOperand(0), VTy, I->getName());
1146 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *I);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001147 } else if (RHSKnownOne[SrcBitWidth-1]) { // Input sign bit known set
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001148 RHSKnownOne |= NewBits;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001149 }
1150 break;
1151 }
1152 case Instruction::Add: {
1153 // Figure out what the input bits are. If the top bits of the and result
1154 // are not demanded, then the add doesn't demand them from its input
1155 // either.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001156 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001157
1158 // If there is a constant on the RHS, there are a variety of xformations
1159 // we can do.
1160 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
1161 // If null, this should be simplified elsewhere. Some of the xforms here
1162 // won't work if the RHS is zero.
1163 if (RHS->isZero())
1164 break;
1165
1166 // If the top bit of the output is demanded, demand everything from the
1167 // input. Otherwise, we demand all the input bits except NLZ top bits.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001168 APInt InDemandedBits(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - NLZ));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001169
1170 // Find information about known zero/one bits in the input.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001171 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), InDemandedBits,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001172 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001173 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001174
1175 // If the RHS of the add has bits set that can't affect the input, reduce
1176 // the constant.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001177 if (ShrinkDemandedConstant(I, 1, InDemandedBits, Context))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001178 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001179
1180 // Avoid excess work.
1181 if (LHSKnownZero == 0 && LHSKnownOne == 0)
1182 break;
1183
1184 // Turn it into OR if input bits are zero.
1185 if ((LHSKnownZero & RHS->getValue()) == RHS->getValue()) {
1186 Instruction *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001187 BinaryOperator::CreateOr(I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1),
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001188 I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001189 return InsertNewInstBefore(Or, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001190 }
1191
1192 // We can say something about the output known-zero and known-one bits,
1193 // depending on potential carries from the input constant and the
1194 // unknowns. For example if the LHS is known to have at most the 0x0F0F0
1195 // bits set and the RHS constant is 0x01001, then we know we have a known
1196 // one mask of 0x00001 and a known zero mask of 0xE0F0E.
1197
1198 // To compute this, we first compute the potential carry bits. These are
1199 // the bits which may be modified. I'm not aware of a better way to do
1200 // this scan.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001201 const APInt &RHSVal = RHS->getValue();
Zhou Shengb9cb95f2007-03-31 02:38:39 +00001202 APInt CarryBits((~LHSKnownZero + RHSVal) ^ (~LHSKnownZero ^ RHSVal));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001203
1204 // Now that we know which bits have carries, compute the known-1/0 sets.
1205
1206 // Bits are known one if they are known zero in one operand and one in the
1207 // other, and there is no input carry.
1208 RHSKnownOne = ((LHSKnownZero & RHSVal) |
1209 (LHSKnownOne & ~RHSVal)) & ~CarryBits;
1210
1211 // Bits are known zero if they are known zero in both operands and there
1212 // is no input carry.
1213 RHSKnownZero = LHSKnownZero & ~RHSVal & ~CarryBits;
1214 } else {
1215 // If the high-bits of this ADD are not demanded, then it does not demand
1216 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001217 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001218 // Right fill the mask of bits for this ADD to demand the most
1219 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001220 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001221 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1222 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1223 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001224 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001225 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001226 }
1227 }
1228 break;
1229 }
1230 case Instruction::Sub:
1231 // If the high-bits of this SUB are not demanded, then it does not demand
1232 // the high bits of its LHS or RHS.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001233 if (DemandedMask[BitWidth-1] == 0) {
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001234 // Right fill the mask of bits for this SUB to demand the most
1235 // significant bit and all those below it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00001236 uint32_t NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001237 APInt DemandedFromOps(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-NLZ));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001238 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedFromOps,
1239 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1) ||
1240 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), DemandedFromOps,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001241 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001242 return I;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001243 }
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001244 // Otherwise just hand the sub off to ComputeMaskedBits to fill in
1245 // the known zeros and ones.
1246 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001247 break;
1248 case Instruction::Shl:
1249 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001250 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001251 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.lshr(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001252 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001253 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001254 return I;
1255 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001256 RHSKnownZero <<= ShiftAmt;
1257 RHSKnownOne <<= ShiftAmt;
1258 // low bits known zero.
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001259 if (ShiftAmt)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00001260 RHSKnownZero |= APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001261 }
1262 break;
1263 case Instruction::LShr:
1264 // For a logical shift right
1265 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00001266 uint64_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001267
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001268 // Unsigned shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001269 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001270 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001271 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001272 return I;
1273 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001274 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1275 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001276 if (ShiftAmt) {
1277 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001278 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Zhou Shengadc14952007-03-14 09:07:33 +00001279 RHSKnownZero |= HighBits; // high bits known zero.
1280 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001281 }
1282 break;
1283 case Instruction::AShr:
1284 // If this is an arithmetic shift right and only the low-bit is set, we can
1285 // always convert this into a logical shr, even if the shift amount is
1286 // variable. The low bit of the shift cannot be an input sign bit unless
1287 // the shift amount is >= the size of the datatype, which is undefined.
1288 if (DemandedMask == 1) {
1289 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001290 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001291 I->getOperand(0), I->getOperand(1), I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001292 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001293 }
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00001294
1295 // If the sign bit is the only bit demanded by this ashr, then there is no
1296 // need to do it, the shift doesn't change the high bit.
1297 if (DemandedMask.isSignBit())
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001298 return I->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001299
1300 if (ConstantInt *SA = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00001301 uint32_t ShiftAmt = SA->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001302
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001303 // Signed shift right.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001304 APInt DemandedMaskIn(DemandedMask.shl(ShiftAmt));
Lauro Ramos Venanciod0499af2007-06-06 17:08:48 +00001305 // If any of the "high bits" are demanded, we should set the sign bit as
1306 // demanded.
1307 if (DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros() <= ShiftAmt)
1308 DemandedMaskIn.set(BitWidth-1);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001309 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), DemandedMaskIn,
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001310 RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001311 return I;
1312 assert(!(RHSKnownZero & RHSKnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001313 // Compute the new bits that are at the top now.
Zhou Sheng01542f32007-03-29 02:26:30 +00001314 APInt HighBits(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, ShiftAmt));
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001315 RHSKnownZero = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownZero, ShiftAmt);
1316 RHSKnownOne = APIntOps::lshr(RHSKnownOne, ShiftAmt);
1317
1318 // Handle the sign bits.
1319 APInt SignBit(APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth));
1320 // Adjust to where it is now in the mask.
1321 SignBit = APIntOps::lshr(SignBit, ShiftAmt);
1322
1323 // If the input sign bit is known to be zero, or if none of the top bits
1324 // are demanded, turn this into an unsigned shift right.
Zhou Shengcc419402008-06-06 08:32:05 +00001325 if (BitWidth <= ShiftAmt || RHSKnownZero[BitWidth-ShiftAmt-1] ||
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001326 (HighBits & ~DemandedMask) == HighBits) {
1327 // Perform the logical shift right.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001328 Instruction *NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001329 I->getOperand(0), SA, I->getName());
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001330 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001331 } else if ((RHSKnownOne & SignBit) != 0) { // New bits are known one.
1332 RHSKnownOne |= HighBits;
1333 }
1334 }
1335 break;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001336 case Instruction::SRem:
1337 if (ConstantInt *Rem = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001338 APInt RA = Rem->getValue().abs();
1339 if (RA.isPowerOf2()) {
Eli Friedmana999a512009-06-17 02:57:36 +00001340 if (DemandedMask.ult(RA)) // srem won't affect demanded bits
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001341 return I->getOperand(0);
Nick Lewycky3ac9e102008-07-12 05:04:38 +00001342
Nick Lewycky8e394322008-11-02 02:41:50 +00001343 APInt LowBits = RA - 1;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001344 APInt Mask2 = LowBits | APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001345 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), Mask2,
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001346 LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001347 return I;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001348
1349 if (LHSKnownZero[BitWidth-1] || ((LHSKnownZero & LowBits) == LowBits))
1350 LHSKnownZero |= ~LowBits;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001351
1352 KnownZero |= LHSKnownZero & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001353
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001354 assert(!(KnownZero & KnownOne) && "Bits known to be one AND zero?");
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001355 }
1356 }
1357 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001358 case Instruction::URem: {
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001359 APInt KnownZero2(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne2(BitWidth, 0);
1360 APInt AllOnes = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001361 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(0), AllOnes,
1362 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1) ||
1363 SimplifyDemandedBits(I->getOperandUse(1), AllOnes,
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001364 KnownZero2, KnownOne2, Depth+1))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001365 return I;
Dan Gohmane85b7582008-05-01 19:13:24 +00001366
Chris Lattner455e9ab2009-01-21 18:09:24 +00001367 unsigned Leaders = KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes();
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001368 Leaders = std::max(Leaders,
1369 KnownZero2.countLeadingOnes());
1370 KnownZero = APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, Leaders) & DemandedMask;
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00001371 break;
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001372 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001373 case Instruction::Call:
1374 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I)) {
1375 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1376 default: break;
1377 case Intrinsic::bswap: {
1378 // If the only bits demanded come from one byte of the bswap result,
1379 // just shift the input byte into position to eliminate the bswap.
1380 unsigned NLZ = DemandedMask.countLeadingZeros();
1381 unsigned NTZ = DemandedMask.countTrailingZeros();
1382
1383 // Round NTZ down to the next byte. If we have 11 trailing zeros, then
1384 // we need all the bits down to bit 8. Likewise, round NLZ. If we
1385 // have 14 leading zeros, round to 8.
1386 NLZ &= ~7;
1387 NTZ &= ~7;
1388 // If we need exactly one byte, we can do this transformation.
1389 if (BitWidth-NLZ-NTZ == 8) {
1390 unsigned ResultBit = NTZ;
1391 unsigned InputBit = BitWidth-NTZ-8;
1392
1393 // Replace this with either a left or right shift to get the byte into
1394 // the right place.
1395 Instruction *NewVal;
1396 if (InputBit > ResultBit)
1397 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001398 Context->getConstantInt(I->getType(), InputBit-ResultBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001399 else
1400 NewVal = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001401 Context->getConstantInt(I->getType(), ResultBit-InputBit));
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001402 NewVal->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00001403 return InsertNewInstBefore(NewVal, *I);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001404 }
1405
1406 // TODO: Could compute known zero/one bits based on the input.
1407 break;
1408 }
1409 }
1410 }
Chris Lattner6c3bfba2008-06-18 18:11:55 +00001411 ComputeMaskedBits(V, DemandedMask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne, Depth);
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00001412 break;
Dan Gohman23e8b712008-04-28 17:02:21 +00001413 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001414
1415 // If the client is only demanding bits that we know, return the known
1416 // constant.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00001417 if ((DemandedMask & (RHSKnownZero|RHSKnownOne)) == DemandedMask) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001418 Constant *C = Context->getConstantInt(RHSKnownOne);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00001419 if (isa<PointerType>(V->getType()))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001420 C = Context->getConstantExprIntToPtr(C, V->getType());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00001421 return C;
1422 }
Reid Spencer8cb68342007-03-12 17:25:59 +00001423 return false;
1424}
1425
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001426
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001427/// SimplifyDemandedVectorElts - The specified value produces a vector with
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001428/// any number of elements. DemandedElts contains the set of elements that are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001429/// actually used by the caller. This method analyzes which elements of the
1430/// operand are undef and returns that information in UndefElts.
1431///
1432/// If the information about demanded elements can be used to simplify the
1433/// operation, the operation is simplified, then the resultant value is
1434/// returned. This returns null if no change was made.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001435Value *InstCombiner::SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(Value *V, APInt DemandedElts,
1436 APInt& UndefElts,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001437 unsigned Depth) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001438 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001439 APInt EltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001440 assert((DemandedElts & ~EltMask) == 0 && "Invalid DemandedElts!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001441
1442 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
1443 // If the entire vector is undefined, just return this info.
1444 UndefElts = EltMask;
1445 return 0;
1446 } else if (DemandedElts == 0) { // If nothing is demanded, provide undef.
1447 UndefElts = EltMask;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001448 return Context->getUndef(V->getType());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001449 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001450
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001451 UndefElts = 0;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001452 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
1453 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001454 Constant *Undef = Context->getUndef(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001455
1456 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1457 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001458 if (!DemandedElts[i]) { // If not demanded, set to undef.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001459 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001460 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001461 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(CP->getOperand(i))) { // Already undef.
1462 Elts.push_back(Undef);
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001463 UndefElts.set(i);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001464 } else { // Otherwise, defined.
1465 Elts.push_back(CP->getOperand(i));
1466 }
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001467
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001468 // If we changed the constant, return it.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001469 Constant *NewCP = Context->getConstantVector(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001470 return NewCP != CP ? NewCP : 0;
1471 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001472 // Simplify the CAZ to a ConstantVector where the non-demanded elements are
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001473 // set to undef.
Mon P Wange0b436a2008-11-06 22:52:21 +00001474
1475 // Check if this is identity. If so, return 0 since we are not simplifying
1476 // anything.
1477 if (DemandedElts == ((1ULL << VWidth) -1))
1478 return 0;
1479
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00001480 const Type *EltTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001481 Constant *Zero = Context->getNullValue(EltTy);
1482 Constant *Undef = Context->getUndef(EltTy);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001483 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001484 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
1485 Constant *Elt = DemandedElts[i] ? Zero : Undef;
1486 Elts.push_back(Elt);
1487 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001488 UndefElts = DemandedElts ^ EltMask;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001489 return Context->getConstantVector(Elts);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001490 }
1491
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001492 // Limit search depth.
1493 if (Depth == 10)
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001494 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001495
1496 // If multiple users are using the root value, procede with
1497 // simplification conservatively assuming that all elements
1498 // are needed.
1499 if (!V->hasOneUse()) {
1500 // Quit if we find multiple users of a non-root value though.
1501 // They'll be handled when it's their turn to be visited by
1502 // the main instcombine process.
1503 if (Depth != 0)
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001504 // TODO: Just compute the UndefElts information recursively.
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001505 return 0;
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001506
1507 // Conservatively assume that all elements are needed.
1508 DemandedElts = EltMask;
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001509 }
1510
1511 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Dan Gohman2fe4d0a2009-04-25 17:28:45 +00001512 if (!I) return 0; // Only analyze instructions.
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001513
1514 bool MadeChange = false;
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001515 APInt UndefElts2(VWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001516 Value *TmpV;
1517 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
1518 default: break;
1519
1520 case Instruction::InsertElement: {
1521 // If this is a variable index, we don't know which element it overwrites.
1522 // demand exactly the same input as we produce.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001523 ConstantInt *Idx = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001524 if (Idx == 0) {
1525 // Note that we can't propagate undef elt info, because we don't know
1526 // which elt is getting updated.
1527 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1528 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1529 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1530 break;
1531 }
1532
1533 // If this is inserting an element that isn't demanded, remove this
1534 // insertelement.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00001535 unsigned IdxNo = Idx->getZExtValue();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001536 if (IdxNo >= VWidth || !DemandedElts[IdxNo])
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001537 return AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*I, 0);
1538
1539 // Otherwise, the element inserted overwrites whatever was there, so the
1540 // input demanded set is simpler than the output set.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001541 APInt DemandedElts2 = DemandedElts;
1542 DemandedElts2.clear(IdxNo);
1543 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts2,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001544 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1545 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1546
1547 // The inserted element is defined.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001548 UndefElts.clear(IdxNo);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001549 break;
1550 }
1551 case Instruction::ShuffleVector: {
1552 ShuffleVectorInst *Shuffle = cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001553 uint64_t LHSVWidth =
1554 cast<VectorType>(Shuffle->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001555 APInt LeftDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0), RightDemanded(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001556 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001557 if (DemandedElts[i]) {
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001558 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
1559 if (MaskVal != -1u) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001560 assert(MaskVal < LHSVWidth * 2 &&
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001561 "shufflevector mask index out of range!");
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001562 if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001563 LeftDemanded.set(MaskVal);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001564 else
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001565 RightDemanded.set(MaskVal - LHSVWidth);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001566 }
1567 }
1568 }
1569
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001570 APInt UndefElts4(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001571 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), LeftDemanded,
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001572 UndefElts4, Depth+1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001573 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1574
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001575 APInt UndefElts3(LHSVWidth, 0);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001576 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), RightDemanded,
1577 UndefElts3, Depth+1);
1578 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1579
1580 bool NewUndefElts = false;
1581 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; i++) {
1582 unsigned MaskVal = Shuffle->getMaskValue(i);
Dan Gohmancb893092008-09-10 01:09:32 +00001583 if (MaskVal == -1u) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001584 UndefElts.set(i);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00001585 } else if (MaskVal < LHSVWidth) {
Nate Begeman7b254672009-02-11 22:36:25 +00001586 if (UndefElts4[MaskVal]) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001587 NewUndefElts = true;
1588 UndefElts.set(i);
1589 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001590 } else {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001591 if (UndefElts3[MaskVal - LHSVWidth]) {
1592 NewUndefElts = true;
1593 UndefElts.set(i);
1594 }
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001595 }
1596 }
1597
1598 if (NewUndefElts) {
1599 // Add additional discovered undefs.
1600 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
1601 for (unsigned i = 0; i < VWidth; ++i) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001602 if (UndefElts[i])
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001603 Elts.push_back(Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001604 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001605 Elts.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty,
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001606 Shuffle->getMaskValue(i)));
1607 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001608 I->setOperand(2, Context->getConstantVector(Elts));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +00001609 MadeChange = true;
1610 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001611 break;
1612 }
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001613 case Instruction::BitCast: {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001614 // Vector->vector casts only.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001615 const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType());
1616 if (!VTy) break;
1617 unsigned InVWidth = VTy->getNumElements();
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001618 APInt InputDemandedElts(InVWidth, 0);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001619 unsigned Ratio;
1620
1621 if (VWidth == InVWidth) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +00001622 // If we are converting from <4 x i32> -> <4 x f32>, we demand the same
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001623 // elements as are demanded of us.
1624 Ratio = 1;
1625 InputDemandedElts = DemandedElts;
1626 } else if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
1627 // Untested so far.
1628 break;
1629
1630 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1631 // then an input element is live if any of the corresponding output
1632 // elements are live.
1633 Ratio = VWidth/InVWidth;
1634 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001635 if (DemandedElts[OutIdx])
1636 InputDemandedElts.set(OutIdx/Ratio);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001637 }
1638 } else {
1639 // Untested so far.
1640 break;
1641
1642 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1643 // then an input element is live if the corresponding output element is
1644 // live.
1645 Ratio = InVWidth/VWidth;
1646 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001647 if (DemandedElts[InIdx/Ratio])
1648 InputDemandedElts.set(InIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001649 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001650
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001651 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1652 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), InputDemandedElts,
1653 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1654 if (TmpV) {
1655 I->setOperand(0, TmpV);
1656 MadeChange = true;
1657 }
1658
1659 UndefElts = UndefElts2;
1660 if (VWidth > InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001661 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001662 // If there are more elements in the result than there are in the source,
1663 // then an output element is undef if the corresponding input element is
1664 // undef.
1665 for (unsigned OutIdx = 0; OutIdx != VWidth; ++OutIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001666 if (UndefElts2[OutIdx/Ratio])
1667 UndefElts.set(OutIdx);
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001668 } else if (VWidth < InVWidth) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001669 llvm_unreachable("Unimp");
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001670 // If there are more elements in the source than there are in the result,
1671 // then a result element is undef if all of the corresponding input
1672 // elements are undef.
1673 UndefElts = ~0ULL >> (64-VWidth); // Start out all undef.
1674 for (unsigned InIdx = 0; InIdx != InVWidth; ++InIdx)
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00001675 if (!UndefElts2[InIdx]) // Not undef?
1676 UndefElts.clear(InIdx/Ratio); // Clear undef bit.
Chris Lattner69878332007-04-14 22:29:23 +00001677 }
1678 break;
1679 }
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001680 case Instruction::And:
1681 case Instruction::Or:
1682 case Instruction::Xor:
1683 case Instruction::Add:
1684 case Instruction::Sub:
1685 case Instruction::Mul:
1686 // div/rem demand all inputs, because they don't want divide by zero.
1687 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(0), DemandedElts,
1688 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1689 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(0, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1690 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(I->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1691 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1692 if (TmpV) { I->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1693
1694 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1695 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1696 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1697 break;
1698
1699 case Instruction::Call: {
1700 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(I);
1701 if (!II) break;
1702 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1703 default: break;
1704
1705 // Binary vector operations that work column-wise. A dest element is a
1706 // function of the corresponding input elements from the two inputs.
1707 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1708 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1709 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_min_ss:
1710 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_max_ss:
1711 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1712 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1713 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_min_sd:
1714 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_max_sd:
1715 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
1716 UndefElts, Depth+1);
1717 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(1, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1718 TmpV = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(2), DemandedElts,
1719 UndefElts2, Depth+1);
1720 if (TmpV) { II->setOperand(2, TmpV); MadeChange = true; }
1721
1722 // If only the low elt is demanded and this is a scalarizable intrinsic,
1723 // scalarize it now.
1724 if (DemandedElts == 1) {
1725 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
1726 default: break;
1727 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1728 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1729 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
1730 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
1731 // TODO: Lower MIN/MAX/ABS/etc
1732 Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
1733 Value *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
1734 // Extract the element as scalars.
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +00001735 LHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(LHS,
1736 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
1737 RHS = InsertNewInstBefore(new ExtractElementInst(RHS,
1738 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0U, false), "tmp"), *II);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001739
1740 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001741 default: llvm_unreachable("Case stmts out of sync!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001742 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_sub_ss:
1743 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_sub_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001744 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001745 II->getName()), *II);
1746 break;
1747 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_mul_ss:
1748 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_mul_sd:
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00001749 TmpV = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(LHS, RHS,
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001750 II->getName()), *II);
1751 break;
1752 }
1753
1754 Instruction *New =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001755 InsertElementInst::Create(
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +00001756 Context->getUndef(II->getType()), TmpV,
1757 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0U, false), II->getName());
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00001758 InsertNewInstBefore(New, *II);
1759 AddSoonDeadInstToWorklist(*II, 0);
1760 return New;
1761 }
1762 }
1763
1764 // Output elements are undefined if both are undefined. Consider things
1765 // like undef&0. The result is known zero, not undef.
1766 UndefElts &= UndefElts2;
1767 break;
1768 }
1769 break;
1770 }
1771 }
1772 return MadeChange ? I : 0;
1773}
1774
Dan Gohman45b4e482008-05-19 22:14:15 +00001775
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001776/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
1777/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
1778/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
1779/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
1780/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
1781/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
1782/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
1783///
1784template<typename Functor>
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001785static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00001786 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001787 unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
1788 Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
1789
1790 // Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
1791 if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
1792 return F.apply(Root);
1793
1794 // Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
1795 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00001796 while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001797 // Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
1798 bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
1799
1800 // If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
1801 if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
1802 cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
1803 ShouldApply = true;
1804 }
1805
1806 // If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
1807 // reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
1808 if (ShouldApply) {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001809 // Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
1810 // and perform the reassociation.
1811 Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
1812
1813 // First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
1814 Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
1815
1816 // Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
1817 Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001818 if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001819 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
Chris Lattner15a76c02004-04-05 02:10:19 +00001820 return 0;
1821 }
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001822 Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001823 TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001824 BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001825 TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001826 ARI = Root;
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001827
1828 // Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
1829 // get to LHSI.
1830 while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
1831 Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001832 // Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
1833 // constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
Dan Gohmand02d9172008-06-19 17:47:47 +00001834 NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
Chris Lattner65725312004-04-16 18:08:07 +00001835 ARI = NextLHSI;
1836
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001837 Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
1838 NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
1839 TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
1840 ExtraOperand = NextOp;
1841 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001842
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001843 // Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
1844 // the transformation...
1845 return F.apply(Root);
1846 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00001847
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001848 LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
1849 }
1850 return 0;
1851}
1852
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001853namespace {
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001854
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001855// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001856struct AddRHS {
1857 Value *RHS;
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00001858 LLVMContext *Context;
1859 AddRHS(Value *rhs, LLVMContext *C) : RHS(rhs), Context(C) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001860 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
1861 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Nick Lewycky02d639f2008-05-23 04:34:58 +00001862 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001863 Context->getConstantInt(Add.getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001864 }
1865};
1866
1867// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
1868// iff C1&C2 == 0
1869struct AddMaskingAnd {
1870 Constant *C2;
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00001871 LLVMContext *Context;
1872 AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c, LLVMContext *C) : C2(c), Context(C) {}
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001873 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00001874 ConstantInt *C1;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00001875 return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001876 Context->getConstantExprAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001877 }
1878 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001879 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001880 }
1881};
1882
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00001883}
1884
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001885static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001886 InstCombiner *IC) {
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00001887 LLVMContext *Context = IC->getContext();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001888
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00001889 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I)) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00001890 return IC->InsertCastBefore(CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType(), I);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001891 }
1892
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001893 // Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001894 bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
1895 Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00001896
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001897 if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
1898 if (ConstIsRHS)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001899 return Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
1900 return Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001901 }
1902
1903 Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
1904 if (!ConstIsRHS)
1905 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
1906 Instruction *New;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001907 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001908 New = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,SO->getName()+".op");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001909 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00001910 New = CmpInst::Create(*Context, CI->getOpcode(), CI->getPredicate(),
1911 Op0, Op1, SO->getName()+".cmp");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001912 else {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00001913 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binary instruction type!");
Chris Lattner326c0f32004-04-10 19:15:56 +00001914 }
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001915 return IC->InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
1916}
1917
1918// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
1919// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
1920// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
1921// not have a second operand.
1922static Instruction *FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI,
1923 InstCombiner *IC) {
1924 // Don't modify shared select instructions
1925 if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
1926 Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
1927 Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
1928
1929 if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001930 // Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00001931 if (SI->getType() == Type::Int1Ty) return 0;
Chris Lattner956db272005-04-21 05:43:13 +00001932
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001933 Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, IC);
1934 Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, IC);
1935
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001936 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
1937 SelectFalseVal);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00001938 }
1939 return 0;
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00001940}
1941
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001942
1943/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator or cast instruction which has a PHI
1944/// node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the PHI (which
1945/// is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
1946Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I) {
1947 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001948 unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001949 if (!PN->hasOneUse() || NumPHIValues == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001950
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001951 // Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are constants. If there is
1952 // one non-constant value, remember the BB it is. If there is more than one
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001953 // or if *it* is a PHI, bail out.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001954 BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
1955 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
1956 if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
1957 if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
Chris Lattnerb3036682007-02-24 01:03:45 +00001958 if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001959 NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
1960
1961 // If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
1962 // loop.
1963 if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
1964 return 0;
1965 }
1966
1967 // If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
1968 // operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
1969 // inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
1970 // do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
1971 if (NonConstBB) {
1972 BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
1973 if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
1974 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001975
1976 // Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00001977 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +00001978 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001979 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00001980 NewPN->takeName(PN);
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00001981
1982 // Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
1983 if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
1984 Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00001985 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00001986 Value *InV = 0;
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001987 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001988 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001989 InV = Context->getConstantExprCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001990 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00001991 InV = Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001992 } else {
1993 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
1994 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00001995 InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00001996 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
1997 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00001998 else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00001999 InV = CmpInst::Create(*Context, CI->getOpcode(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002000 CI->getPredicate(),
2001 PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
2002 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002003 else
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00002004 llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002005
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00002006 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002007 }
2008 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002009 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002010 } else {
2011 CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
2012 const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +00002013 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002014 Value *InV;
2015 if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002016 InV = Context->getConstantExprCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002017 } else {
2018 assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002019 InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002020 I.getType(), "phitmp",
2021 NonConstBB->getTerminator());
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00002022 AddToWorkList(cast<Instruction>(InV));
Chris Lattner2a86f3b2006-09-09 22:02:56 +00002023 }
2024 NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002025 }
2026 }
2027 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
2028}
2029
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002030
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002031/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
2032/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
2033/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
2034/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
2035bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
2036 // There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
2037 // ones.
2038
2039 // Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
2040 // have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
2041 // have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values will
2042 // sign extend fine.
2043 if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
2044 return true;
2045
2046
2047 // If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
2048 // has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
2049 // sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
2050 // sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
2051
2052 // TODO: Implement.
2053
2054 return false;
2055}
2056
Chris Lattner2454a2e2008-01-29 06:52:45 +00002057
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002058Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002059 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002060 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002061
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002062 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002063 // X + undef -> undef
2064 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS))
2065 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
2066
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002067 // X + 0 --> X
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002068 if (RHSC->isNullValue())
2069 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002070
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002071 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002072 // X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002073 const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002074 uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002075 if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002076 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattnerb4a2f052006-11-09 05:12:27 +00002077
2078 // See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
2079 // (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002080 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00002081 return &I;
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002082
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002083 // zext(bool) + C -> bool ? C + 1 : C
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00002084 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002085 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::Int1Ty)
2086 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), AddOne(CI, Context), CI);
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002087 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002088
2089 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2090 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2091 return NV;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002092
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002093 ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
2094 Value *XorLHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +00002095 if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002096 match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)), *Context)) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002097 uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002098 const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002099
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002100 uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002101 APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
2102 APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002103 do {
2104 if (TySizeBits > Size) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002105 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
2106 // If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002107 if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
2108 (RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002109 // This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00002110 if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
2111 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002112 Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002113 break;
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002114 }
2115 }
2116 Size >>= 1;
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00002117 C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
2118 CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
2119 } while (Size >= 1);
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002120
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002121 // FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00002122 // with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
2123 // is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
2124 // that the back ends can handle.
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002125 const Type *MiddleType = 0;
2126 switch (Size) {
2127 default: break;
2128 case 32: MiddleType = Type::Int32Ty; break;
2129 case 16: MiddleType = Type::Int16Ty; break;
2130 case 8: MiddleType = Type::Int8Ty; break;
2131 }
2132 if (MiddleType) {
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00002133 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002134 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
Reid Spencer35c38852007-03-28 01:36:16 +00002135 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
Chris Lattner5931c542005-09-24 23:43:33 +00002136 }
2137 }
Chris Lattner66331a42004-04-10 22:01:55 +00002138 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002139
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002140 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2141 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
2142
Nick Lewycky7d26bd82008-05-23 04:39:38 +00002143 // X + X --> X << 1
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002144 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002145 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS, Context), Context))
2146 return Result;
Chris Lattner7edc8c22005-04-07 17:14:51 +00002147
2148 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
2149 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2150 if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
2151 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
2152 }
2153 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
2154 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
2155 if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
2156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
2157 }
Robert Bocchino71698282004-07-27 21:02:21 +00002158 }
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002159
Chris Lattner5c4afb92002-05-08 22:46:53 +00002160 // -A + B --> B - A
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002161 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002162 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS, Context)) {
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002163 if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002164 if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS, Context)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002165 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002166 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002167 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, NewAdd);
Chris Lattnere10c0b92008-02-18 17:50:16 +00002168 }
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002169 }
2170
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002171 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
Chris Lattnerdd12f962008-02-17 21:03:36 +00002172 }
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002173
2174 // A + -B --> A - B
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00002175 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002176 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS, Context))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002177 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002178
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002179
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002180 ConstantInt *C2;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002181 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2, Context)) {
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002182 if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002183 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2, Context));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002184
2185 // X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
2186 ConstantInt *C1;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002187 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1, Context))
2188 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Context->getConstantExprAdd(C1, C2));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002189 }
2190
2191 // X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002192 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2, Context) == LHS)
2193 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2, Context));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002194
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002195 // X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002196 if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS, Context) == RHS ||
2197 dyn_castNotVal(RHS, Context) == LHS)
2198 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002199
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002200
Chris Lattner564a7272003-08-13 19:01:45 +00002201 // (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002202 if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2)), *Context))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002203 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2, Context), Context))
Chris Lattnere617c9e2007-01-05 02:17:46 +00002204 return R;
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002205
2206 // A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
2207 if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
2208 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
2209 APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2210 APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2211 ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
2212 if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
2213 APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2214 APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
2215 ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
2216
2217 // No bits in common -> bitwise or.
Chris Lattner9d60ba92008-05-19 20:03:53 +00002218 if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002219 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner5e0d7182008-05-19 20:01:56 +00002220 }
2221 }
Chris Lattnerc8802d22003-03-11 00:12:48 +00002222
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002223 // W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
Nick Lewycky0c2c3f62008-02-03 08:19:11 +00002224 if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002225 Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002226 if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X)), *Context) &&
2227 match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)), *Context)) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002228 if (W != Y) {
2229 if (W == Z) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002230 std::swap(Y, Z);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002231 } else if (Y == X) {
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +00002232 std::swap(W, X);
2233 } else if (X == Z) {
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002234 std::swap(Y, Z);
2235 std::swap(W, X);
2236 }
2237 }
2238
2239 if (W == Y) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002240 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, Z,
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002241 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002242 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
Nick Lewyckyb6eabff2008-02-03 07:42:09 +00002243 }
2244 }
2245 }
2246
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002247 if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00002248 Value *X = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002249 if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)), *Context)) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002250 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS, Context), X);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002251
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002252 // (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002253 if (LHS->hasOneUse() &&
2254 match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)), *Context)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002255 Constant *Anded = Context->getConstantExprAnd(CRHS, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002256 if (Anded == CRHS) {
2257 // See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
2258 // in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002259 const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002260
2261 // Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002262 APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002263
2264 // See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00002265 APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002266
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002267 if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
2268 // Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002269 Value *NewAdd = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, CRHS,
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002270 LHS->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002271 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
Chris Lattnerb99d6b12004-10-08 05:07:56 +00002272 }
2273 }
2274 }
2275
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002276 // Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
2277 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002278 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00002279 return R;
Chris Lattner6b032052003-10-02 15:11:26 +00002280 }
2281
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002282 // add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002283 {
2284 SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002285 Value *A = RHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002286 if (!SI) {
2287 SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002288 A = LHS;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002289 }
Chris Lattner42790482007-12-20 01:56:58 +00002290 if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002291 Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
2292 Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002293 Value *N;
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002294
2295 // Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
2296 // We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002297 if (match(FV, m_Zero(), *Context) &&
2298 match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A)), *Context))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002299 // Fold the add into the true select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002300 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002301 if (match(TV, m_Zero(), *Context) &&
2302 match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A)), *Context))
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00002303 // Fold the add into the false select value.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00002304 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
Christopher Lamb30f017a2007-12-18 09:34:41 +00002305 }
2306 }
Andrew Lenharth16d79552006-09-19 18:24:51 +00002307
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002308 // Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2309 // integer add followed by a sext.
2310 if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
2311 // (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
2312 if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
2313 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002314 Context->getConstantExprTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002315 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002316 Context->getConstantExprSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002317 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2318 // Insert the new, smaller add.
2319 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2320 CI, "addconv");
2321 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2322 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2323 }
2324 }
2325
2326 // (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
2327 if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
2328 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2329 // single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
2330 // integer add will not overflow.
2331 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2332 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2333 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2334 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2335 // Insert the new integer add.
2336 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2337 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2338 "addconv");
2339 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2340 return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2341 }
2342 }
2343 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002344
2345 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2346}
2347
2348Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
2349 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2350 Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
2351
2352 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
2353 // X + 0 --> X
2354 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002355 if (CFP->isExactlyValue(Context->getConstantFPNegativeZero
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002356 (I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
2357 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2358 }
2359
2360 if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
2361 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2362 return NV;
2363 }
2364
2365 // -A + B --> B - A
2366 // -A + -B --> -(A + B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002367 if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castFNegVal(LHS, Context))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002368 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(RHS, LHSV);
2369
2370 // A + -B --> A - B
2371 if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002372 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(RHS, Context))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002373 return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, V);
2374
2375 // Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
2376 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
2377 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
2378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
2379
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002380 // Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
2381 // integer add followed by a promotion.
2382 if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
2383 // (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
2384 // ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
2385 // like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
2386 // requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
2387 // instcombined.
2388 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
2389 Constant *CI =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002390 Context->getConstantExprFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002391 if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002392 Context->getConstantExprSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
Chris Lattner3d28b1b2008-05-20 05:46:13 +00002393 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
2394 // Insert the new integer add.
2395 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2396 CI, "addconv");
2397 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2398 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2399 }
2400 }
2401
2402 // (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
2403 if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
2404 // Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
2405 // single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
2406 // and if the integer add will not overflow.
2407 if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
2408 (LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
2409 WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2410 RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
2411 // Insert the new integer add.
2412 Instruction *NewAdd = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
2413 RHSConv->getOperand(0),
2414 "addconv");
2415 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAdd, I);
2416 return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
2417 }
2418 }
2419 }
2420
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002421 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002422}
2423
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002424Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002425 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002426
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002427 if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002428 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002429
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002430 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002431 if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1, Context))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002432 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
Chris Lattnerb35dde12002-05-06 16:49:18 +00002433
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002434 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
2435 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
2436 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
2437 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
2438
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002439 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
2440 // Replace (-1 - A) with (~A)...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002441 if (C->isAllOnesValue())
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00002442 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Op1);
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002443
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002444 // C - ~X == X + (1+C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002445 Value *X = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00002446 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X)), *Context))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002447 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C, Context));
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002448
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +00002449 // -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
2450 // -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002451 if (C->isZero()) {
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002452 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002453 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002454 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002455 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002456 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002457 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002458 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002459 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002460 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Chris Lattner9c290672004-03-12 23:53:13 +00002461 }
2462 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002463 }
2464 else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
2465 if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
2466 // Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00002467 if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002468 SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00002469 // Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002470 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002471 SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00002472 }
2473 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002474 }
2475 }
Chris Lattnerbfe492b2004-03-13 00:11:49 +00002476 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002477
2478 // Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
2479 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002480 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002481 return R;
Eli Friedman709b33d2009-07-13 22:27:52 +00002482
2483 // C - zext(bool) -> bool ? C - 1 : C
2484 if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op1))
2485 if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::Int1Ty)
2486 return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), SubOne(C, Context), C);
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00002487 }
2488
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002489 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2490 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
2491
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002492 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002493 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002494 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002495 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op1I->getOperand(1),
2496 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002497 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002498 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op1I->getOperand(0),
2499 I.getName());
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002500 else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
2501 if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
2502 // C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002503 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
2504 Context->getConstantExprSub(CI1, CI2), Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner08954a22005-04-07 16:28:01 +00002505 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002506 }
2507
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00002508 if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002509 // Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
2510 // is not used by anyone else...
2511 //
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002512 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002513 // Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
2514 Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
2515 Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
2516 Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002517
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002518 // Create the new top level add instruction...
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002519 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002520 }
2521
2522 // Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
2523 //
2524 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
2525 (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
2526 Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
2527
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +00002528 Value *NewNot =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00002529 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
2530 OtherOp, "B.not"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002531 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002532 }
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002533
Reid Spencerac5209e2006-10-16 23:08:08 +00002534 // 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002535 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00002536 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002537 if (CSI->isZero())
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002538 if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002539 return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002540 Context->getConstantExprNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner91ccc152004-10-06 15:08:25 +00002541
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002542 // X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +00002543 ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002544 if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2, Context) == Op0) {
2545 Constant *CP1 =
2546 Context->getConstantExprSub(Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00002547 C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002548 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002549 }
Chris Lattner40371712002-05-09 01:29:19 +00002550 }
Chris Lattner43d84d62005-04-07 16:15:25 +00002551 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002552
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002553 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
2554 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
2555 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
2556 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
2557 else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
2558 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
2559 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
2560 if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002561 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0I->getOperand(1),
2562 I.getName());
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00002563 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002564 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002565
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002566 ConstantInt *C1;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002567 if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1, Context)) {
Reid Spencer7177c3a2007-03-25 05:33:51 +00002568 if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002569 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1, Context));
Chris Lattnerad3448c2003-02-18 19:57:07 +00002570
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002571 ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002572 if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2, Context))
2573 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, Context->getConstantExprSub(C1, C2));
Chris Lattner50af16a2004-11-13 19:50:12 +00002574 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00002575 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002576}
2577
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002578Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
2579 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2580
2581 // If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002582 if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1, Context))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002583 return BinaryOperator::CreateFAdd(Op0, V);
2584
2585 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
2586 if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd) {
2587 if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002588 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(*Context, Op1I->getOperand(1),
2589 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002590 else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002591 return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(*Context, Op1I->getOperand(0),
2592 I.getName());
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002593 }
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002594 }
2595
2596 return 0;
2597}
2598
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002599/// isSignBitCheck - Given an exploded icmp instruction, return true if the
2600/// comparison only checks the sign bit. If it only checks the sign bit, set
2601/// TrueIfSigned if the result of the comparison is true when the input value is
2602/// signed.
2603static bool isSignBitCheck(ICmpInst::Predicate pred, ConstantInt *RHS,
2604 bool &TrueIfSigned) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002605 switch (pred) {
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002606 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // True if LHS s< 0
2607 TrueIfSigned = true;
2608 return RHS->isZero();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002609 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: // True if LHS s<= RHS and RHS == -1
2610 TrueIfSigned = true;
2611 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002612 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // True if LHS s> -1
2613 TrueIfSigned = false;
2614 return RHS->isAllOnesValue();
Chris Lattnercb7122b2007-07-16 04:15:34 +00002615 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
2616 // True if LHS u> RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask - 1
2617 TrueIfSigned = true;
2618 return RHS->getValue() ==
2619 APInt::getSignedMaxValue(RHS->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits());
2620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
2621 // True if LHS u>= RHS and RHS == high-bit-mask (2^7, 2^15, 2^31, etc)
2622 TrueIfSigned = true;
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00002623 return RHS->getValue().isSignBit();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002624 default:
2625 return false;
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002626 }
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002627}
2628
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002629Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00002630 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002631 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002632
Eli Friedman1694e092009-07-18 09:12:15 +00002633 if (isa<UndefValue>(I.getOperand(1))) // undef * X -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002634 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002635
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00002636 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002637 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2638 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002639
2640 // ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002641 if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
Chris Lattnere92d2f42003-08-13 04:18:28 +00002642 if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
2643 if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002644 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002645 Context->getConstantExprShl(CI, ShOp));
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002646
Zhou Sheng843f07672007-04-19 05:39:12 +00002647 if (CI->isZero())
Chris Lattner515c97c2003-09-11 22:24:54 +00002648 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X * 0 == 0
2649 if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
2650 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2651 if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002652 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0, I.getName());
Chris Lattner6c1ce212002-04-29 22:24:47 +00002653
Zhou Sheng97b52c22007-03-29 01:57:21 +00002654 const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002655 if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002656 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002657 Context->getConstantInt(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
Chris Lattnerbcd7db52005-08-02 19:16:58 +00002658 }
Chris Lattnerb8cd4d32008-08-11 22:06:05 +00002659 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
Eli Friedmanb4687092009-07-14 02:01:53 +00002660 if (Op1->isNullValue())
2661 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002662
2663 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2664 if (Op1V->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00002665 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0, I.getName());
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002666
2667 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2668 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002669 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Splat))
2670 if (CI->equalsInt(1))
2671 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2672 }
2673 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002674 }
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002675
2676 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
2677 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Chris Lattner47c99092008-05-18 04:11:26 +00002678 isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002679 // Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002680 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002681 Op1, "tmp");
2682 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002683 Value *C1C2 = Context->getConstantExprMul(Op1,
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002684 cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(1)));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002685 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
Chris Lattnerab51f3f2006-03-04 06:04:02 +00002686
2687 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002688
2689 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2690 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00002691 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00002692 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00002693
2694 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2695 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2696 return NV;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002697 }
2698
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002699 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0, Context)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2700 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(I.getOperand(1), Context))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002701 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
Chris Lattnera4f445b2003-03-10 23:23:04 +00002702
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002703 // (X / Y) * Y = X - (X % Y)
2704 // (X / Y) * -Y = (X % Y) - X
2705 {
2706 Value *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2707 BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
2708 if (!BO ||
2709 (BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::UDiv &&
2710 BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::SDiv)) {
2711 Op1 = Op0;
2712 BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1));
2713 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002714 Value *Neg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1, Context);
Nick Lewycky0c730792008-11-21 07:33:58 +00002715 if (BO && BO->hasOneUse() &&
2716 (BO->getOperand(1) == Op1 || BO->getOperand(1) == Neg) &&
2717 (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv ||
2718 BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)) {
2719 Value *Op0BO = BO->getOperand(0), *Op1BO = BO->getOperand(1);
2720
2721 Instruction *Rem;
2722 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
2723 Rem = BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
2724 else
2725 Rem = BinaryOperator::CreateSRem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
2726
2727 InsertNewInstBefore(Rem, I);
2728 Rem->takeName(BO);
2729
2730 if (Op1BO == Op1)
2731 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Op0BO, Rem);
2732 else
2733 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Rem, Op0BO);
2734 }
2735 }
2736
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002737 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2738 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
2739
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002740 // If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
2741 // we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
2742 // See if we can simplify things based on how the boolean was originally
2743 // formed.
2744 CastInst *BoolCast = 0;
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002745 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op0))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002746 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002747 BoolCast = CI;
2748 if (!BoolCast)
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00002749 if (ZExtInst *CI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00002750 if (CI->getOperand(0)->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002751 BoolCast = CI;
2752 if (BoolCast) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002753 if (ICmpInst *SCI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(BoolCast->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002754 Value *SCIOp0 = SCI->getOperand(0), *SCIOp1 = SCI->getOperand(1);
2755 const Type *SCOpTy = SCIOp0->getType();
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002756 bool TIS = false;
2757
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00002758 // If the icmp is true iff the sign bit of X is set, then convert this
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002759 // multiply into a shift/and combination.
2760 if (isa<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1) &&
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00002761 isSignBitCheck(SCI->getPredicate(), cast<ConstantInt>(SCIOp1), TIS) &&
2762 TIS) {
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002763 // Shift the X value right to turn it into "all signbits".
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002764 Constant *Amt = Context->getConstantInt(SCIOp0->getType(),
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00002765 SCOpTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1);
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002766 Value *V =
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00002767 InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002768 BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr, SCIOp0, Amt,
Chris Lattner4cb170c2004-02-23 06:38:22 +00002769 BoolCast->getOperand(0)->getName()+
2770 ".mask"), I);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002771
2772 // If the multiply type is not the same as the source type, sign extend
2773 // or truncate to the multiply type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002774 if (I.getType() != V->getType()) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00002775 uint32_t SrcBits = V->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
2776 uint32_t DstBits = I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00002777 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
2778 (SrcBits == DstBits ? Instruction::BitCast :
2779 (SrcBits < DstBits ? Instruction::SExt : Instruction::Trunc));
2780 V = InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, I.getType(), I);
2781 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002782
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002783 Value *OtherOp = Op0 == BoolCast ? I.getOperand(1) : Op0;
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002784 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
Chris Lattnerfb54b2b2004-02-23 05:39:21 +00002785 }
2786 }
2787 }
2788
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00002789 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00002790}
2791
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002792Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
2793 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
2794 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
2795
2796 // Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
2797 if (Constant *Op1 = dyn_cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
2798 if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1)) {
2799 // "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
2800 // ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
2801 if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2802 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
2803 } else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1->getType())) {
2804 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2805 // As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
2806 if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
2807 if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Splat))
2808 if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
2809 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2810 }
2811 }
2812 }
2813
2814 // Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
2815 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2816 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2817 return R;
2818
2819 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2820 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2821 return NV;
2822 }
2823
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002824 if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op0, Context)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
2825 if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castFNegVal(I.getOperand(1), Context))
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00002826 return BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(Op0v, Op1v);
2827
2828 return Changed ? &I : 0;
2829}
2830
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002831/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
2832/// instruction.
2833bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
2834 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
2835
2836 // div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
2837 int NonNullOperand = -1;
2838 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
2839 if (ST->isNullValue())
2840 NonNullOperand = 2;
2841 // div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
2842 if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
2843 if (ST->isNullValue())
2844 NonNullOperand = 1;
2845
2846 if (NonNullOperand == -1)
2847 return false;
2848
2849 Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
2850
2851 // Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
2852 I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
2853
2854 // Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
2855 // problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
2856 // multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
2857 // propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
2858 // propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
2859
2860 // If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
2861 // early exit.
2862 if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
2863 return true;
2864
2865 // Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
2866 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
2867
2868 while (BBI != BBFront) {
2869 --BBI;
2870 // If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
2871 // information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
2872 if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
2873 break;
2874
2875 // Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
2876 for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
2877 I != E; ++I) {
2878 if (*I == SI) {
2879 *I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
2880 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2881 } else if (*I == SelectCond) {
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00002882 *I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? Context->getTrue() :
2883 Context->getFalse();
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002884 AddToWorkList(BBI);
2885 }
2886 }
2887
2888 // If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
2889 if (&*BBI == SI)
2890 SI = 0;
2891 if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
2892 SelectCond = 0;
2893
2894 // If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
2895 if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
2896 break;
2897
2898 }
2899 return true;
2900}
2901
2902
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002903/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
2904/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
2905/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
2906/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002907Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002908 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00002909
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002910 // undef / X -> 0 for integer.
2911 // undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
2912 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
2913 if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
2914 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002915 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00002916 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002917
2918 // X / undef -> undef
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002919 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002920 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002921
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002922 return 0;
2923}
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002924
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002925/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
2926/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
2927/// division instructions.
2928/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00002929Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002930 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
2931
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002932 // (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002933 if (Op0 == Op1) {
2934 if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002935 Constant *CI = Context->getConstantInt(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002936 std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002937 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantVector(Elts));
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002938 }
2939
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002940 Constant *CI = Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1);
Nick Lewycky39ac3b52008-05-23 03:26:47 +00002941 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
2942 }
Chris Lattnerb2ae9e32008-05-16 02:59:42 +00002943
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002944 if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
2945 return Common;
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00002946
2947 // Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
2948 // This does not apply for fdiv.
2949 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
2950 return &I;
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002951
2952 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
2953 // div X, 1 == X
2954 if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
2955 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2956
2957 // (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
2958 if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
2959 if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
2960 if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002961 if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS,
2962 I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv, Context))
2963 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckye0cfecf2008-02-18 22:48:05 +00002964 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00002965 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002966 Context->getConstantExprMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
Chris Lattnerbf70b832005-04-08 04:03:26 +00002967 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002968
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00002969 if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002970 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
2971 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
2972 return R;
2973 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
2974 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
2975 return NV;
2976 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00002977 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00002978
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002979 // 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00002980 if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002981 if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00002982 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00002983
Nick Lewycky9419ddb2008-05-31 17:59:52 +00002984 // It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
2985 if (I.getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
2986 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2987
Nick Lewycky895f0852008-11-27 20:21:08 +00002988 if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
2989 if (ConstantInt *X = cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
2990 // div X, 1 == X
2991 if (X->isOne())
2992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
2993 }
2994
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00002995 return 0;
2996}
2997
2998Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
2999 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3000
3001 // Handle the integer div common cases
3002 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3003 return Common;
3004
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003005 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003006 // X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
3007 // Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
3008 // if so, convert to a right shift.
Reid Spencer6eb0d992007-03-26 23:58:26 +00003009 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003010 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003011 Context->getConstantInt(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003012
3013 // X udiv C, where C >= signbit
3014 if (C->getValue().isNegative()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003015 Value *IC = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(*Context,
3016 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0, C),
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003017 I);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003018 return SelectInst::Create(IC, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()),
3019 Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1));
Nick Lewycky8ca52482008-11-27 22:41:10 +00003020 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003021 }
3022
3023 // X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003024 if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003025 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3026 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003027 const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003028 if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003029 Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00003030 const Type *NTy = N->getType();
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00003031 if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003032 Constant *C2V = Context->getConstantInt(NTy, C2);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003033 N = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(N, C2V, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003034 }
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003035 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003036 }
3037 }
Chris Lattnerc812e5d2005-11-05 07:40:31 +00003038 }
3039
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003040 // udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
3041 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003042 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003043 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003044 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003045 const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003046 if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003047 // Compute the shift amounts
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003048 uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003049 // Construct the "on true" case of the select
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003050 Constant *TC = Context->getConstantInt(Op0->getType(), TSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003051 Instruction *TSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003052 Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
3053 TSI = InsertNewInstBefore(TSI, I);
3054
3055 // Construct the "on false" case of the select
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003056 Constant *FC = Context->getConstantInt(Op0->getType(), FSA);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003057 Instruction *FSI = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003058 Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
3059 FSI = InsertNewInstBefore(FSI, I);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003060
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003061 // construct the select instruction and return it.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003062 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003063 }
Reid Spencerbaf1e4b2007-03-05 23:36:13 +00003064 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003065 return 0;
3066}
3067
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003068Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3069 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3070
3071 // Handle the integer div common cases
3072 if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
3073 return Common;
3074
3075 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3076 // sdiv X, -1 == -X
3077 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00003078 return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0);
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003079 }
3080
3081 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
3082 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00003083 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003084 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003085 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3086 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask)) {
3087 // X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
3088 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3089 }
3090 ConstantInt *ShiftedInt;
3091 if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_ConstantInt(ShiftedInt), m_Value()), *Context) &&
3092 ShiftedInt->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3093 // X sdiv (1 << Y) -> X udiv (1 << Y) ( -> X u>> Y)
3094 // Safe because the only negative value (1 << Y) can take on is
3095 // INT_MIN, and X sdiv INT_MIN == X udiv INT_MIN == 0 if X doesn't have
3096 // the sign bit set.
3097 return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
3098 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003099 }
Eli Friedman8be17392009-07-18 09:53:21 +00003100 }
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00003101
3102 return 0;
3103}
3104
3105Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
3106 return commonDivTransforms(I);
3107}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003108
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003109/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
3110/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
3111/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
3112/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
3113Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003114 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003115
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003116 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
3117 if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
3118 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003119 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner50b2ca42008-02-19 06:12:18 +00003120 }
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003121 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
3122 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003123
3124 // Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
Chris Lattnerfdb19e52008-07-14 00:15:52 +00003125 if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
3126 return &I;
Chris Lattner5b73c082004-07-06 07:01:22 +00003127
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003128 return 0;
3129}
3130
3131/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
3132/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
3133/// remainder instructions.
3134/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
3135Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
3136 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3137
3138 if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
3139 return common;
3140
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003141 // 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
3142 if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
3143 if (LHS->isNullValue())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003144 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Dale Johannesened6af242009-01-21 00:35:19 +00003145
Chris Lattner857e8cd2004-12-12 21:48:58 +00003146 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003147 // X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
3148 if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003149 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getUndef(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner19ccd5c2006-02-28 05:30:45 +00003150
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003151 if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003152 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003153
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003154 if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
3155 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
3156 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
3157 return R;
3158 } else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
3159 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
3160 return NV;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003161 }
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003162
3163 // See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00003164 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Nick Lewyckyc1a2a612008-03-06 06:48:30 +00003165 return &I;
Chris Lattner97943922006-02-28 05:49:21 +00003166 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00003167 }
3168
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003169 return 0;
3170}
3171
3172Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3173 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3174
3175 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3176 return common;
3177
3178 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
3179 // X urem C^2 -> X and C
3180 // Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
3181 // if so, convert to a bitwise and.
3182 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003183 if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003184 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C, Context));
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003185 }
3186
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003187 if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003188 // Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
3189 if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
3190 isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
Zhou Sheng0fc50952007-03-25 05:01:29 +00003191 if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00003192 Constant *N1 = Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003193 Value *Add = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(RHSI, N1,
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003194 "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003195 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003196 }
3197 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003198 }
Chris Lattner8e49e082006-09-09 20:26:32 +00003199
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003200 // urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
3201 // where C1&C2 are powers of two.
3202 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
3203 if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
3204 if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
3205 // STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
Reid Spencerbca0e382007-03-23 20:05:17 +00003206 if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
3207 (SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003208 Value *TrueAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003209 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO, Context),
3210 SI->getName()+".t"), I);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003211 Value *FalseAnd = InsertNewInstBefore(
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003212 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO, Context),
3213 SI->getName()+".f"), I);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00003214 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003215 }
3216 }
Chris Lattner5f3b0ee2006-02-05 07:54:04 +00003217 }
3218
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00003219 return 0;
3220}
3221
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003222Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
3223 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
3224
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003225 // Handle the integer rem common cases
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003226 if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
3227 return common;
3228
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003229 if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1, Context))
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00003230 if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
3231 (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
3232 cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003233 // X % -Y -> X % Y
3234 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
3235 I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
3236 return &I;
3237 }
Nick Lewyckya06cf822008-09-30 06:08:34 +00003238
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003239 // If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003240 // unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003241 if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
3242 APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
3243 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
3244 // X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003245 return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
Dan Gohmancff55092007-11-05 23:16:33 +00003246 }
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003247 }
3248
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003249 // If it's a constant vector, flip any negative values positive.
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003250 if (ConstantVector *RHSV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
3251 unsigned VWidth = RHSV->getNumOperands();
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003252
Nick Lewycky9dce8732008-12-20 16:48:00 +00003253 bool hasNegative = false;
3254 for (unsigned i = 0; !hasNegative && i != VWidth; ++i)
3255 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i)))
3256 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
3257 hasNegative = true;
3258
3259 if (hasNegative) {
3260 std::vector<Constant *> Elts(VWidth);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003261 for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
3262 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i))) {
3263 if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003264 Elts[i] = cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(RHS));
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003265 else
3266 Elts[i] = RHS;
3267 }
3268 }
3269
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003270 Constant *NewRHSV = Context->getConstantVector(Elts);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003271 if (NewRHSV != RHSV) {
Nick Lewycky19c28922008-12-18 06:42:28 +00003272 AddUsesToWorkList(I);
Nick Lewycky2a8f6592008-12-18 06:31:11 +00003273 I.setOperand(1, NewRHSV);
3274 return &I;
3275 }
3276 }
3277 }
3278
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003279 return 0;
3280}
3281
3282Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
Reid Spencer0a783f72006-11-02 01:53:59 +00003283 return commonRemTransforms(I);
3284}
3285
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003286// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
3287// constant.
3288static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Reid Spencer5f6a8952007-03-20 00:16:52 +00003289 return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003290}
3291
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003292// isHighOnes - Return true if the constant is of the form 1+0+.
3293// This is the same as lowones(~X).
3294static bool isHighOnes(const ConstantInt *CI) {
Zhou Sheng2cde46c2007-03-20 12:49:06 +00003295 return (~CI->getValue() + 1).isPowerOf2();
Chris Lattnerb20ba0a2004-09-23 21:46:38 +00003296}
3297
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003298/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003299/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
3300///
3301/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
3302///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003303/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
3304/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003305///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003306/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
3307/// 0 A > B
3308/// 1 A == B
3309/// 2 A < B
3310///
3311/// <=> Value Definition
3312/// 000 0 Always false
3313/// 001 1 A > B
3314/// 010 2 A == B
3315/// 011 3 A >= B
3316/// 100 4 A < B
3317/// 101 5 A != B
3318/// 110 6 A <= B
3319/// 111 7 Always true
3320///
3321static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
3322 switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003323 // False -> 0
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003324 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3325 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
3326 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
3327 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3328 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
3329 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
3330 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
3331 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
3332 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
3333 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003334 // True -> 7
3335 default:
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003336 llvm_unreachable("Invalid ICmp predicate!");
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003337 return 0;
3338 }
3339}
3340
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003341/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
3342/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
3343/// predicate by reference.
3344static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
3345 isOrdered = false;
3346 switch (CC) {
3347 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
3348 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003349 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
3350 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
3351 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
3352 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003353 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
3354 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
3355 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
3356 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003357 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
3358 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003359 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
3360 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
Evan Cheng40300622008-10-14 18:44:08 +00003361 // True -> 7
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003362 default:
3363 // Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003364 llvm_unreachable("Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003365 return 0;
3366 }
3367}
3368
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003369/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
3370/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
Dan Gohman5d066ff2007-09-17 17:31:57 +00003371/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003372/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003373static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003374 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003375 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003376 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal ICmp code!");
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00003377 case 0: return Context->getFalse();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003378 case 1:
3379 if (sign)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003380 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003381 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003382 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
3383 case 2: return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003384 case 3:
3385 if (sign)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003386 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003387 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003388 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003389 case 4:
3390 if (sign)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003391 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003392 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003393 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
3394 case 5: return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003395 case 6:
3396 if (sign)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003397 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003398 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003399 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00003400 case 7: return Context->getTrue();
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003401 }
3402}
3403
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003404/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
3405/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
3406/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
3407static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00003408 Value *LHS, Value *RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003409 switch (code) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003410 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal FCmp code!");
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003411 case 0:
3412 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003413 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003414 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003415 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003416 case 1:
3417 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003418 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003419 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003420 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003421 case 2:
3422 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003423 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003424 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003425 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003426 case 3:
3427 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003428 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003429 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003430 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003431 case 4:
3432 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003433 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003434 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003435 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003436 case 5:
3437 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003438 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003439 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003440 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng4990b252008-10-14 18:13:38 +00003441 case 6:
3442 if (isordered)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003443 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003444 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003445 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00003446 case 7: return Context->getTrue();
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00003447 }
3448}
3449
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003450/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
3451/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003452static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
3453 return (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) == ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2)) ||
Chris Lattnerb9553d62008-11-16 04:55:20 +00003454 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
3455 (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003456}
3457
3458namespace {
3459// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
3460struct FoldICmpLogical {
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003461 InstCombiner &IC;
3462 Value *LHS, *RHS;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003463 ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
3464 FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
3465 : IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
3466 pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003467 bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003468 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
3469 if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00003470 return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
3471 (ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003472 return false;
3473 }
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003474 Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
3475 ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
3476 if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
3477 assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
3478 ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003479 }
3480
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003481 ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003482 unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003483 unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003484 unsigned Code;
3485 switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
3486 case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
3487 case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
3488 case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003489 default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003490 }
3491
Chris Lattnerbc1dbfc2007-03-13 14:27:42 +00003492 bool isSigned = ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSICI->getPredicate()) ||
3493 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
3494
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003495 Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS, IC.getContext());
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003496 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
3497 return I;
3498 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
3499 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
3500 }
3501};
Chris Lattnerd23b5ba2006-11-15 04:53:24 +00003502} // end anonymous namespace
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00003503
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003504// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
3505// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003506// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003507Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003508 ConstantInt *OpRHS,
3509 ConstantInt *AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003510 BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
3511 Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner76f7fe22004-01-12 19:47:05 +00003512 Constant *Together = 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003513 if (!Op->isShift())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003514 Together = Context->getConstantExprAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00003515
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003516 switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
3517 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003518 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003519 // (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003520 Instruction *And = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003521 InsertNewInstBefore(And, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003522 And->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003523 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003524 }
3525 break;
3526 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003527 if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
3528 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003529
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003530 if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
3531 // (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003532 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, Together);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00003533 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003534 Or->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003535 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003536 }
3537 break;
3538 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattnerfd059242003-10-15 16:48:29 +00003539 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003540 // Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
3541 // of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
3542 // single bit constant.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003543 const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003544
3545 // If there is only one bit set...
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00003546 if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003547 // Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
3548 // ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
3549 // no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003550 const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003551
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003552 // Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
3553 if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
3554 // If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
3555 // the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
3556 // the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
3557 // no effect.
3558 if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
3559 TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
3560 return &TheAnd;
3561 } else {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003562 // Pull the XOR out of the AND.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003563 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003564 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, TheAnd);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00003565 NewAnd->takeName(Op);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003566 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003567 }
3568 }
3569 }
3570 }
3571 break;
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003572
3573 case Instruction::Shl: {
3574 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3575 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
3576 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003577 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003578 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003579 APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003580 ConstantInt *CI = Context->getConstantInt(AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003581
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003582 if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
3583 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003584 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
3585 } else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003586 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
3587 return &TheAnd;
3588 }
3589 break;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003590 }
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003591 case Instruction::LShr:
3592 {
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003593 // We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
3594 // the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
3595 // unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
3596 //
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003597 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003598 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003599 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003600 ConstantInt *CI = Context->getConstantInt(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003601
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003602 if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
3603 // Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003604 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
3605 } else if (CI != AndRHS) {
3606 TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
3607 return &TheAnd;
3608 }
3609 break;
3610 }
3611 case Instruction::AShr:
3612 // Signed shr.
3613 // See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
3614 // with an and.
3615 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003616 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00003617 uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003618 APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003619 Constant *C = Context->getConstantInt(AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
Reid Spencer7eb76382006-12-13 17:19:09 +00003620 if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00003621 // (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00003622 // Make the argument unsigned.
3623 Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003624 ShVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003625 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00003626 Op->getName()), TheAnd);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003627 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
Chris Lattner0c967662004-09-24 15:21:34 +00003628 }
Chris Lattner62a355c2003-09-19 19:05:02 +00003629 }
3630 break;
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00003631 }
3632 return 0;
3633}
3634
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00003635
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003636/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
3637/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003638/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
3639/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003640/// insert new instructions.
3641Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003642 bool isSigned, bool Inside,
3643 Instruction &IB) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003644 assert(cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprICmp((isSigned ?
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00003645 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003646 "Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003647
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003648 if (Inside) {
3649 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003650 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00003651
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003652 // V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003653 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003654 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003655 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003656 return new ICmpInst(*Context, pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003657 }
3658
3659 // Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003660 Constant *NegLo = Context->getConstantExprNeg(Lo);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003661 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003662 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003663 Constant *UpperBound = Context->getConstantExprAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003664 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003665 }
3666
3667 if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003668 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003669
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003670 // V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003671 Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi), Context);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003672 if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003673 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
3674 ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003675 return new ICmpInst(*Context, pred, V, Hi);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00003676 }
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00003677
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00003678 // Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
3679 // Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003680 ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(Lo));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003681 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003682 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, IB);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003683 Constant *LowerBound = Context->getConstantExprAdd(NegLo, Hi);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003684 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00003685}
3686
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003687// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
3688// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
3689// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
3690// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003691static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00003692 const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003693 uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
3694 if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003695
3696 // look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003697 MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003698 // look for the first non-zero bit
Reid Spencerf2442522007-03-24 00:42:08 +00003699 ME = V.getActiveBits();
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003700 return true;
3701}
3702
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003703/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
3704/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
3705/// the following xforms:
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003706///
3707/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
3708/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3709/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
3710///
3711/// return (A +/- B).
3712///
3713Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00003714 ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003715 Instruction &I) {
3716 Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
3717 if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
3718 !isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
3719
3720 ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
3721
3722 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
3723 default: return 0;
3724 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003725 if (Context->getConstantExprAnd(N, Mask) == Mask) {
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003726 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003727 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3728 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
3729 Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003730 break;
3731
3732 // Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
3733 // part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
3734 // is all N is, ignore it.
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00003735 uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003736 if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
Reid Spencerb35ae032007-03-23 18:46:34 +00003737 uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
Zhou Sheng290bec52007-03-29 08:15:12 +00003738 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00003739 if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003740 break;
3741 }
3742 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003743 return 0;
3744 case Instruction::Or:
3745 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00003746 // If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
Zhou Sheng00f436c2007-03-24 15:34:37 +00003747 if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
3748 Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003749 && Context->getConstantExprAnd(N, Mask)->isNullValue())
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003750 break;
3751 return 0;
3752 }
3753
3754 Instruction *New;
3755 if (isSub)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003756 New = BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003757 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00003758 New = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00003759 return InsertNewInstBefore(New, I);
3760}
3761
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003762/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
3763Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
3764 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003765 Value *Val, *Val2;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003766 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
3767 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
3768
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003769 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00003770 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
3771 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst)), *Context) ||
3772 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
3773 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst)), *Context))
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003774 return 0;
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003775
3776 // (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
3777 // where C is a power of 2
3778 if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC && LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
3779 LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
3780 Instruction *NewOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Val, Val2);
3781 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOr, I);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003782 return new ICmpInst(*Context, LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
Chris Lattnerea065fb2008-11-16 05:10:52 +00003783 }
3784
3785 // From here on, we only handle:
3786 // (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
3787 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
3788
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003789 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
3790 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3791 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
3792 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
3793 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
3794 return 0;
3795
3796 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
3797 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
3798 return 0;
3799
3800 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003801 bool ShouldSwap;
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003802 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
3803 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
3804 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003805 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003806 else
Chris Lattneraa3e1572008-11-16 05:14:43 +00003807 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
3808
3809 if (ShouldSwap) {
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003810 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3811 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
3812 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
3813 }
3814
3815 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
3816 // comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
3817 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
3818 // icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
3819 // (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
3820 // are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
3821 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
3822
3823 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003824 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003825 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
3826 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003827 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003828 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
3829 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
3830 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00003831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003832 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
3833 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3834 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
3835 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3836 }
3837 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
3838 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003839 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003840 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003841 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst, Context)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003842 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003843 break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3844 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003845 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst, Context)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003846 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003847 break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3848 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3849 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3850 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3851 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3852 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003853 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst, Context)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
3854 Constant *AddCST = Context->getConstantExprNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003855 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
3856 Val->getName()+".off");
3857 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003858 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003859 Context->getConstantInt(Add->getType(), 1));
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003860 }
3861 break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
3862 }
3863 break;
3864 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
3865 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003866 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003867 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3868 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00003869 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003870 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3871 break;
3872 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
3873 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
3874 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3875 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3876 break;
3877 }
3878 break;
3879 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
3880 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003881 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003882 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
3883 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00003884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003885 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3886 break;
3887 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
3888 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
3889 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3890 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3891 break;
3892 }
3893 break;
3894 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
3895 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003896 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003897 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3898 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
3899 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3900 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
3901 break;
3902 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003903 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst, Context)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003904 return new ICmpInst(*Context, LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003905 break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003906 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003907 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst, Context),
3908 RHSCst, false, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003909 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
3910 break;
3911 }
3912 break;
3913 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
3914 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00003915 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003916 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
3917 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
3918 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3919 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
3920 break;
3921 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003922 if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst, Context)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00003923 return new ICmpInst(*Context, LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003924 break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00003925 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00003926 return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst, Context),
3927 RHSCst, true, true, I);
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003928 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
3929 break;
3930 }
3931 break;
3932 }
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00003933
3934 return 0;
3935}
3936
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003937Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
3938 FCmpInst *RHS) {
3939
3940 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
3941 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
3942 // (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
3943 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
3944 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
3945 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
3946 // false.
3947 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
3948 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
3949 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
3950 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
3951 }
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00003952
3953 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
3954 // "fcmp ord x,x" is "fcmp ord x, 0".
3955 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
3956 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
3957 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
3958 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00003959 return 0;
3960 }
3961
3962 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
3963 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
3964 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
3965
3966
3967 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
3968 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
3969 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
3970 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
3971 }
3972
3973 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
3974 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
3975 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
3976 return new FCmpInst(*Context, (FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
3977
3978 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
3979 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
3980 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
3981 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3982 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
3983 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
3984
3985 bool Op0Ordered;
3986 bool Op1Ordered;
3987 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
3988 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
3989 if (Op1Pred == 0) {
3990 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
3991 std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
3992 std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
3993 }
3994 if (Op0Pred == 0) {
3995 // uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
3996 // ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
3997 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
3998 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
3999
4000 // uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
4001 // uno && ord -> false
4002 if (!Op0Ordered)
4003 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
4004 // ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
4005 return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred,
4006 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context));
4007 }
4008 }
4009
4010 return 0;
4011}
4012
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004013
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004014Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004015 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004016 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004017
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004018 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X & undef -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004019 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004020
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004021 // and X, X = X
4022 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004023 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004024
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004025 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +00004026 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004027 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4028 return &I;
4029 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00004030 if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004031 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X & <-1,-1> -> X
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00004032 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004033 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4034 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X & <0,0> -> <0,0>
Chris Lattner696ee0a2007-01-18 22:16:33 +00004035 }
4036 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004037
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004038 if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00004039 const APInt& AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
4040 APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004041
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004042 // Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004043 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004044 Instruction *Op0I = cast<Instruction>(Op0);
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004045 Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
4046 Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
4047 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
4048 case Instruction::Xor:
4049 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004050 // If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
4051 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4052 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4053 // Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004054 Instruction *NewRHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004055 Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
4056 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004057 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004058 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00004059 }
Chris Lattner3bedbd92006-02-07 07:27:52 +00004060 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004061 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
4062 // Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004063 Instruction *NewLHS = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004064 Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
4065 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004066 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattnerad1e3022005-01-23 20:26:55 +00004067 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0I)->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
4068 }
4069 }
4070
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004071 break;
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004072 case Instruction::Add:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004073 // ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4074 // ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4075 // ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4076 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004077 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004078 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004079 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004080 break;
4081
4082 case Instruction::Sub:
Chris Lattner7203e152005-09-18 07:22:02 +00004083 // ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
4084 // ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4085 // ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
4086 if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004087 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004088
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004089 // (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
4090 // has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
4091 if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
4092 uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
4093 uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
4094 APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
4095
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004096 ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
Nick Lewycky5dcc41f2008-07-10 05:51:40 +00004097 if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
4098 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00004099 Instruction *NewNeg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, Op0RHS);
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004100 InsertNewInstBefore(NewNeg, I);
4101 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
4102 }
4103 }
Chris Lattnerc8e77562005-09-18 04:24:45 +00004104 break;
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004105
4106 case Instruction::Shl:
4107 case Instruction::LShr:
4108 // (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
4109 // (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
Nick Lewyckyd8ad4922008-07-09 07:35:26 +00004110 if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00004111 Instruction *NewICmp = new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
4112 Op0RHS, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Nick Lewyckyd1f77bf2008-07-09 05:20:13 +00004113 InsertNewInstBefore(NewICmp, I);
4114 return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
4115 }
4116 break;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004117 }
4118
Chris Lattner58403262003-07-23 19:25:52 +00004119 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004120 if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
Chris Lattnerbd7b5ff2003-09-19 17:17:26 +00004121 return Res;
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004122 } else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004123 // If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
4124 // if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
4125 // frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
4126 if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004127 if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004128 CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004129 if (ConstantInt *AndCI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004130 if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
4131 // Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004132 // into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
4133 // This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
4134 // other simplifications.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004135 Instruction *NewCast = CastInst::CreateTruncOrBitCast(
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +00004136 CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
4137 CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004138 NewCast = InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, I);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00004139 // trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004140 Constant *C3 =
4141 Context->getConstantExprTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
4142 C3 = Context->getConstantExprAnd(C3, AndRHS);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004143 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004144 } else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4145 // Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
4146 // into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004147 Constant *C3 =
4148 Context->getConstantExprTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
4149 if (Context->getConstantExprAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS)
4150 // trunc(C1)&C2
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004151 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
4152 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00004153 }
Chris Lattner2b83af22005-08-07 07:03:10 +00004154 }
Chris Lattner06782f82003-07-23 19:36:21 +00004155 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004156
4157 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4158 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004159 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004160 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004161 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4162 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4163 return NV;
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00004164 }
4165
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004166 Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0, Context);
4167 Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1, Context);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004168
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004169 if (Op0NotVal == Op1 || Op1NotVal == Op0) // A & ~A == ~A & A == 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004170 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner5b62aa72004-06-18 06:07:51 +00004171
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004172 // (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattner8d969642003-03-10 23:06:50 +00004173 if (Op0NotVal && Op1NotVal && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004174 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +00004175 I.getName()+".demorgan");
Chris Lattnerc6a8aff2003-07-23 17:57:01 +00004176 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00004177 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Or);
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004178 }
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004179
4180 {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004181 Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004182 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004183 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A | ?) & A --> A
4184 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004185
4186 // (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004187 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004188 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004189 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004190 }
4191 }
4192
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004193 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004194 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A & (A | ?) --> A
4195 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004196
4197 // ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004198 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D))), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004199 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004200 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner003b6202007-06-15 05:58:24 +00004201 }
4202 }
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004203
4204 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004205 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004206 if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
4207 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4208 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4209 } else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
4210 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
4211 I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
4212 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
4213 }
4214 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004215
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004216 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004217 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004218 if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
4219 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
4220 std::swap(A, B);
4221 }
4222 if (A == Op0) { // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00004223 Instruction *NotB = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, B, "tmp");
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004224 InsertNewInstBefore(NotB, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004225 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00004226 }
4227 }
Bill Wendling7f0ef6b2008-11-30 13:08:13 +00004228
4229 // (A&((~A)|B)) -> A&B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004230 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)), m_Value(A)), *Context) ||
4231 match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op1))), *Context))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004232 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op1);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004233 if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)), m_Value(A)), *Context) ||
4234 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op0))), *Context))
Chris Lattnerd8aafcb2008-12-01 05:16:26 +00004235 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner2082ad92006-02-13 23:07:23 +00004236 }
4237
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004238 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
4239 // (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004240 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS),Context))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004241 return R;
4242
Chris Lattner29cd5ba2008-11-16 05:06:21 +00004243 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
4244 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4245 return Res;
Chris Lattner955f3312004-09-28 21:48:02 +00004246 }
4247
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004248 // fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004249 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
4250 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
4251 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
4252 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004253 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
4254 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004255 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004256 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4257 I.getType(), TD) &&
4258 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4259 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004260 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004261 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4262 I.getName());
4263 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004264 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004265 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004266 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004267
4268 // (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004269 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4270 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4271 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004272 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4273 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4274 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004275 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004276 SI1->getOperand(0),
4277 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004278 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004279 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004280 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004281 }
4282
Evan Cheng8db90722008-10-14 17:15:11 +00004283 // If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004284 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner42d1be02009-07-23 05:14:02 +00004285 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
4286 if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4287 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004288 }
Nick Lewyckyb4d1bc92008-07-09 04:32:37 +00004289
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004290 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004291}
4292
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004293/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
4294/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
4295/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
4296/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
4297/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
4298/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
4299/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
4300/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
4301/// match.
4302///
4303/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
4304/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
4305/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
4306/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
4307/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
4308/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
4309///
4310/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
4311/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
4312/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
4313/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
4314/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
4315///
4316static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
4317 SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
4318 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
4319 // If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
4320 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
4321 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4322 ByteValues) ||
4323 CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4324 ByteValues);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004325 }
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004326
4327 // If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
4328 // OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
4329 if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4330 unsigned ShAmt =
4331 cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
4332 // Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
4333 if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
4334 return true;
4335
4336 unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
4337 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
4338 // X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
4339 OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
4340 ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
4341 } else {
4342 // X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
4343 OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
4344 ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
Chris Lattnerde17ddc2008-10-08 06:42:28 +00004345 ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004346 }
4347
4348 if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4349 if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
4350
4351 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4352 ByteValues);
4353 }
4354
4355 // If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
4356 // corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
4357 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
4358 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
4359 // Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
4360 unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
4361 APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
4362 const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
4363
4364 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
4365 // If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
4366 // the and mask is.
4367 if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
4368 continue;
4369
4370 // If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
4371 APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
4372 if (MaskB == 0) {
4373 ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
4374 continue;
4375 }
4376
4377 // If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
4378 if (MaskB != Byte)
4379 return true;
4380
4381 // Otherwise, this byte is kept.
4382 }
4383
4384 return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
4385 ByteValues);
4386 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004387 }
4388
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004389 // Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
4390 // the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
4391 // is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
4392 // into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
4393 // their ultimate destination.
4394 if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
4395 unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004396
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004397 // 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
4398 // is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
4399 // byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
4400 // shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
4401 // part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
4402 // low part, it must be shifted left.
4403 unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
4404 if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
4405 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4406 return true;
4407 } else {
4408 if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
4409 return true;
4410 }
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004411
4412 // If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
4413 // together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004414 if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004415 return true;
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004416 ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004417 return false;
4418}
4419
4420/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
4421/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
4422Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004423 const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004424 if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
4425 // ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
4426 ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004427 return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004428
4429 /// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
4430 /// defines each byte.
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00004431 SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
Chris Lattner55fc8c42007-04-01 20:57:36 +00004432 ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004433
4434 // Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
Chris Lattner8c34cd22008-10-05 02:13:19 +00004435 uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
4436 if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004437 return 0;
4438
4439 // Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
4440 Value *V = ByteValues[0];
4441 if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
4442
4443 // Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
4444 for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
4445 if (ByteValues[i] != V)
4446 return 0;
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004447 const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004448 Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chandler Carruth69940402007-08-04 01:51:18 +00004449 Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00004450 return CallInst::Create(F, V);
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004451}
4452
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004453/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
4454/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
4455/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
4456static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004457 Value *C, Value *D,
4458 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004459 // If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
Chris Lattner6046fb72008-11-16 04:46:19 +00004460 Value *Cond = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004461 if (!match(A, m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Value(Cond)), *Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004462 return 0;
4463
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004464 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004465 if (match(D, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond)), *Context))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004466 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004467 if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond))), *Context))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004468 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
4469 // ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004470 if (match(B, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond)), *Context))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004471 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004472 if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond))), *Context))
Chris Lattnera6a474d2008-11-16 04:26:55 +00004473 return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004474 return 0;
4475}
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004476
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004477/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
4478Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
4479 ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
4480 Value *Val, *Val2;
4481 ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
4482 ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
4483
4484 // This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004485 if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
4486 m_ConstantInt(LHSCst)), *Context) ||
4487 !match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
4488 m_ConstantInt(RHSCst)), *Context))
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004489 return 0;
4490
4491 // From here on, we only handle:
4492 // (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
4493 if (Val != Val2) return 0;
4494
4495 // ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
4496 if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4497 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
4498 LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
4499 RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
4500 return 0;
4501
4502 // We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
4503 if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
4504 return 0;
4505
4506 // Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
4507 bool ShouldSwap;
4508 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(LHSCC) ||
4509 (ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
4510 ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(RHSCC)))
4511 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
4512 else
4513 ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
4514
4515 if (ShouldSwap) {
4516 std::swap(LHS, RHS);
4517 std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
4518 std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
4519 }
4520
4521 // At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
4522 // comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
4523 // together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
4524 // ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
4525 // FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
4526 // equal.
4527 assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
4528
4529 switch (LHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004530 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004531 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
4532 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004533 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004534 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004535 if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst, Context)) {
4536 // (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
4537 Constant *AddCST = Context->getConstantExprNeg(LHSCst);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004538 Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Val, AddCST,
4539 Val->getName()+".off");
4540 InsertNewInstBefore(Add, I);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004541 AddCST = Context->getConstantExprSub(AddOne(RHSCst, Context), LHSCst);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00004542 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004543 }
4544 break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
4545 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
4546 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
4547 break;
4548 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4549 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4550 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4551 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4552 }
4553 break;
4554 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
4555 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004556 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004557 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
4558 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
4559 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
4560 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4561 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
4562 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
4563 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00004564 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004565 }
4566 break;
4567 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
4568 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004569 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004570 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4571 break;
4572 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
4573 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4574 // this can cause overflow.
4575 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
4576 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004577 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst, Context),
4578 false, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004579 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4580 break;
4581 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4582 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
4583 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4584 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4585 break;
4586 }
4587 break;
4588 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
4589 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004590 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004591 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
4592 break;
4593 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
4594 // If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
4595 // this can cause overflow.
4596 if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
4597 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004598 return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst, Context),
4599 true, false, I);
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004600 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4601 break;
4602 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
4603 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
4604 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4605 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4606 break;
4607 }
4608 break;
4609 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
4610 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004611 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004612 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
4613 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
4614 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4615 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
4616 break;
4617 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4618 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00004619 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004620 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
4621 break;
4622 }
4623 break;
4624 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
4625 switch (RHSCC) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00004626 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004627 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
4628 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
4629 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4630 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
4631 break;
4632 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
4633 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00004634 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004635 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
4636 break;
4637 }
4638 break;
4639 }
4640 return 0;
4641}
4642
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00004643Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
4644 FCmpInst *RHS) {
4645 if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4646 RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
4647 LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
4648 if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
4649 if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
4650 // If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
4651 // true.
4652 if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
4653 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
4654
4655 // Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
4656 // rest.
4657 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
4658 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4659 }
4660
4661 // Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
4662 // "fcmp uno x,x" is "fcmp uno x, 0".
4663 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
4664 isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
4665 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
4666 LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
4667
4668 return 0;
4669 }
4670
4671 Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
4672 Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
4673 FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
4674
4675 if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
4676 // Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
4677 Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
4678 std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
4679 }
4680 if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
4681 // Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
4682 if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
4683 return new FCmpInst(*Context, (FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC,
4684 Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
4685 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
4686 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
4687 if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4688 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
4689 if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
4690 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
4691 bool Op0Ordered;
4692 bool Op1Ordered;
4693 unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
4694 unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
4695 if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
4696 // If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
4697 // or'ed predicates.
4698 Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred,
4699 Op0LHS, Op0RHS, Context);
4700 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
4701 return I;
4702 // Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
4703 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
4704 }
4705 }
4706 return 0;
4707}
4708
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004709/// FoldOrWithConstants - This helper function folds:
4710///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004711/// ((A | B) & C1) | (B & C2)
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004712///
4713/// into:
4714///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004715/// (A & C1) | B
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004716///
Bill Wendlinga8bb13f2008-12-02 05:09:00 +00004717/// when the XOR of the two constants is "all ones" (-1).
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004718Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004719 Value *A, Value *B, Value *C) {
Bill Wendlingdda74e02008-12-02 05:06:43 +00004720 ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4721 if (!CI1) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004722
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004723 Value *V1 = 0;
4724 ConstantInt *CI2 = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004725 if (!match(Op, m_And(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CI2)), *Context)) return 0;
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004726
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004727 APInt Xor = CI1->getValue() ^ CI2->getValue();
4728 if (!Xor.isAllOnesValue()) return 0;
4729
Bill Wendling286a0542008-12-02 06:24:20 +00004730 if (V1 == A || V1 == B) {
Bill Wendling29976b92008-12-02 06:18:11 +00004731 Instruction *NewOp =
Bill Wendlingd16c6e92008-12-02 06:22:04 +00004732 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd((V1 == A) ? B : A, CI1), I);
4733 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NewOp, V1);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004734 }
4735
4736 return 0;
4737}
4738
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004739Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00004740 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00004741 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004742
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004743 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X | undef -> -1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00004745
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004746 // or X, X = X
4747 if (Op0 == Op1)
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00004748 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004749
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00004750 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
4751 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00004752 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
4753 return &I;
4754 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
4755 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1)) {
4756 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X | <0,0> -> X
4757 } else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
4758 if (CP->isAllOnesValue()) // X | <-1,-1> -> <-1,-1>
4759 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, I.getOperand(1));
4760 }
Chris Lattner42593e62007-03-24 23:56:43 +00004761 }
Chris Lattner041a6c92007-06-15 05:26:55 +00004762
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00004763 // or X, -1 == -1
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00004764 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004765 ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004766 // (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004767 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
4768 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004769 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004770 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004771 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004772 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004773 Context->getConstantInt(RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004774 }
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004775
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004776 // (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004777 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
4778 isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004779 Instruction *Or = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(X, RHS);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004780 InsertNewInstBefore(Or, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004781 Or->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004782 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004783 Context->getConstantInt(C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004784 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004785
4786 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
4787 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00004788 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00004789 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00004790 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
4791 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
4792 return NV;
Chris Lattnerad44ebf2003-07-23 18:29:44 +00004793 }
4794
Chris Lattner4f637d42006-01-06 17:59:59 +00004795 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
4796 ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004797
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004798 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004799 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) // (A & ?) | A --> A
4800 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004801 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context))
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004802 if (A == Op0 || B == Op0) // A | (A & ?) --> A
4803 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
4804
Chris Lattner6423d4c2006-07-10 20:25:24 +00004805 // (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
4806 // (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004807 if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value()), *Context) ||
4808 match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value()), *Context) ||
4809 (match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value()), *Context) &&
4810 match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value()), *Context))) {
Chris Lattnerafe91a52006-06-15 19:07:26 +00004811 if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
4812 return BSwap;
4813 }
4814
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004815 // (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004816 if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
4817 match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004818 MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004819 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op1);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004820 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4821 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004822 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004823 }
4824
4825 // Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004826 if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
4827 match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1)), *Context) &&
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00004828 MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004829 Instruction *NOr = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(A, Op0);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00004830 InsertNewInstBefore(NOr, I);
4831 NOr->takeName(Op0);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004832 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
Chris Lattner6e4c6492005-05-09 04:58:36 +00004833 }
4834
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004835 // (A & C)|(B & D)
Chris Lattner2384d7b2007-06-19 05:43:49 +00004836 Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004837 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C)), *Context) &&
4838 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004839 Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
4840 C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
4841 C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
4842 if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
4843 // If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
4844 // .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
4845 // replace with V+N.
4846 if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
4847 if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004848 match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004849 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4850 if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
4851 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4852 if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
4853 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
4854 }
4855 // Or commutes, try both ways.
4856 if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004857 match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004858 // Add commutes, try both ways.
4859 if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
4860 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4861 if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
4862 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
4863 }
4864 }
Chris Lattner044e5332007-04-08 08:01:49 +00004865 V1 = 0; V2 = 0; V3 = 0;
Chris Lattner6cae0e02007-04-08 07:55:22 +00004866 }
4867
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004868 // Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
4869 // terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004870 if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
4871 if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
4872 V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
4873 else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
4874 V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
4875 else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
4876 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
4877 else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
4878 V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
4879
4880 if (V1) {
4881 Value *Or =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004882 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp"), I);
4883 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
Chris Lattner0b7c0bf2005-09-18 06:02:59 +00004884 }
Chris Lattnerc5e7ea42007-04-08 07:47:01 +00004885 }
Dan Gohmanb493b272008-10-28 22:38:57 +00004886
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00004887 // (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004888 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004889 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004890 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004891 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004892 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004893 return Match;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004894 if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C, Context))
Chris Lattnerfaaf9512008-11-16 04:24:12 +00004895 return Match;
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004896
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004897 // ((A&~B)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004898 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(D)), *Context) &&
4899 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(A)), *Context)))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004900 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004901 // ((~B&A)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004902 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(D)), *Context) &&
4903 match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(C)), *Context)))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004904 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, D);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004905 // ((A&~B)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004906 if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(B)), *Context) &&
4907 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(A)), *Context)))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004908 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Bill Wendlingb01865c2008-11-30 13:52:49 +00004909 // ((~B&A)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004910 if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(B)), *Context) &&
4911 match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(C)), *Context)))
Bill Wendling03aae5f2008-12-01 08:09:47 +00004912 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, B);
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00004913 }
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004914
4915 // (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004916 if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
4917 if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
4918 if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004919 SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
4920 (SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
4921 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004922 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004923 SI1->getOperand(0),
4924 SI0->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004925 return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00004926 SI1->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnere511b742006-11-14 07:46:50 +00004927 }
4928 }
Chris Lattner67ca7682003-08-12 19:11:07 +00004929
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004930 // ((A|B)&1)|(B&-2) -> (A&1) | B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004931 if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C)), *Context) ||
4932 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))), *Context)) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004933 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op1, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004934 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004935 }
4936 // (B&-2)|((A|B)&1) -> (A&1) | B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004937 if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C)), *Context) ||
4938 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))), *Context)) {
Bill Wendlingd54d8602008-12-01 08:32:40 +00004939 Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op0, A, B, C);
Bill Wendlinga698a472008-12-01 08:23:25 +00004940 if (Ret) return Ret;
Bill Wendlingb3833d12008-12-01 01:07:11 +00004941 }
4942
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004943 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)), *Context)) { // ~A | Op1
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004944 if (A == Op1) // ~A | A == -1
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004945 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004946 } else {
4947 A = 0;
4948 }
Chris Lattnerf4d4c872005-05-07 23:49:08 +00004949 // Note, A is still live here!
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00004950 if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)), *Context)) { // Op0 | ~B
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004951 if (Op0 == B)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004952 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004953
Misha Brukmancb6267b2004-07-30 12:50:08 +00004954 // (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004955 if (A && isOnlyUse(Op0) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004956 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, B,
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004957 I.getName()+".demorgan"), I);
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00004958 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, And);
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +00004959 }
Chris Lattnera27231a2003-03-10 23:13:59 +00004960 }
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00004961
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00004962 // (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
4963 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00004964 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS),Context))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00004965 return R;
4966
Chris Lattner69d4ced2008-11-16 05:20:07 +00004967 if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
4968 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
4969 return Res;
Chris Lattnerb4f40d22004-09-28 22:33:08 +00004970 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004971
4972 // fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004973 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004974 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004975 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004976 if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
4977 !isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
4978 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnerf98d2532009-07-23 05:32:17 +00004979 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
4980 SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004981 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
4982 // generated.
4983 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
4984 I.getType(), TD) &&
4985 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
4986 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004987 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004988 Op1C->getOperand(0),
4989 I.getName());
4990 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00004991 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00004992 }
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00004993 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00004994 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00004995 }
4996
4997
4998 // (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
4999 if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner5414cc52009-07-23 05:46:22 +00005000 if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
5001 if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
5002 return Res;
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005003 }
Chris Lattnere9bed7d2005-09-18 03:42:07 +00005004
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005005 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005006}
5007
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005008namespace {
5009
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005010// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
5011struct XorSelf {
5012 Value *RHS;
5013 XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
5014 bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
5015 Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
5016 return &Xor;
5017 }
5018};
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005019
Dan Gohman844731a2008-05-13 00:00:25 +00005020}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005021
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005022Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4f98c562003-03-10 21:43:22 +00005023 bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005024 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005025
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005026 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
5027 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
5028 // Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
5029 // idiom (misuse).
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005030 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005031 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
Evan Chengd34af782008-03-25 20:07:13 +00005032 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005033
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005034 // xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005035 if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1), Context)) {
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +00005036 assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005037 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnerc317d392004-02-16 01:20:27 +00005038 }
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005039
5040 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
5041 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005042 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
5043 return &I;
5044 if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType()))
5045 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
5046 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005047
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005048 // Is this a ~ operation?
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005049 if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I, Context)) {
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005050 // ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5051 // ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
5052 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
5053 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
5054 Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005055 if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1), Context)) Op0I->swapOperands();
5056 if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0), Context)) {
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005057 Instruction *NotY =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00005058 BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Op0I->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005059 Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
5060 InsertNewInstBefore(NotY, I);
5061 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005062 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005063 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005064 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
Chris Lattner7cbe2eb2007-06-15 06:23:19 +00005065 }
5066 }
5067 }
5068 }
5069
5070
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00005071 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005072 if (RHS == Context->getTrue() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Bill Wendling3479be92009-01-01 01:18:23 +00005073 // xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005074 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005075 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI->getInversePredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005076 ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattnerad5b4fb2003-11-04 23:50:51 +00005077
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005078 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005079 return new FCmpInst(*Context, FCI->getInversePredicate(),
Nick Lewyckyf947b3e2007-08-06 20:04:16 +00005080 FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
5081 }
5082
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005083 // fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
5084 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
5085 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
5086 if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
5087 Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
5088 if (Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005089 if (RHS == Context->getConstantExprCast(Opcode,
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005090 Context->getTrue(),
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005091 Op0C->getDestTy())) {
5092 Instruction *NewCI = InsertNewInstBefore(CmpInst::Create(
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005093 *Context,
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005094 CI->getOpcode(), CI->getInversePredicate(),
5095 CI->getOperand(0), CI->getOperand(1)), I);
5096 NewCI->takeName(CI);
5097 return CastInst::Create(Opcode, NewCI, Op0C->getType());
5098 }
5099 }
5100 }
5101 }
5102 }
5103
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005104 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattnerd65460f2003-11-05 01:06:05 +00005105 // ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005106 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
5107 if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005108 Constant *NegOp0I0C = Context->getConstantExprNeg(Op0I0C);
5109 Constant *ConstantRHS = Context->getConstantExprSub(NegOp0I0C,
5110 Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005111 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005112 }
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005113
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005114 if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattnerf8c36f52006-02-12 08:02:11 +00005115 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
Chris Lattner689d24b2003-11-04 23:37:10 +00005116 // ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005117 if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005118 Constant *NegOp0CI = Context->getConstantExprNeg(Op0CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005119 return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005120 Context->getConstantExprSub(NegOp0CI,
5121 Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), 1)),
5122 Op0I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattneracf4e072007-04-02 05:42:22 +00005123 } else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner5c6e2db2007-04-02 05:36:22 +00005124 // (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005125 Constant *C =
5126 Context->getConstantInt(RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005127 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00005128
Chris Lattner7c4049c2004-01-12 19:35:11 +00005129 }
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005130 } else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
5131 // (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
Reid Spencera03d45f2007-03-22 22:19:58 +00005132 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005133 Constant *NewRHS = Context->getConstantExprOr(Op0CI, RHS);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005134 // Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
5135 // NewRHS.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005136 Constant *CommonBits = Context->getConstantExprAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
5137 NewRHS = Context->getConstantExprAnd(NewRHS,
5138 Context->getConstantExprNot(CommonBits));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +00005139 AddToWorkList(Op0I);
Chris Lattner02bd1b32006-02-26 19:57:54 +00005140 I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
5141 I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
5142 return &I;
5143 }
Chris Lattnereca0c5c2003-07-23 21:37:07 +00005144 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00005145 }
Chris Lattner05bd1b22002-08-20 18:24:26 +00005146 }
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005147
5148 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
5149 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00005150 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00005151 return R;
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00005152 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
5153 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5154 return NV;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005155 }
5156
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005157 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0, Context)) // ~A ^ A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005158 if (X == Op1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005159 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005160
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005161 if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1, Context)) // A ^ ~A == -1
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005162 if (X == Op0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnera2881962003-02-18 19:28:33 +00005164
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005165
5166 BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
5167 if (Op1I) {
5168 Value *A, *B;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005169 if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005170 if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005171 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005172 I.swapOperands();
5173 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005174 } else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005175 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005176 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005177 }
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005178 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005179 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // A^(A^B) == B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005180 } else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op0)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // A^(B^A) == B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005182 } else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5183 Op1I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005184 if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005185 Op1I->swapOperands();
Chris Lattner6abbdf92007-04-01 05:36:37 +00005186 std::swap(A, B);
5187 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005188 if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005189 I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
5190 std::swap(Op0, Op1);
5191 }
Chris Lattner26ca7e12004-02-16 03:54:20 +00005192 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005193 }
5194
5195 BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
5196 if (Op0I) {
5197 Value *A, *B;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005198 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5199 Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005200 if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
5201 std::swap(A, B);
5202 if (B == Op1) { // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
5203 Instruction *NotB =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00005204 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
5205 Op1, "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005206 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, NotB);
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005207 }
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005208 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005209 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // (A^B)^A == B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005210 } else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op1)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00005211 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // (B^A)^A == B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005212 } else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5213 Op0I->hasOneUse()){
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005214 if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
5215 std::swap(A, B);
5216 if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
Chris Lattnerae1ab392006-04-01 22:05:01 +00005217 !isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005218 Instruction *N =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00005219 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, A, "tmp"), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005220 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(N, Op1);
Chris Lattner64daab52006-04-01 08:03:55 +00005221 }
Chris Lattnercb40a372003-03-10 18:24:17 +00005222 }
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005223 }
5224
5225 // (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
5226 if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
5227 Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
5228 Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
5229 (Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
5230 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005231 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005232 Op1I->getOperand(0),
5233 Op0I->getName()), I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005234 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005235 Op1I->getOperand(1));
5236 }
5237
5238 if (Op0I && Op1I) {
5239 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
5240 // (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005241 if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5242 match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005243 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005244 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005245 }
5246 // (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005247 if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5248 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005249 if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005250 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005251 }
5252
5253 // (A & B)^(C & D)
5254 if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00005255 match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
5256 match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005257 // (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
5258 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
5259 if (A == C)
5260 X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
5261 else if (A == D)
5262 X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
5263 else if (B == C)
5264 X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
5265 else if (B == D)
5266 X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
5267
5268 if (X) {
5269 Instruction *NewOp =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005270 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName()), I);
5271 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
Chris Lattner318bf792007-03-18 22:51:34 +00005272 }
5273 }
5274 }
5275
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005276 // (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
5277 if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005278 if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS),Context))
Chris Lattneraa9c1f12003-08-13 20:16:26 +00005279 return R;
5280
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005281 // fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005282 if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005283 if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005284 if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
5285 const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00005286 if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005287 // Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005288 ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
5289 I.getType(), TD) &&
5290 ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
5291 I.getType(), TD)) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005292 Instruction *NewOp = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005293 Op1C->getOperand(0),
5294 I.getName());
5295 InsertNewInstBefore(NewOp, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005296 return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
Reid Spencer5ae9ceb2006-12-13 08:27:15 +00005297 }
Chris Lattner6fc205f2006-05-05 06:39:07 +00005298 }
Chris Lattner99c65742007-10-24 05:38:08 +00005299 }
Nick Lewycky517e1f52008-05-31 19:01:33 +00005300
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00005301 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005302}
5303
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005304static ConstantInt *ExtractElement(Constant *V, Constant *Idx,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005305 LLVMContext *Context) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005306 return cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprExtractElement(V, Idx));
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005307}
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005308
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005309static bool HasAddOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5310 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5311 bool IsSigned) {
Reid Spencere4e40032007-03-21 23:19:50 +00005312 if (IsSigned)
5313 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5314 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5315 else
5316 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5317 else
5318 return Result->getValue().ult(In1->getValue());
Chris Lattnera96879a2004-09-29 17:40:11 +00005319}
5320
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005321/// AddWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1+In2, returning true if the result
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005322/// overflowed for this type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005323static bool AddWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005324 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005325 bool IsSigned = false) {
5326 Result = Context->getConstantExprAdd(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005327
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005328 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5329 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005330 Constant *Idx = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i);
5331 if (HasAddOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5332 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5333 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005334 IsSigned))
5335 return true;
5336 }
5337 return false;
5338 }
5339
5340 return HasAddOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5341 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5342 IsSigned);
5343}
5344
5345static bool HasSubOverflow(ConstantInt *Result,
5346 ConstantInt *In1, ConstantInt *In2,
5347 bool IsSigned) {
Dan Gohman1df3fd62008-09-10 23:30:57 +00005348 if (IsSigned)
5349 if (In2->getValue().isNegative())
5350 return Result->getValue().slt(In1->getValue());
5351 else
5352 return Result->getValue().sgt(In1->getValue());
5353 else
5354 return Result->getValue().ugt(In1->getValue());
5355}
5356
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005357/// SubWithOverflow - Compute Result = In1-In2, returning true if the result
5358/// overflowed for this type.
5359static bool SubWithOverflow(Constant *&Result, Constant *In1,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005360 Constant *In2, LLVMContext *Context,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005361 bool IsSigned = false) {
5362 Result = Context->getConstantExprSub(In1, In2);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005363
5364 if (const VectorType *VTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(In1->getType())) {
5365 for (unsigned i = 0, e = VTy->getNumElements(); i != e; ++i) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005366 Constant *Idx = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i);
5367 if (HasSubOverflow(ExtractElement(Result, Idx, Context),
5368 ExtractElement(In1, Idx, Context),
5369 ExtractElement(In2, Idx, Context),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005370 IsSigned))
5371 return true;
5372 }
5373 return false;
5374 }
5375
5376 return HasSubOverflow(cast<ConstantInt>(Result),
5377 cast<ConstantInt>(In1), cast<ConstantInt>(In2),
5378 IsSigned);
5379}
5380
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005381/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
5382/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
5383/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
5384static Value *EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP, Instruction &I, InstCombiner &IC) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005385 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005386 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005387 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00005388 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005389 Value *Result = Context->getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005390
5391 // Build a mask for high order bits.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005392 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005393 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005394
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00005395 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
5396 ++i, ++GTI) {
5397 Value *Op = *i;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005398 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005399 if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
5400 if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
5401
5402 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5403 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5404 Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
5405
5406 if (ConstantInt *RC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Result))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005407 Result =
5408 Context->getConstantInt(RC->getValue() + APInt(IntPtrWidth, Size));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005409 else
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005410 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005411 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005412 Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, Size),
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005413 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
5414 continue;
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005415 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005416
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005417 Constant *Scale = Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, Size);
5418 Constant *OC =
5419 Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
5420 Scale = Context->getConstantExprMul(OC, Scale);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005421 if (Constant *RC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005422 Result = Context->getConstantExprAdd(RC, Scale);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005423 else {
5424 // Emit an add instruction.
5425 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005426 BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Result, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005427 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00005428 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005429 continue;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005430 }
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005431 // Convert to correct type.
5432 if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy) {
5433 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005434 Op = Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005435 else
Chris Lattner62ce3b32009-04-07 05:03:34 +00005436 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(Op, IntPtrTy,
5437 true,
5438 Op->getName()+".c"), I);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005439 }
5440 if (Size != 1) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005441 Constant *Scale = Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, Size);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005442 if (Constant *OpC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005443 Op = Context->getConstantExprMul(OpC, Scale);
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005444 else // We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005445 Op = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op, Scale,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005446 GEP->getName()+".idx"), I);
5447 }
5448
5449 // Emit an add instruction.
5450 if (isa<Constant>(Op) && isa<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005451 Result = Context->getConstantExprAdd(cast<Constant>(Op),
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005452 cast<Constant>(Result));
5453 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005454 Result = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op, Result,
Chris Lattnere62f0212007-04-28 04:52:43 +00005455 GEP->getName()+".offs"), I);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005456 }
5457 return Result;
5458}
5459
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005460
Dan Gohman8f080f02009-07-17 22:16:21 +00005461/// EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression - Return a value that can be used to compare
5462/// the *offset* implied by a GEP to zero. For example, if we have &A[i], we
5463/// want to return 'i' for "icmp ne i, 0". Note that, in general, indices can
5464/// be complex, and scales are involved. The above expression would also be
5465/// legal to codegen as "icmp ne (i*4), 0" (assuming A is a pointer to i32).
5466/// This later form is less amenable to optimization though, and we are allowed
5467/// to generate the first by knowing that pointer arithmetic doesn't overflow.
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005468///
5469/// If we can't emit an optimized form for this expression, this returns null.
5470///
5471static Value *EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(User *GEP, Instruction &I,
5472 InstCombiner &IC) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005473 TargetData &TD = *IC.getTargetData();
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005474 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
5475
5476 // Check to see if this gep only has a single variable index. If so, and if
5477 // any constant indices are a multiple of its scale, then we can compute this
5478 // in terms of the scale of the variable index. For example, if the GEP
5479 // implies an offset of "12 + i*4", then we can codegen this as "3 + i",
5480 // because the expression will cross zero at the same point.
5481 unsigned i, e = GEP->getNumOperands();
5482 int64_t Offset = 0;
5483 for (i = 1; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5484 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i))) {
5485 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5486 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5487
5488 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5489 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5490 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5491 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005492 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005493 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5494 }
5495 } else {
5496 // Found our variable index.
5497 break;
5498 }
5499 }
5500
5501 // If there are no variable indices, we must have a constant offset, just
5502 // evaluate it the general way.
5503 if (i == e) return 0;
5504
5505 Value *VariableIdx = GEP->getOperand(i);
5506 // Determine the scale factor of the variable element. For example, this is
5507 // 4 if the variable index is into an array of i32.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005508 uint64_t VariableScale = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005509
5510 // Verify that there are no other variable indices. If so, emit the hard way.
5511 for (++i, ++GTI; i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
5512 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(i));
5513 if (!CI) return 0;
5514
5515 // Compute the aggregate offset of constant indices.
5516 if (CI->isZero()) continue;
5517
5518 // Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
5519 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
5520 Offset += TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(CI->getZExtValue());
5521 } else {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00005522 uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType());
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005523 Offset += Size*CI->getSExtValue();
5524 }
5525 }
5526
5527 // Okay, we know we have a single variable index, which must be a
5528 // pointer/array/vector index. If there is no offset, life is simple, return
5529 // the index.
5530 unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
5531 if (Offset == 0) {
5532 // Cast to intptrty in case a truncation occurs. If an extension is needed,
5533 // we don't need to bother extending: the extension won't affect where the
5534 // computation crosses zero.
5535 if (VariableIdx->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() > IntPtrWidth)
5536 VariableIdx = new TruncInst(VariableIdx, TD.getIntPtrType(),
5537 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
5538 return VariableIdx;
5539 }
5540
5541 // Otherwise, there is an index. The computation we will do will be modulo
5542 // the pointer size, so get it.
5543 uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
5544
5545 Offset &= PtrSizeMask;
5546 VariableScale &= PtrSizeMask;
5547
5548 // To do this transformation, any constant index must be a multiple of the
5549 // variable scale factor. For example, we can evaluate "12 + 4*i" as "3 + i",
5550 // but we can't evaluate "10 + 3*i" in terms of i. Check that the offset is a
5551 // multiple of the variable scale.
5552 int64_t NewOffs = Offset / (int64_t)VariableScale;
5553 if (Offset != NewOffs*(int64_t)VariableScale)
5554 return 0;
5555
5556 // Okay, we can do this evaluation. Start by converting the index to intptr.
5557 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType();
5558 if (VariableIdx->getType() != IntPtrTy)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005559 VariableIdx = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(VariableIdx, IntPtrTy,
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005560 true /*SExt*/,
5561 VariableIdx->getNameStart(), &I);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005562 Constant *OffsetVal = IC.getContext()->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, NewOffs);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00005563 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(VariableIdx, OffsetVal, "offset", &I);
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005564}
5565
5566
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005567/// FoldGEPICmp - Fold comparisons between a GEP instruction and something
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005568/// else. At this point we know that the GEP is on the LHS of the comparison.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005569Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldGEPICmp(User *GEPLHS, Value *RHS,
5570 ICmpInst::Predicate Cond,
5571 Instruction &I) {
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005572 assert(dyn_castGetElementPtr(GEPLHS) && "LHS is not a getelementptr!");
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005573
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005574 // Look through bitcasts.
5575 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(RHS))
5576 RHS = BCI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005577
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005578 Value *PtrBase = GEPLHS->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005579 if (TD && PtrBase == RHS) {
Chris Lattner7c95deb2008-02-05 04:45:32 +00005580 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET) cmp Ptr) ---> (OFFSET cmp 0).
Chris Lattner10c0d912008-04-22 02:53:33 +00005581 // This transformation (ignoring the base and scales) is valid because we
5582 // know pointers can't overflow. See if we can output an optimized form.
5583 Value *Offset = EvaluateGEPOffsetExpression(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5584
5585 // If not, synthesize the offset the hard way.
5586 if (Offset == 0)
5587 Offset = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005588 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), Offset,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005589 Context->getNullValue(Offset->getType()));
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005590 } else if (User *GEPRHS = dyn_castGetElementPtr(RHS)) {
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005591 // If the base pointers are different, but the indices are the same, just
5592 // compare the base pointer.
5593 if (PtrBase != GEPRHS->getOperand(0)) {
5594 bool IndicesTheSame = GEPLHS->getNumOperands()==GEPRHS->getNumOperands();
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +00005595 IndicesTheSame &= GEPLHS->getOperand(0)->getType() ==
Chris Lattner93b94a62005-04-26 14:40:41 +00005596 GEPRHS->getOperand(0)->getType();
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005597 if (IndicesTheSame)
5598 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5599 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
5600 IndicesTheSame = false;
5601 break;
5602 }
5603
5604 // If all indices are the same, just compare the base pointers.
5605 if (IndicesTheSame)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005606 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005607 GEPLHS->getOperand(0), GEPRHS->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005608
5609 // Otherwise, the base pointers are different and the indices are
5610 // different, bail out.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005611 return 0;
Chris Lattnera70b66d2005-04-25 20:17:30 +00005612 }
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005613
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005614 // If one of the GEPs has all zero indices, recurse.
5615 bool AllZeros = true;
5616 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPLHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5617 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5618 !cast<Constant>(GEPLHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5619 AllZeros = false;
5620 break;
5621 }
5622 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005623 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPRHS, GEPLHS->getOperand(0),
5624 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Cond), I);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005625
5626 // If the other GEP has all zero indices, recurse.
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005627 AllZeros = true;
5628 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5629 if (!isa<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) ||
5630 !cast<Constant>(GEPRHS->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
5631 AllZeros = false;
5632 break;
5633 }
5634 if (AllZeros)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005635 return FoldGEPICmp(GEPLHS, GEPRHS->getOperand(0), Cond, I);
Chris Lattnere9d782b2005-01-13 22:25:21 +00005636
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005637 if (GEPLHS->getNumOperands() == GEPRHS->getNumOperands()) {
5638 // If the GEPs only differ by one index, compare it.
5639 unsigned NumDifferences = 0; // Keep track of # differences.
5640 unsigned DiffOperand = 0; // The operand that differs.
5641 for (unsigned i = 1, e = GEPRHS->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
5642 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i) != GEPRHS->getOperand(i)) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00005643 if (GEPLHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() !=
5644 GEPRHS->getOperand(i)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005645 // Irreconcilable differences.
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005646 NumDifferences = 2;
5647 break;
5648 } else {
5649 if (NumDifferences++) break;
5650 DiffOperand = i;
5651 }
5652 }
5653
5654 if (NumDifferences == 0) // SAME GEP?
5655 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, // No comparison is needed here.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005656 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005657 ICmpInst::isTrueWhenEqual(Cond)));
Nick Lewycky455e1762007-09-06 02:40:25 +00005658
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005659 else if (NumDifferences == 1) {
Chris Lattner45f57b82005-01-21 23:06:49 +00005660 Value *LHSV = GEPLHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
5661 Value *RHSV = GEPRHS->getOperand(DiffOperand);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005662 // Make sure we do a signed comparison here.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005663 return new ICmpInst(*Context,
5664 ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), LHSV, RHSV);
Chris Lattner4401c9c2005-01-14 00:20:05 +00005665 }
5666 }
5667
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005668 // Only lower this if the icmp is the only user of the GEP or if we expect
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005669 // the result to fold to a constant!
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00005670 if (TD &&
5671 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPLHS) || GEPLHS->hasOneUse()) &&
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005672 (isa<ConstantExpr>(GEPRHS) || GEPRHS->hasOneUse())) {
5673 // ((gep Ptr, OFFSET1) cmp (gep Ptr, OFFSET2) ---> (OFFSET1 cmp OFFSET2)
5674 Value *L = EmitGEPOffset(GEPLHS, I, *this);
5675 Value *R = EmitGEPOffset(GEPRHS, I, *this);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005676 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::getSignedPredicate(Cond), L, R);
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00005677 }
5678 }
5679 return 0;
5680}
5681
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005682/// FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst - Fold fcmp ([us]itofp x, cst) if possible.
5683///
5684Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(FCmpInst &I,
5685 Instruction *LHSI,
5686 Constant *RHSC) {
5687 if (!isa<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) return 0;
5688 const APFloat &RHS = cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)->getValueAPF();
5689
5690 // Get the width of the mantissa. We don't want to hack on conversions that
5691 // might lose information from the integer, e.g. "i64 -> float"
Chris Lattner7be1c452008-05-19 21:17:23 +00005692 int MantissaWidth = LHSI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005693 if (MantissaWidth == -1) return 0; // Unknown.
5694
5695 // Check to see that the input is converted from an integer type that is small
5696 // enough that preserves all bits. TODO: check here for "known" sign bits.
5697 // This would allow us to handle (fptosi (x >>s 62) to float) if x is i64 f.e.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005698 unsigned InputSize = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005699
5700 // If this is a uitofp instruction, we need an extra bit to hold the sign.
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005701 bool LHSUnsigned = isa<UIToFPInst>(LHSI);
5702 if (LHSUnsigned)
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005703 ++InputSize;
5704
5705 // If the conversion would lose info, don't hack on this.
5706 if ((int)InputSize > MantissaWidth)
5707 return 0;
5708
5709 // Otherwise, we can potentially simplify the comparison. We know that it
5710 // will always come through as an integer value and we know the constant is
5711 // not a NAN (it would have been previously simplified).
5712 assert(!RHS.isNaN() && "NaN comparison not already folded!");
5713
5714 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred;
5715 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005716 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected predicate!");
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005717 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005718 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ:
5719 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ;
5720 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005721 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005722 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT:
5723 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5724 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005725 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005726 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE:
5727 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5728 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005729 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005730 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT:
5731 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5732 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005733 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005734 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE:
5735 Pred = LHSUnsigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE : ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5736 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005737 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE:
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005738 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE:
5739 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
5740 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005741 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD:
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005742 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005743 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO:
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005744 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005745 }
5746
5747 const IntegerType *IntTy = cast<IntegerType>(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType());
5748
5749 // Now we know that the APFloat is a normal number, zero or inf.
5750
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005751 // See if the FP constant is too large for the integer. For example,
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005752 // comparing an i8 to 300.0.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00005753 unsigned IntWidth = IntTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005754
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005755 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5756 // If the RHS value is > SignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles +INF
5757 // and large values.
5758 APFloat SMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5759 SMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMaxValue(IntWidth), true,
5760 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5761 if (SMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // smax < 13123.0
5762 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT ||
5763 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005764 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
5765 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005766 }
5767 } else {
5768 // If the RHS value is > UnsignedMax, fold the comparison. This handles
5769 // +INF and large values.
5770 APFloat UMax(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5771 UMax.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getMaxValue(IntWidth), false,
5772 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5773 if (UMax.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpLessThan) { // umax < 13123.0
5774 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
5775 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005776 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
5777 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005778 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005779 }
5780
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005781 if (!LHSUnsigned) {
5782 // See if the RHS value is < SignedMin.
5783 APFloat SMin(RHS.getSemantics(), APFloat::fcZero, false);
5784 SMin.convertFromAPInt(APInt::getSignedMinValue(IntWidth), true,
5785 APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven);
5786 if (SMin.compare(RHS) == APFloat::cmpGreaterThan) { // smin > 12312.0
5787 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT ||
5788 Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005789 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
5790 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005791 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005792 }
5793
Bill Wendlingc143bcf2008-11-09 04:26:50 +00005794 // Okay, now we know that the FP constant fits in the range [SMIN, SMAX] or
5795 // [0, UMAX], but it may still be fractional. See if it is fractional by
5796 // casting the FP value to the integer value and back, checking for equality.
5797 // Don't do this for zero, because -0.0 is not fractional.
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005798 Constant *RHSInt = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005799 ? Context->getConstantExprFPToUI(RHSC, IntTy)
5800 : Context->getConstantExprFPToSI(RHSC, IntTy);
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005801 if (!RHS.isZero()) {
5802 bool Equal = LHSUnsigned
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005803 ? Context->getConstantExprUIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC
5804 : Context->getConstantExprSIToFP(RHSInt, RHSC->getType()) == RHSC;
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005805 if (!Equal) {
5806 // If we had a comparison against a fractional value, we have to adjust
5807 // the compare predicate and sometimes the value. RHSC is rounded towards
5808 // zero at this point.
5809 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005810 default: llvm_unreachable("Unexpected integer comparison!");
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005811 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (float)int != 4.4 --> true
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005812 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005813 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (float)int == 4.4 --> false
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005814 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005815 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
5816 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5817 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> false
5818 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005819 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005820 break;
5821 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
5822 // (float)int <= 4.4 --> int <= 4
5823 // (float)int <= -4.4 --> int < -4
5824 if (RHS.isNegative())
5825 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT;
5826 break;
5827 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
5828 // (float)int < -4.4 --> false
5829 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5830 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005831 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005832 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE;
5833 break;
5834 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
5835 // (float)int < -4.4 --> int < -4
5836 // (float)int < 4.4 --> int <= 4
5837 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5838 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE;
5839 break;
5840 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
5841 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5842 // (float)int > -4.4 --> true
5843 if (RHS.isNegative())
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005844 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005845 break;
5846 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
5847 // (float)int > 4.4 --> int > 4
5848 // (float)int > -4.4 --> int >= -4
5849 if (RHS.isNegative())
5850 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
5851 break;
5852 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
5853 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> true
5854 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5855 if (!RHS.isNegative())
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005856 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Evan Cheng2ddb6f12009-05-22 23:10:53 +00005857 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT;
5858 break;
5859 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
5860 // (float)int >= -4.4 --> int >= -4
5861 // (float)int >= 4.4 --> int > 4
5862 if (!RHS.isNegative())
5863 Pred = ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
5864 break;
5865 }
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005866 }
5867 }
5868
5869 // Lower this FP comparison into an appropriate integer version of the
5870 // comparison.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005871 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0), RHSInt);
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005872}
5873
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005874Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFCmpInst(FCmpInst &I) {
5875 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00005876 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00005877
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005878 // Fold trivial predicates.
5879 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005880 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005881 if (I.getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005882 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005883
5884 // Simplify 'fcmp pred X, X'
5885 if (Op0 == Op1) {
5886 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00005887 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown predicate!");
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005888 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: // True if unordered or equal
5889 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: // True if unordered, greater than, or equal
5890 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: // True if unordered, less than, or equal
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005891 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005892 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: // True if ordered and greater than
5893 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: // True if ordered and less than
5894 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: // True if ordered and operands are unequal
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005896
5897 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: // True if unordered: isnan(X) | isnan(Y)
5898 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: // True if unordered or less than
5899 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: // True if unordered or greater than
5900 case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: // True if unordered or not equal
5901 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp uno %X, 0.0'.
5902 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005903 I.setOperand(1, Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005904 return &I;
5905
5906 case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: // True if ordered (no nans)
5907 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: // True if ordered and equal
5908 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: // True if ordered and greater than or equal
5909 case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: // True if ordered and less than or equal
5910 // Canonicalize these to be 'fcmp ord %X, 0.0'.
5911 I.setPredicate(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005912 I.setOperand(1, Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner58e97462007-01-14 19:42:17 +00005913 return &I;
5914 }
5915 }
5916
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005917 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // fcmp pred X, undef -> undef
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005918 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getUndef(Type::Int1Ty));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00005919
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005920 // Handle fcmp with constant RHS
5921 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005922 // If the constant is a nan, see if we can fold the comparison based on it.
5923 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
5924 if (CFP->getValueAPF().isNaN()) {
5925 if (FCmpInst::isOrdered(I.getPredicate())) // True if ordered and...
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005926 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner85162782008-05-20 03:50:52 +00005927 assert(FCmpInst::isUnordered(I.getPredicate()) &&
5928 "Comparison must be either ordered or unordered!");
5929 // True if unordered.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00005930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005931 }
5932 }
5933
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005934 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
5935 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
5936 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00005937 // Only fold fcmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
5938 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
5939 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
5940 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
5941 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
5942 return NV;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005943 break;
Chris Lattnera5406232008-05-19 20:18:56 +00005944 case Instruction::SIToFP:
5945 case Instruction::UIToFP:
5946 if (Instruction *NV = FoldFCmp_IntToFP_Cst(I, LHSI, RHSC))
5947 return NV;
5948 break;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005949 case Instruction::Select:
5950 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
5951 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
5952 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
5953 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
5954 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
5955 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
5956 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005957 Op1 = Context->getConstantExprCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005958 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005959 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005960 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
5961 I.getName()), I);
5962 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
5963 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005964 Op2 = Context->getConstantExprCompare(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005965 // Insert a new FCmp of the other select operand.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00005966 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new FCmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005967 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
5968 I.getName()), I);
5969 }
5970 }
5971
5972 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00005973 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005974 break;
5975 }
5976 }
5977
5978 return Changed ? &I : 0;
5979}
5980
5981Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInst(ICmpInst &I) {
5982 bool Changed = SimplifyCompare(I);
5983 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
5984 const Type *Ty = Op0->getType();
5985
5986 // icmp X, X
5987 if (Op0 == Op1)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005988 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00005989 I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005990
5991 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // X icmp undef -> undef
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00005992 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getUndef(Type::Int1Ty));
Christopher Lamb7a0678c2007-12-18 21:32:20 +00005993
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00005994 // icmp <global/alloca*/null>, <global/alloca*/null> - Global/Stack value
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005995 // addresses never equal each other! We already know that Op0 != Op1.
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00005996 if ((isa<GlobalValue>(Op0) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op0) ||
5997 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op0)) &&
5998 (isa<GlobalValue>(Op1) || isa<AllocaInst>(Op1) ||
Chris Lattner711b3402004-11-14 07:33:16 +00005999 isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op1)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006000 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00006001 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006002
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006003 // icmp's with boolean values can always be turned into bitwise operations
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00006004 if (Ty == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006005 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006006 default: llvm_unreachable("Invalid icmp instruction!");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006007 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: { // icmp eq i1 A, B -> ~(A^B)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006008 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006009 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I);
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006010 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Xor);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006011 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006012 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // icmp eq i1 A, B -> A^B
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006013 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006014
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006015 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006016 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp ugt -> icmp ult
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006017 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006018 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:{ // icmp ult i1 A, B -> ~A & B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006019 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
6020 Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006021 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006022 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006023 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006024 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6025 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sgt -> icmp slt
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006026 // FALL THROUGH
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006027 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: { // icmp slt i1 A, B -> A & ~B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006028 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
6029 Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006030 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
6031 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Not, Op0);
6032 }
6033 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6034 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp uge -> icmp ule
6035 // FALL THROUGH
6036 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: { // icmp ule i1 A, B -> ~A | B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006037 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
6038 Op0, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006039 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006040 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op1);
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006041 }
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006042 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6043 std::swap(Op0, Op1); // Change icmp sge -> icmp sle
6044 // FALL THROUGH
6045 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: { // icmp sle i1 A, B -> A | ~B
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006046 Instruction *Not = BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context,
6047 Op1, I.getName()+"tmp");
Chris Lattner85b5eb02008-07-11 04:20:58 +00006048 InsertNewInstBefore(Not, I);
6049 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Not, Op0);
6050 }
Chris Lattner5dbef222004-08-11 00:50:51 +00006051 }
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006052 }
6053
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006054 unsigned BitWidth = 0;
6055 if (TD)
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00006056 BitWidth = TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty->getScalarType());
6057 else if (Ty->isIntOrIntVector())
6058 BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006059
6060 bool isSignBit = false;
6061
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006062 // See if we are doing a comparison with a constant.
Chris Lattner8b170942002-08-09 23:47:40 +00006063 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky579214a2009-02-27 06:37:39 +00006064 Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006065
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006066 // (icmp ne/eq (sub A B) 0) -> (icmp ne/eq A, B)
6067 if (I.isEquality() && CI->isNullValue() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006068 match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattnerb6566012008-01-05 01:18:20 +00006069 // (icmp cond A B) if cond is equality
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006070 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Owen Andersonf5783f82007-12-28 07:42:12 +00006071 }
Christopher Lamb103e1a32007-12-20 07:21:11 +00006072
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006073 // If we have an icmp le or icmp ge instruction, turn it into the
6074 // appropriate icmp lt or icmp gt instruction. This allows us to rely on
6075 // them being folded in the code below.
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006076 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
6077 default: break;
6078 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6079 if (CI->isMaxValue(false)) // A <=u MAX -> TRUE
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006080 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006081 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Op0,
6082 AddOne(CI, Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006083 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6084 if (CI->isMaxValue(true)) // A <=s MAX -> TRUE
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006085 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006086 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
6087 AddOne(CI, Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006088 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6089 if (CI->isMinValue(false)) // A >=u MIN -> TRUE
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006090 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006091 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Op0,
6092 SubOne(CI, Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006093 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6094 if (CI->isMinValue(true)) // A >=s MIN -> TRUE
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006095 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006096 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
6097 SubOne(CI, Context));
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006098 }
6099
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006100 // If this comparison is a normal comparison, it demands all
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006101 // bits, if it is a sign bit comparison, it only demands the sign bit.
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006102 bool UnusedBit;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006103 isSignBit = isSignBitCheck(I.getPredicate(), CI, UnusedBit);
6104 }
6105
6106 // See if we can fold the comparison based on range information we can get
6107 // by checking whether bits are known to be zero or one in the input.
6108 if (BitWidth != 0) {
6109 APInt Op0KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op0KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6110 APInt Op1KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), Op1KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
6111
6112 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(0),
Chris Lattner4241e4d2007-07-15 20:54:51 +00006113 isSignBit ? APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth)
6114 : APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006115 Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne, 0))
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006116 return &I;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006117 if (SimplifyDemandedBits(I.getOperandUse(1),
6118 APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth),
6119 Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne, 0))
6120 return &I;
6121
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006122 // Given the known and unknown bits, compute a range that the LHS could be
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006123 // in. Compute the Min, Max and RHS values based on the known bits. For the
6124 // EQ and NE we use unsigned values.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006125 APInt Op0Min(BitWidth, 0), Op0Max(BitWidth, 0);
6126 APInt Op1Min(BitWidth, 0), Op1Max(BitWidth, 0);
6127 if (ICmpInst::isSignedPredicate(I.getPredicate())) {
6128 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6129 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6130 ComputeSignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6131 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6132 } else {
6133 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op0KnownZero, Op0KnownOne,
6134 Op0Min, Op0Max);
6135 ComputeUnsignedMinMaxValuesFromKnownBits(Op1KnownZero, Op1KnownOne,
6136 Op1Min, Op1Max);
6137 }
6138
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006139 // If Min and Max are known to be the same, then SimplifyDemandedBits
6140 // figured out that the LHS is a constant. Just constant fold this now so
6141 // that code below can assume that Min != Max.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006142 if (!isa<Constant>(Op0) && Op0Min == Op0Max)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006143 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006144 Context->getConstantInt(Op0Min), Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006145 if (!isa<Constant>(Op1) && Op1Min == Op1Max)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006146 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), Op0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006147 Context->getConstantInt(Op1Min));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006148
Chris Lattner183661e2008-07-11 05:40:05 +00006149 // Based on the range information we know about the LHS, see if we can
6150 // simplify this comparison. For example, (x&4) < 8 is always true.
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006151 switch (I.getPredicate()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006152 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006153 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006154 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006155 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006156 break;
6157 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006158 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min) || Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max))
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006159 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006160 break;
6161 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006162 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A <u B -> true if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006164 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A <u B -> false if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006165 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006166 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <u B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006167 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006168 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6169 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <u C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006170 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
6171 SubOne(CI, Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006172
6173 // (x <u 2147483648) -> (x >s -1) -> true if sign bit clear
6174 if (CI->isMinValue(true))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006175 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, Op0,
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00006176 Context->getAllOnesValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006177 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006178 break;
6179 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006180 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A >u B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006181 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006182 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A >u B -> false if max(A) <= max(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006183 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006184
6185 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >u B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006186 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006187 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6188 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >u C -> A == C+1 if max(a)-1 == C
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006189 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
6190 AddOne(CI, Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006191
6192 // (x >u 2147483647) -> (x <s 0) -> true if sign bit set
6193 if (CI->isMaxValue(true))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006194 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Op0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006195 Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006196 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006197 break;
6198 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006199 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A <s B -> true if max(A) < min(C)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006200 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006201 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A <s B -> false if min(A) >= max(C)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006202 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006203 if (Op1Min == Op0Max) // A <s B -> A != B if max(A) == min(B)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006204 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006205 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6206 if (Op1Max == Op0Min+1) // A <s C -> A == C-1 if min(A)+1 == C
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006207 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
6208 SubOne(CI, Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006209 }
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006210 break;
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006211 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
6212 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A >s B -> true if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006213 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006214 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A >s B -> false if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006215 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006216
6217 if (Op1Max == Op0Min) // A >s B -> A != B if min(A) == max(B)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006218 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006219 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
6220 if (Op1Min == Op0Max-1) // A >s C -> A == C+1 if max(A)-1 == C
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006221 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, Op0,
6222 AddOne(CI, Context));
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006223 }
6224 break;
6225 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE:
6226 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6227 if (Op0Min.sge(Op1Max)) // A >=s B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006228 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006229 if (Op0Max.slt(Op1Min)) // A >=s B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006230 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006231 break;
6232 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:
6233 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_SLE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6234 if (Op0Max.sle(Op1Min)) // A <=s B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006235 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006236 if (Op0Min.sgt(Op1Max)) // A <=s B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006237 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006238 break;
6239 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE:
6240 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_UGE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6241 if (Op0Min.uge(Op1Max)) // A >=u B -> true if min(A) >= max(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006242 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006243 if (Op0Max.ult(Op1Min)) // A >=u B -> false if max(A) < min(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006244 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006245 break;
6246 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE:
6247 assert(!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) && "ICMP_ULE with ConstantInt not folded!");
6248 if (Op0Max.ule(Op1Min)) // A <=u B -> true if max(A) <= min(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006249 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getTrue());
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006250 if (Op0Min.ugt(Op1Max)) // A <=u B -> false if min(A) > max(B)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006251 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner84dff672008-07-11 05:08:55 +00006252 break;
Chris Lattnerbf5d8a82006-02-12 02:07:56 +00006253 }
Dan Gohman1c8491e2009-04-25 17:12:48 +00006254
6255 // Turn a signed comparison into an unsigned one if both operands
6256 // are known to have the same sign.
6257 if (I.isSignedPredicate() &&
6258 ((Op0KnownZero.isNegative() && Op1KnownZero.isNegative()) ||
6259 (Op0KnownOne.isNegative() && Op1KnownOne.isNegative())))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006260 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getUnsignedPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00006261 }
6262
6263 // Test if the ICmpInst instruction is used exclusively by a select as
6264 // part of a minimum or maximum operation. If so, refrain from doing
6265 // any other folding. This helps out other analyses which understand
6266 // non-obfuscated minimum and maximum idioms, such as ScalarEvolution
6267 // and CodeGen. And in this case, at least one of the comparison
6268 // operands has at least one user besides the compare (the select),
6269 // which would often largely negate the benefit of folding anyway.
6270 if (I.hasOneUse())
6271 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(*I.use_begin()))
6272 if ((SI->getOperand(1) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(2) == Op1) ||
6273 (SI->getOperand(2) == Op0 && SI->getOperand(1) == Op1))
6274 return 0;
6275
6276 // See if we are doing a comparison between a constant and an instruction that
6277 // can be folded into the comparison.
6278 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006279 // Since the RHS is a ConstantInt (CI), if the left hand side is an
Reid Spencer1628cec2006-10-26 06:15:43 +00006280 // instruction, see if that instruction also has constants so that the
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006281 // instruction can be folded into the icmp
Chris Lattner3c6a0d42004-05-25 06:32:08 +00006282 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006283 if (Instruction *Res = visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(I, LHSI, CI))
6284 return Res;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006285 }
6286
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006287 // Handle icmp with constant (but not simple integer constant) RHS
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006288 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
6289 if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
6290 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006291 case Instruction::GetElementPtr:
6292 if (RHSC->isNullValue()) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006293 // icmp pred GEP (P, int 0, int 0, int 0), null -> icmp pred P, null
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006294 bool isAllZeros = true;
6295 for (unsigned i = 1, e = LHSI->getNumOperands(); i != e; ++i)
6296 if (!isa<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i)) ||
6297 !cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(i))->isNullValue()) {
6298 isAllZeros = false;
6299 break;
6300 }
6301 if (isAllZeros)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006302 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006303 Context->getNullValue(LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()));
Chris Lattner9fb25db2005-05-01 04:42:15 +00006304 }
6305 break;
6306
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006307 case Instruction::PHI:
Chris Lattner7d8ab4e2008-06-08 20:52:11 +00006308 // Only fold icmp into the PHI if the phi and fcmp are in the same
6309 // block. If in the same block, we're encouraging jump threading. If
6310 // not, we are just pessimizing the code by making an i1 phi.
6311 if (LHSI->getParent() == I.getParent())
6312 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
6313 return NV;
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006314 break;
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006315 case Instruction::Select: {
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006316 // If either operand of the select is a constant, we can fold the
6317 // comparison into the select arms, which will cause one to be
6318 // constant folded and the select turned into a bitwise or.
6319 Value *Op1 = 0, *Op2 = 0;
6320 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6321 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6322 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006323 Op1 = Context->getConstantExprICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006324 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006325 Op2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006326 LHSI->getOperand(2), RHSC,
6327 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006328 } else if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(LHSI->getOperand(2))) {
6329 // Fold the known value into the constant operand.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006330 Op2 = Context->getConstantExprICmp(I.getPredicate(), C, RHSC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006331 // Insert a new ICmp of the other select operand.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006332 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006333 LHSI->getOperand(1), RHSC,
6334 I.getName()), I);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006335 }
6336 }
Jeff Cohen9d809302005-04-23 21:38:35 +00006337
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006338 if (Op1)
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00006339 return SelectInst::Create(LHSI->getOperand(0), Op1, Op2);
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006340 break;
6341 }
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006342 case Instruction::Malloc:
6343 // If we have (malloc != null), and if the malloc has a single use, we
6344 // can assume it is successful and remove the malloc.
6345 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantPointerNull>(RHSC)) {
6346 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006347 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
Nick Lewyckyfc1efbb2008-05-17 07:33:39 +00006348 !I.isTrueWhenEqual()));
Chris Lattner4802d902007-04-06 18:57:34 +00006349 }
6350 break;
6351 }
Chris Lattner6970b662005-04-23 15:31:55 +00006352 }
6353
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006354 // If we can optimize a 'icmp GEP, P' or 'icmp P, GEP', do so now.
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006355 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op0))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006356 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op1, I.getPredicate(), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006357 return NI;
6358 if (User *GEP = dyn_castGetElementPtr(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006359 if (Instruction *NI = FoldGEPICmp(GEP, Op0,
6360 ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(I.getPredicate()), I))
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +00006361 return NI;
6362
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006363 // Test to see if the operands of the icmp are casted versions of other
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006364 // values. If the ptr->ptr cast can be stripped off both arguments, we do so
6365 // now.
6366 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op0)) {
6367 if (isa<PointerType>(Op0->getType()) &&
6368 (isa<Constant>(Op1) || isa<BitCastInst>(Op1))) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006369 // We keep moving the cast from the left operand over to the right
6370 // operand, where it can often be eliminated completely.
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006371 Op0 = CI->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006372
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006373 // If operand #1 is a bitcast instruction, it must also be a ptr->ptr cast
6374 // so eliminate it as well.
6375 if (BitCastInst *CI2 = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op1))
6376 Op1 = CI2->getOperand(0);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00006377
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006378 // If Op1 is a constant, we can fold the cast into the constant.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006379 if (Op0->getType() != Op1->getType()) {
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006380 if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006381 Op1 = Context->getConstantExprBitCast(Op1C, Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006382 } else {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006383 // Otherwise, cast the RHS right before the icmp
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00006384 Op1 = InsertBitCastBefore(Op1, Op0->getType(), I);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006385 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006386 }
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006387 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), Op0, Op1);
Chris Lattnerde90b762003-11-03 04:25:02 +00006388 }
Chris Lattner57d86372007-01-06 01:45:59 +00006389 }
6390
6391 if (isa<CastInst>(Op0)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006392 // Handle the special case of: icmp (cast bool to X), <cst>
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006393 // This comes up when you have code like
6394 // int X = A < B;
6395 // if (X) ...
6396 // For generality, we handle any zero-extension of any operand comparison
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006397 // with a constant or another cast from the same type.
6398 if (isa<ConstantInt>(Op1) || isa<CastInst>(Op1))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00006399 if (Instruction *R = visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(I))
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00006400 return R;
Chris Lattner68708052003-11-03 05:17:03 +00006401 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006402
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006403 // See if it's the same type of instruction on the left and right.
6404 if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
6405 if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006406 if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006407 Op1I->hasOneUse() && Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1)) {
Nick Lewycky23c04302008-09-03 06:24:21 +00006408 switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006409 default: break;
6410 case Instruction::Add:
6411 case Instruction::Sub:
6412 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006413 if (I.isEquality()) // a+x icmp eq/ne b+x --> a icmp b
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006414 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), Op0I->getOperand(0),
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006415 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006416 // icmp u/s (a ^ signbit), (b ^ signbit) --> icmp s/u a, b
6417 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6418 if (CI->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6419 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6420 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6421 : I.getSignedPredicate();
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006422 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006423 Op1I->getOperand(0));
6424 }
6425
6426 if (CI->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
6427 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = I.isSignedPredicate()
6428 ? I.getUnsignedPredicate()
6429 : I.getSignedPredicate();
6430 Pred = I.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006431 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, Op0I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006432 Op1I->getOperand(0));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006433 }
6434 }
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006435 break;
6436 case Instruction::Mul:
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006437 if (!I.isEquality())
6438 break;
6439
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006440 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
6441 // a * Cst icmp eq/ne b * Cst --> a & Mask icmp b & Mask
6442 // Mask = -1 >> count-trailing-zeros(Cst).
6443 if (!CI->isZero() && !CI->isOne()) {
6444 const APInt &AP = CI->getValue();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006445 ConstantInt *Mask = Context->getConstantInt(
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006446 APInt::getLowBitsSet(AP.getBitWidth(),
6447 AP.getBitWidth() -
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006448 AP.countTrailingZeros()));
Nick Lewycky5d52c452008-08-21 05:56:10 +00006449 Instruction *And1 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0I->getOperand(0),
6450 Mask);
6451 Instruction *And2 = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1I->getOperand(0),
6452 Mask);
6453 InsertNewInstBefore(And1, I);
6454 InsertNewInstBefore(And2, I);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006455 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), And1, And2);
Nick Lewycky4bf1e592008-07-11 07:20:53 +00006456 }
6457 }
6458 break;
6459 }
6460 }
6461 }
6462 }
6463
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006464 // ~x < ~y --> y < x
6465 { Value *A, *B;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006466 if (match(Op0, m_Not(m_Value(A)), *Context) &&
6467 match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(B)), *Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006468 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B, A);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006469 }
6470
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00006471 if (I.isEquality()) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006472 Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006473
6474 // -x == -y --> x == y
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006475 if (match(Op0, m_Neg(m_Value(A)), *Context) &&
6476 match(Op1, m_Neg(m_Value(B)), *Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006477 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A, B);
Chris Lattner7d2cbd22008-05-09 05:19:28 +00006478
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006479 if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006480 if (A == Op1 || B == Op1) { // (A^B) == A -> B == 0
6481 Value *OtherVal = A == Op1 ? B : A;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006482 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006483 Context->getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006484 }
6485
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006486 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006487 // A^c1 == C^c2 --> A == C^(c1^c2)
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006488 ConstantInt *C1, *C2;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006489 if (match(B, m_ConstantInt(C1), *Context) &&
6490 match(D, m_ConstantInt(C2), *Context) && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006491 Constant *NC =
6492 Context->getConstantInt(C1->getValue() ^ C2->getValue());
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006493 Instruction *Xor = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, NC, "tmp");
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006494 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006495 InsertNewInstBefore(Xor, I));
6496 }
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006497
6498 // A^B == A^D -> B == D
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006499 if (A == C) return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B, D);
6500 if (A == D) return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B, C);
6501 if (B == C) return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A, D);
6502 if (B == D) return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), A, C);
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006503 }
6504 }
6505
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006506 if (match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006507 (A == Op0 || B == Op0)) {
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006508 // A == (A^B) -> B == 0
6509 Value *OtherVal = A == Op0 ? B : A;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006510 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), OtherVal,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006511 Context->getNullValue(A->getType()));
Chris Lattner4f0e33d2007-01-05 03:04:57 +00006512 }
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006513
6514 // (A-B) == A -> B == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006515 if (match(Op0, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)), *Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006516 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006517 Context->getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00006518
6519 // A == (A-B) -> B == 0
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006520 if (match(Op1, m_Sub(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)), *Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006521 return new ICmpInst(*Context, I.getPredicate(), B,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006522 Context->getNullValue(B->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006523
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006524 // (X&Z) == (Y&Z) -> (X^Y) & Z == 0
6525 if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00006526 match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), *Context) &&
6527 match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006528 Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
6529
6530 if (A == C) {
6531 X = B; Y = D; Z = A;
6532 } else if (A == D) {
6533 X = B; Y = C; Z = A;
6534 } else if (B == C) {
6535 X = A; Y = D; Z = B;
6536 } else if (B == D) {
6537 X = A; Y = C; Z = B;
6538 }
6539
6540 if (X) { // Build (X^Y) & Z
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006541 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(X, Y, "tmp"), I);
6542 Op1 = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op1, Z, "tmp"), I);
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006543 I.setOperand(0, Op1);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006544 I.setOperand(1, Context->getNullValue(Op1->getType()));
Chris Lattner9c2328e2006-11-14 06:06:06 +00006545 return &I;
6546 }
6547 }
Chris Lattner26ab9a92006-02-27 01:44:11 +00006548 }
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00006549 return Changed ? &I : 0;
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00006550}
6551
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006552
6553/// FoldICmpDivCst - Fold "icmp pred, ([su]div X, DivRHS), CmpRHS" where DivRHS
6554/// and CmpRHS are both known to be integer constants.
6555Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldICmpDivCst(ICmpInst &ICI, BinaryOperator *DivI,
6556 ConstantInt *DivRHS) {
6557 ConstantInt *CmpRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
6558 const APInt &CmpRHSV = CmpRHS->getValue();
6559
6560 // FIXME: If the operand types don't match the type of the divide
6561 // then don't attempt this transform. The code below doesn't have the
6562 // logic to deal with a signed divide and an unsigned compare (and
6563 // vice versa). This is because (x /s C1) <s C2 produces different
6564 // results than (x /s C1) <u C2 or (x /u C1) <s C2 or even
6565 // (x /u C1) <u C2. Simply casting the operands and result won't
6566 // work. :( The if statement below tests that condition and bails
6567 // if it finds it.
6568 bool DivIsSigned = DivI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv;
6569 if (!ICI.isEquality() && DivIsSigned != ICI.isSignedPredicate())
6570 return 0;
6571 if (DivRHS->isZero())
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006572 return 0; // The ProdOV computation fails on divide by zero.
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006573 if (DivIsSigned && DivRHS->isAllOnesValue())
6574 return 0; // The overflow computation also screws up here
6575 if (DivRHS->isOne())
6576 return 0; // Not worth bothering, and eliminates some funny cases
6577 // with INT_MIN.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006578
6579 // Compute Prod = CI * DivRHS. We are essentially solving an equation
6580 // of form X/C1=C2. We solve for X by multiplying C1 (DivRHS) and
6581 // C2 (CI). By solving for X we can turn this into a range check
6582 // instead of computing a divide.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006583 Constant *Prod = Context->getConstantExprMul(CmpRHS, DivRHS);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006584
6585 // Determine if the product overflows by seeing if the product is
6586 // not equal to the divide. Make sure we do the same kind of divide
6587 // as in the LHS instruction that we're folding.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006588 bool ProdOV = (DivIsSigned ? Context->getConstantExprSDiv(Prod, DivRHS) :
6589 Context->getConstantExprUDiv(Prod, DivRHS)) != CmpRHS;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006590
6591 // Get the ICmp opcode
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006592 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.getPredicate();
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006593
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006594 // Figure out the interval that is being checked. For example, a comparison
6595 // like "X /u 5 == 0" is really checking that X is in the interval [0, 5).
6596 // Compute this interval based on the constants involved and the signedness of
6597 // the compare/divide. This computes a half-open interval, keeping track of
6598 // whether either value in the interval overflows. After analysis each
6599 // overflow variable is set to 0 if it's corresponding bound variable is valid
6600 // -1 if overflowed off the bottom end, or +1 if overflowed off the top end.
6601 int LoOverflow = 0, HiOverflow = 0;
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00006602 Constant *LoBound = 0, *HiBound = 0;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006603
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006604 if (!DivIsSigned) { // udiv
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006605 // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006606 LoBound = Prod;
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006607 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6608 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006609 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, LoBound, DivRHS, Context, false);
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006610 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isStrictlyPositive()) { // Divisor is > 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006611 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / pos) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006612 // Can't overflow. e.g. X/2 op 0 --> [-1, 2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006613 LoBound = cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(SubOne(DivRHS,
6614 Context)));
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006615 HiBound = DivRHS;
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006616 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / pos) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006617 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/5 op 3 --> [15, 20)
6618 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV;
6619 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006620 HiOverflow = AddWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006621 } else { // (X / pos) op neg
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006622 // e.g. X/5 op -3 --> [-15-4, -15+1) --> [-19, -14)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006623 HiBound = AddOne(Prod, Context);
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006624 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
6625 if (!LoOverflow) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006626 ConstantInt* DivNeg =
6627 cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(DivRHS));
6628 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound, DivNeg, Context,
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006629 true) ? -1 : 0;
6630 }
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006631 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006632 } else if (DivRHS->getValue().isNegative()) { // Divisor is < 0.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006633 if (CmpRHSV == 0) { // (X / neg) op 0
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006634 // e.g. X/-5 op 0 --> [-4, 5)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006635 LoBound = AddOne(DivRHS, Context);
6636 HiBound = cast<ConstantInt>(Context->getConstantExprNeg(DivRHS));
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006637 if (HiBound == DivRHS) { // -INTMIN = INTMIN
6638 HiOverflow = 1; // [INTMIN+1, overflow)
6639 HiBound = 0; // e.g. X/INTMIN = 0 --> X > INTMIN
6640 }
Dan Gohman76491272008-02-13 22:09:18 +00006641 } else if (CmpRHSV.isStrictlyPositive()) { // (X / neg) op pos
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006642 // e.g. X/-5 op 3 --> [-19, -14)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006643 HiBound = AddOne(Prod, Context);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006644 HiOverflow = LoOverflow = ProdOV ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006645 if (!LoOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006646 LoOverflow = AddWithOverflow(LoBound, HiBound,
6647 DivRHS, Context, true) ? -1 : 0;
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006648 } else { // (X / neg) op neg
Chris Lattnera6321b42008-10-11 22:55:00 +00006649 LoBound = Prod; // e.g. X/-5 op -3 --> [15, 20)
6650 LoOverflow = HiOverflow = ProdOV;
Dan Gohman7f85fbd2008-09-11 00:25:00 +00006651 if (!HiOverflow)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006652 HiOverflow = SubWithOverflow(HiBound, Prod, DivRHS, Context, true);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006653 }
6654
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006655 // Dividing by a negative swaps the condition. LT <-> GT
6656 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006657 }
6658
6659 Value *X = DivI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006660 switch (Pred) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00006661 default: llvm_unreachable("Unhandled icmp opcode!");
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006662 case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
6663 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006664 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006665 else if (HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006666 return new ICmpInst(*Context, DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006667 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, LoBound);
6668 else if (LoOverflow)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006669 return new ICmpInst(*Context, DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006670 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, HiBound);
6671 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006672 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, true, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006673 case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
6674 if (LoOverflow && HiOverflow)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006675 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006676 else if (HiOverflow)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006677 return new ICmpInst(*Context, DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006678 ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, X, LoBound);
6679 else if (LoOverflow)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006680 return new ICmpInst(*Context, DivIsSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE :
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006681 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
6682 else
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006683 return InsertRangeTest(X, LoBound, HiBound, DivIsSigned, false, ICI);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006684 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
6685 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006686 if (LoOverflow == +1) // Low bound is greater than input range.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006687 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006688 if (LoOverflow == -1) // Low bound is less than input range.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006689 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getFalse());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006690 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, X, LoBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006691 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
6692 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006693 if (HiOverflow == +1) // High bound greater than input range.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006694 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006695 else if (HiOverflow == -1) // High bound less than input range.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner1dbfd482007-06-21 18:11:19 +00006697 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006698 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006699 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006700 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, X, HiBound);
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00006701 }
6702}
6703
6704
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006705/// visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst - Handle "icmp (instr, intcst)".
6706///
6707Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithInstAndIntCst(ICmpInst &ICI,
6708 Instruction *LHSI,
6709 ConstantInt *RHS) {
6710 const APInt &RHSV = RHS->getValue();
6711
6712 switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006713 case Instruction::Trunc:
6714 if (ICI.isEquality() && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6715 // Simplify icmp eq (trunc x to i8), 42 -> icmp eq x, 42|highbits if all
6716 // of the high bits truncated out of x are known.
6717 unsigned DstBits = LHSI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(),
6718 SrcBits = LHSI->getOperand(0)->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6719 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(SrcBits, SrcBits-DstBits));
6720 APInt KnownZero(SrcBits, 0), KnownOne(SrcBits, 0);
6721 ComputeMaskedBits(LHSI->getOperand(0), Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
6722
6723 // If all the high bits are known, we can do this xform.
6724 if ((KnownZero|KnownOne).countLeadingOnes() >= SrcBits-DstBits) {
6725 // Pull in the high bits from known-ones set.
6726 APInt NewRHS(RHS->getValue());
6727 NewRHS.zext(SrcBits);
6728 NewRHS |= KnownOne;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006729 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006730 Context->getConstantInt(NewRHS));
Chris Lattnera80d6682009-01-09 07:47:06 +00006731 }
6732 }
6733 break;
6734
Duncan Sands0091bf22007-04-04 06:42:45 +00006735 case Instruction::Xor: // (icmp pred (xor X, XorCST), CI)
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006736 if (ConstantInt *XorCST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) {
6737 // If this is a comparison that tests the signbit (X < 0) or (x > -1),
6738 // fold the xor.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +00006739 if ((ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && RHSV == 0) ||
6740 (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && RHSV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006741 Value *CompareVal = LHSI->getOperand(0);
6742
6743 // If the sign bit of the XorCST is not set, there is no change to
6744 // the operation, just stop using the Xor.
6745 if (!XorCST->getValue().isNegative()) {
6746 ICI.setOperand(0, CompareVal);
6747 AddToWorkList(LHSI);
6748 return &ICI;
6749 }
6750
6751 // Was the old condition true if the operand is positive?
6752 bool isTrueIfPositive = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT;
6753
6754 // If so, the new one isn't.
6755 isTrueIfPositive ^= true;
6756
6757 if (isTrueIfPositive)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006758 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, CompareVal,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006759 SubOne(RHS, Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006760 else
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006761 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, CompareVal,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006762 AddOne(RHS, Context));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006763 }
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006764
6765 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6766 // (icmp u/s (xor A SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u A, (xor C SignBit))
6767 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isSignBit()) {
6768 const APInt &SignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6769 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6770 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6771 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006772 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006773 Context->getConstantInt(RHSV ^ SignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006774 }
6775
6776 // (icmp u/s (xor A ~SignBit), C) -> (icmp s/u (xor C ~SignBit), A)
Chris Lattnerf5db1fb2009-02-02 07:15:30 +00006777 if (!ICI.isEquality() && XorCST->getValue().isMaxSignedValue()) {
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006778 const APInt &NotSignBit = XorCST->getValue();
6779 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI.isSignedPredicate()
6780 ? ICI.getUnsignedPredicate()
6781 : ICI.getSignedPredicate();
6782 Pred = ICI.getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006783 return new ICmpInst(*Context, Pred, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006784 Context->getConstantInt(RHSV ^ NotSignBit));
Nick Lewycky4333f492009-01-31 21:30:05 +00006785 }
6786 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006787 }
6788 break;
6789 case Instruction::And: // (icmp pred (and X, AndCST), RHS)
6790 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() && isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)) &&
6791 LHSI->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
6792 ConstantInt *AndCST = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6793
6794 // If the LHS is an AND of a truncating cast, we can widen the
6795 // and/compare to be the input width without changing the value
6796 // produced, eliminating a cast.
6797 if (TruncInst *Cast = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
6798 // We can do this transformation if either the AND constant does not
6799 // have its sign bit set or if it is an equality comparison.
6800 // Extending a relational comparison when we're checking the sign
6801 // bit would not work.
6802 if (Cast->hasOneUse() &&
Anton Korobeynikov4aefd6b2008-02-20 12:07:57 +00006803 (ICI.isEquality() ||
6804 (AndCST->getValue().isNonNegative() && RHSV.isNonNegative()))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006805 uint32_t BitWidth =
6806 cast<IntegerType>(Cast->getOperand(0)->getType())->getBitWidth();
6807 APInt NewCST = AndCST->getValue();
6808 NewCST.zext(BitWidth);
6809 APInt NewCI = RHSV;
6810 NewCI.zext(BitWidth);
6811 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006812 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Cast->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006813 Context->getConstantInt(NewCST),LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006814 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006815 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), NewAnd,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006816 Context->getConstantInt(NewCI));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006817 }
6818 }
6819
6820 // If this is: (X >> C1) & C2 != C3 (where any shift and any compare
6821 // could exist), turn it into (X & (C2 << C1)) != (C3 << C1). This
6822 // happens a LOT in code produced by the C front-end, for bitfield
6823 // access.
6824 BinaryOperator *Shift = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
6825 if (Shift && !Shift->isShift())
6826 Shift = 0;
6827
6828 ConstantInt *ShAmt;
6829 ShAmt = Shift ? dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Shift->getOperand(1)) : 0;
6830 const Type *Ty = Shift ? Shift->getType() : 0; // Type of the shift.
6831 const Type *AndTy = AndCST->getType(); // Type of the and.
6832
6833 // We can fold this as long as we can't shift unknown bits
6834 // into the mask. This can only happen with signed shift
6835 // rights, as they sign-extend.
6836 if (ShAmt) {
6837 bool CanFold = Shift->isLogicalShift();
6838 if (!CanFold) {
6839 // To test for the bad case of the signed shr, see if any
6840 // of the bits shifted in could be tested after the mask.
6841 uint32_t TyBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6842 int ShAmtVal = TyBits - ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TyBits);
6843
6844 uint32_t BitWidth = AndTy->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
6845 if ((APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-ShAmtVal) &
6846 AndCST->getValue()) == 0)
6847 CanFold = true;
6848 }
6849
6850 if (CanFold) {
6851 Constant *NewCst;
6852 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006853 NewCst = Context->getConstantExprLShr(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006854 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006855 NewCst = Context->getConstantExprShl(RHS, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006856
6857 // Check to see if we are shifting out any of the bits being
6858 // compared.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006859 if (Context->getConstantExpr(Shift->getOpcode(),
6860 NewCst, ShAmt) != RHS) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006861 // If we shifted bits out, the fold is not going to work out.
6862 // As a special case, check to see if this means that the
6863 // result is always true or false now.
6864 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006865 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getFalse());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006866 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00006867 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getTrue());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006868 } else {
6869 ICI.setOperand(1, NewCst);
6870 Constant *NewAndCST;
6871 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006872 NewAndCST = Context->getConstantExprLShr(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006873 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006874 NewAndCST = Context->getConstantExprShl(AndCST, ShAmt);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006875 LHSI->setOperand(1, NewAndCST);
6876 LHSI->setOperand(0, Shift->getOperand(0));
6877 AddToWorkList(Shift); // Shift is dead.
6878 AddUsesToWorkList(ICI);
6879 return &ICI;
6880 }
6881 }
6882 }
6883
6884 // Turn ((X >> Y) & C) == 0 into (X & (C << Y)) == 0. The later is
6885 // preferable because it allows the C<<Y expression to be hoisted out
6886 // of a loop if Y is invariant and X is not.
6887 if (Shift && Shift->hasOneUse() && RHSV == 0 &&
Chris Lattnere8e49212009-03-25 00:28:58 +00006888 ICI.isEquality() && !Shift->isArithmeticShift() &&
6889 !isa<Constant>(Shift->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006890 // Compute C << Y.
6891 Value *NS;
6892 if (Shift->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006893 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006894 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6895 } else {
6896 // Insert a logical shift.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006897 NS = BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(AndCST,
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006898 Shift->getOperand(1), "tmp");
6899 }
6900 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(NS), ICI);
6901
6902 // Compute X & (C << Y).
6903 Instruction *NewAnd =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006904 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift->getOperand(0), NS, LHSI->getName());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006905 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, ICI);
6906
6907 ICI.setOperand(0, NewAnd);
6908 return &ICI;
6909 }
6910 }
6911 break;
6912
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006913 case Instruction::Shl: { // (icmp pred (shl X, ShAmt), CI)
6914 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
6915 if (!ShAmt) break;
6916
6917 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6918
6919 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6920 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6921 // simplified.
6922 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6923 break;
6924
6925 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
6926 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6927 // comparison cannot succeed.
6928 Constant *Comp =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006929 Context->getConstantExprShl(Context->getConstantExprLShr(RHS, ShAmt),
6930 ShAmt);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006931 if (Comp != RHS) {// Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6932 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006933 Constant *Cst = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006934 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6935 }
6936
6937 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
6938 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
6939 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
6940 Constant *Mask =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006941 Context->getConstantInt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits,
6942 TypeBits-ShAmtVal));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006943
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006944 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006945 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006946 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6947 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006948 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006949 Context->getConstantInt(RHSV.lshr(ShAmtVal)));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006950 }
6951 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006952
6953 // Otherwise, if this is a comparison of the sign bit, simplify to and/test.
6954 bool TrueIfSigned = false;
6955 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
6956 isSignBitCheck(ICI.getPredicate(), RHS, TrueIfSigned)) {
6957 // (X << 31) <s 0 --> (X&1) != 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006958 Constant *Mask = Context->getConstantInt(APInt(TypeBits, 1) <<
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006959 (TypeBits-ShAmt->getZExtValue()-1));
6960 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00006961 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006962 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
6963 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
6964
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00006965 return new ICmpInst(*Context,
6966 TrueIfSigned ? ICmpInst::ICMP_NE : ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006967 And, Context->getNullValue(And->getType()));
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006968 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006969 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006970 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00006971
6972 case Instruction::LShr: // (icmp pred (shr X, ShAmt), CI)
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006973 case Instruction::AShr: {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006974 // Only handle equality comparisons of shift-by-constant.
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006975 ConstantInt *ShAmt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006976 if (!ShAmt || !ICI.isEquality()) break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006977
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006978 // Check that the shift amount is in range. If not, don't perform
6979 // undefined shifts. When the shift is visited it will be
6980 // simplified.
6981 uint32_t TypeBits = RHSV.getBitWidth();
6982 if (ShAmt->uge(TypeBits))
6983 break;
6984
6985 uint32_t ShAmtVal = (uint32_t)ShAmt->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00006986
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006987 // If we are comparing against bits always shifted out, the
6988 // comparison cannot succeed.
6989 APInt Comp = RHSV << ShAmtVal;
6990 if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr)
6991 Comp = Comp.lshr(ShAmtVal);
6992 else
6993 Comp = Comp.ashr(ShAmtVal);
6994
6995 if (Comp != RHSV) { // Comparing against a bit that we know is zero.
6996 bool IsICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00006997 Constant *Cst = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty, IsICMP_NE);
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00006998 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Cst);
6999 }
7000
7001 // Otherwise, check to see if the bits shifted out are known to be zero.
7002 // If so, we can compare against the unshifted value:
7003 // (X & 4) >> 1 == 2 --> (X & 4) == 4.
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00007004 if (LHSI->hasOneUse() &&
7005 MaskedValueIsZero(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007006 APInt::getLowBitsSet(Comp.getBitWidth(), ShAmtVal))) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007007 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007008 Context->getConstantExprShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007009 }
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007010
Evan Chengf30752c2008-04-23 00:38:06 +00007011 if (LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007012 // Otherwise strength reduce the shift into an and.
7013 APInt Val(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShAmtVal));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007014 Constant *Mask = Context->getConstantInt(Val);
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007015
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007016 Instruction *AndI =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007017 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(LHSI->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner41dc0fc2008-03-21 05:19:58 +00007018 Mask, LHSI->getName()+".mask");
7019 Value *And = InsertNewInstBefore(AndI, ICI);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007020 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), And,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007021 Context->getConstantExprShl(RHS, ShAmt));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007022 }
7023 break;
Chris Lattnera0141b92007-07-15 20:42:37 +00007024 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007025
7026 case Instruction::SDiv:
7027 case Instruction::UDiv:
7028 // Fold: icmp pred ([us]div X, C1), C2 -> range test
7029 // Fold this div into the comparison, producing a range check.
7030 // Determine, based on the divide type, what the range is being
7031 // checked. If there is an overflow on the low or high side, remember
7032 // it, otherwise compute the range [low, hi) bounding the new value.
7033 // See: InsertRangeTest above for the kinds of replacements possible.
Chris Lattner562ef782007-06-20 23:46:26 +00007034 if (ConstantInt *DivRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1)))
7035 if (Instruction *R = FoldICmpDivCst(ICI, cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI),
7036 DivRHS))
7037 return R;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007038 break;
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007039
7040 case Instruction::Add:
7041 // Fold: icmp pred (add, X, C1), C2
7042
7043 if (!ICI.isEquality()) {
7044 ConstantInt *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
7045 if (!LHSC) break;
7046 const APInt &LHSV = LHSC->getValue();
7047
7048 ConstantRange CR = ICI.makeConstantRange(ICI.getPredicate(), RHSV)
7049 .subtract(LHSV);
7050
7051 if (ICI.isSignedPredicate()) {
7052 if (CR.getLower().isSignBit()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007053 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007054 Context->getConstantInt(CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007055 } else if (CR.getUpper().isSignBit()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007056 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007057 Context->getConstantInt(CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007058 }
7059 } else {
7060 if (CR.getLower().isMinValue()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007061 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007062 Context->getConstantInt(CR.getUpper()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007063 } else if (CR.getUpper().isMinValue()) {
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007064 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHSI->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007065 Context->getConstantInt(CR.getLower()));
Nick Lewycky5be29202008-02-03 16:33:09 +00007066 }
7067 }
7068 }
7069 break;
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007070 }
7071
7072 // Simplify icmp_eq and icmp_ne instructions with integer constant RHS.
7073 if (ICI.isEquality()) {
7074 bool isICMP_NE = ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
7075
7076 // If the first operand is (add|sub|and|or|xor|rem) with a constant, and
7077 // the second operand is a constant, simplify a bit.
7078 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)) {
7079 switch (BO->getOpcode()) {
7080 case Instruction::SRem:
7081 // If we have a signed (X % (2^c)) == 0, turn it into an unsigned one.
7082 if (RHSV == 0 && isa<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1)) &&BO->hasOneUse()){
7083 const APInt &V = cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))->getValue();
7084 if (V.sgt(APInt(V.getBitWidth(), 1)) && V.isPowerOf2()) {
7085 Instruction *NewRem =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007086 BinaryOperator::CreateURem(BO->getOperand(0), BO->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007087 BO->getName());
7088 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRem, ICI);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007089 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), NewRem,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007090 Context->getNullValue(BO->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007091 }
7092 }
7093 break;
7094 case Instruction::Add:
7095 // Replace ((add A, B) != C) with (A != C-B) if B & C are constants.
7096 if (ConstantInt *BOp1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7097 if (BO->hasOneUse())
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007098 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007099 Context->getConstantExprSub(RHS, BOp1C));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007100 } else if (RHSV == 0) {
7101 // Replace ((add A, B) != 0) with (A != -B) if A or B is
7102 // efficiently invertible, or if the add has just this one use.
7103 Value *BOp0 = BO->getOperand(0), *BOp1 = BO->getOperand(1);
7104
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007105 if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp1, Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007106 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, NegVal);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007107 else if (Value *NegVal = dyn_castNegVal(BOp0, Context))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007108 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), NegVal, BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007109 else if (BO->hasOneUse()) {
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00007110 Instruction *Neg = BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, BOp1);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007111 InsertNewInstBefore(Neg, ICI);
7112 Neg->takeName(BO);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007113 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BOp0, Neg);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007114 }
7115 }
7116 break;
7117 case Instruction::Xor:
7118 // For the xor case, we can xor two constants together, eliminating
7119 // the explicit xor.
7120 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007121 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007122 Context->getConstantExprXor(RHS, BOC));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007123
7124 // FALLTHROUGH
7125 case Instruction::Sub:
7126 // Replace (([sub|xor] A, B) != 0) with (A != B)
7127 if (RHSV == 0)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007128 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), BO->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007129 BO->getOperand(1));
7130 break;
7131
7132 case Instruction::Or:
7133 // If bits are being or'd in that are not present in the constant we
7134 // are comparing against, then the comparison could never succeed!
7135 if (Constant *BOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007136 Constant *NotCI = Context->getConstantExprNot(RHS);
7137 if (!Context->getConstantExprAnd(BOC, NotCI)->isNullValue())
7138 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
7139 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
7140 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007141 }
7142 break;
7143
7144 case Instruction::And:
7145 if (ConstantInt *BOC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(BO->getOperand(1))) {
7146 // If bits are being compared against that are and'd out, then the
7147 // comparison can never succeed!
7148 if ((RHSV & ~BOC->getValue()) != 0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007149 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI,
7150 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty,
7151 isICMP_NE));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007152
7153 // If we have ((X & C) == C), turn it into ((X & C) != 0).
7154 if (RHS == BOC && RHSV.isPowerOf2())
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007155 return new ICmpInst(*Context, isICMP_NE ? ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ :
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007156 ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHSI,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007157 Context->getNullValue(RHS->getType()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007158
7159 // Replace (and X, (1 << size(X)-1) != 0) with x s< 0
Chris Lattner833f25d2008-06-02 01:29:46 +00007160 if (BOC->getValue().isSignBit()) {
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007161 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007162 Constant *Zero = Context->getNullValue(X->getType());
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007163 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7164 ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007165 return new ICmpInst(*Context, pred, X, Zero);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007166 }
7167
7168 // ((X & ~7) == 0) --> X < 8
7169 if (RHSV == 0 && isHighOnes(BOC)) {
7170 Value *X = BO->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007171 Constant *NegX = Context->getConstantExprNeg(BOC);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007172 ICmpInst::Predicate pred = isICMP_NE ?
7173 ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT;
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007174 return new ICmpInst(*Context, pred, X, NegX);
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007175 }
7176 }
7177 default: break;
7178 }
7179 } else if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(LHSI)) {
7180 // Handle icmp {eq|ne} <intrinsic>, intcst.
7181 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
7182 AddToWorkList(II);
7183 ICI.setOperand(0, II->getOperand(1));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007184 ICI.setOperand(1, Context->getConstantInt(RHSV.byteSwap()));
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007185 return &ICI;
7186 }
7187 }
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00007188 }
7189 return 0;
7190}
7191
7192/// visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast - Handle icmp (cast x to y), (cast/cst).
7193/// We only handle extending casts so far.
7194///
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007195Instruction *InstCombiner::visitICmpInstWithCastAndCast(ICmpInst &ICI) {
7196 const CastInst *LHSCI = cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(0));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007197 Value *LHSCIOp = LHSCI->getOperand(0);
7198 const Type *SrcTy = LHSCIOp->getType();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007199 const Type *DestTy = LHSCI->getType();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007200 Value *RHSCIOp;
7201
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007202 // Turn icmp (ptrtoint x), (ptrtoint/c) into a compare of the input if the
7203 // integer type is the same size as the pointer type.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007204 if (TD && LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::PtrToInt &&
7205 TD->getPointerSizeInBits() ==
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007206 cast<IntegerType>(DestTy)->getBitWidth()) {
7207 Value *RHSOp = 0;
7208 if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007209 RHSOp = Context->getConstantExprIntToPtr(RHSC, SrcTy);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007210 } else if (PtrToIntInst *RHSC = dyn_cast<PtrToIntInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
7211 RHSOp = RHSC->getOperand(0);
7212 // If the pointer types don't match, insert a bitcast.
7213 if (LHSCIOp->getType() != RHSOp->getType())
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +00007214 RHSOp = InsertBitCastBefore(RHSOp, LHSCIOp->getType(), ICI);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007215 }
7216
7217 if (RHSOp)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007218 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSOp);
Chris Lattner8c756c12007-05-05 22:41:33 +00007219 }
7220
7221 // The code below only handles extension cast instructions, so far.
7222 // Enforce this.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007223 if (LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::ZExt &&
7224 LHSCI->getOpcode() != Instruction::SExt)
Chris Lattnerb352fa52005-01-17 03:20:02 +00007225 return 0;
7226
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007227 bool isSignedExt = LHSCI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt;
7228 bool isSignedCmp = ICI.isSignedPredicate();
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007229
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007230 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(ICI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007231 // Not an extension from the same type?
7232 RHSCIOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007233 if (RHSCIOp->getType() != LHSCIOp->getType())
7234 return 0;
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007235
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007236 // If the signedness of the two casts doesn't agree (i.e. one is a sext
Chris Lattnera5c5e772007-01-13 23:11:38 +00007237 // and the other is a zext), then we can't handle this.
7238 if (CI->getOpcode() != LHSCI->getOpcode())
7239 return 0;
7240
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007241 // Deal with equality cases early.
7242 if (ICI.isEquality())
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007243 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007244
7245 // A signed comparison of sign extended values simplifies into a
7246 // signed comparison.
7247 if (isSignedCmp && isSignedExt)
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007248 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Nick Lewycky4189a532008-01-28 03:48:02 +00007249
7250 // The other three cases all fold into an unsigned comparison.
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007251 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getUnsignedPredicate(), LHSCIOp, RHSCIOp);
Reid Spencer6731d5c2004-11-28 21:31:15 +00007252 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007253
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007254 // If we aren't dealing with a constant on the RHS, exit early
7255 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI.getOperand(1));
7256 if (!CI)
7257 return 0;
7258
7259 // Compute the constant that would happen if we truncated to SrcTy then
7260 // reextended to DestTy.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007261 Constant *Res1 = Context->getConstantExprTrunc(CI, SrcTy);
7262 Constant *Res2 = Context->getConstantExprCast(LHSCI->getOpcode(),
7263 Res1, DestTy);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007264
7265 // If the re-extended constant didn't change...
7266 if (Res2 == CI) {
7267 // Make sure that sign of the Cmp and the sign of the Cast are the same.
7268 // For example, we might have:
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007269 // %A = sext i16 %X to i32
7270 // %B = icmp ugt i32 %A, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007271 // It is incorrect to transform this into
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007272 // %B = icmp ugt i16 %X, 1330
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007273 // because %A may have negative value.
7274 //
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007275 // However, we allow this when the compare is EQ/NE, because they are
7276 // signless.
7277 if (isSignedExt == isSignedCmp || ICI.isEquality())
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007278 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICI.getPredicate(), LHSCIOp, Res1);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007279 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007280 }
7281
7282 // The re-extended constant changed so the constant cannot be represented
7283 // in the shorter type. Consequently, we cannot emit a simple comparison.
7284
7285 // First, handle some easy cases. We know the result cannot be equal at this
7286 // point so handle the ICI.isEquality() cases
7287 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00007288 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getFalse());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007289 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00007290 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getTrue());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007291
7292 // Evaluate the comparison for LT (we invert for GT below). LE and GE cases
7293 // should have been folded away previously and not enter in here.
7294 Value *Result;
7295 if (isSignedCmp) {
7296 // We're performing a signed comparison.
Reid Spencer0460fb32007-03-22 20:36:03 +00007297 if (cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue().isNegative())
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00007298 Result = Context->getFalse(); // X < (small) --> false
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007299 else
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00007300 Result = Context->getTrue(); // X < (large) --> true
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007301 } else {
7302 // We're performing an unsigned comparison.
7303 if (isSignedExt) {
7304 // We're performing an unsigned comp with a sign extended value.
7305 // This is true if the input is >= 0. [aka >s -1]
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00007306 Constant *NegOne = Context->getAllOnesValue(SrcTy);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00007307 Result = InsertNewInstBefore(new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT,
7308 LHSCIOp, NegOne, ICI.getName()), ICI);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007309 } else {
7310 // Unsigned extend & unsigned compare -> always true.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00007311 Result = Context->getTrue();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007312 }
7313 }
7314
7315 // Finally, return the value computed.
7316 if (ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT ||
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007317 ICI.getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT)
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007318 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Result);
Chris Lattnerf2991842008-07-11 04:09:09 +00007319
7320 assert((ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT ||
7321 ICI.getPredicate()==ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) &&
7322 "ICmp should be folded!");
7323 if (Constant *CI = dyn_cast<Constant>(Result))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007324 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(ICI, Context->getConstantExprNot(CI));
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00007325 return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, Result);
Chris Lattner484d3cf2005-04-24 06:59:08 +00007326}
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007327
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007328Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
7329 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7330}
7331
7332Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
7333 return commonShiftTransforms(I);
7334}
7335
7336Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007337 if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
7338 return R;
7339
7340 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
7341
7342 // ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
7343 if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
7344 if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
7345 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007346
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007347 // See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
7348 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
7349 APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())))
7350 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
7351
7352 // Arithmetic shifting an all-sign-bit value is a no-op.
7353 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op0);
7354 if (NumSignBits == Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())
7355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Dan Gohman0001e562009-02-24 02:00:40 +00007356
Chris Lattner348f6652007-12-06 01:59:46 +00007357 return 0;
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007358}
7359
7360Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
7361 assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +00007362 Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007363
7364 // shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
7365 // shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007366 if (Op1 == Context->getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
7367 Op0 == Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
Chris Lattner233f7dc2002-08-12 21:17:25 +00007368 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007369
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007370 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
7371 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
Chris Lattner79a564c2004-10-16 23:28:04 +00007372 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007373 else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007374 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007375 }
7376 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00007377 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
7378 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
7379 else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007380 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00007381 }
7382
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007383 // See if we can fold away this shift.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007384 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
Dan Gohman9004c8a2009-05-21 02:28:33 +00007385 return &I;
7386
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007387 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7388 if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
7389 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007390 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00007391 return R;
7392
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007393 if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007394 if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
7395 return Res;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007396 return 0;
7397}
7398
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007399Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007400 BinaryOperator &I) {
Chris Lattner4598c942009-01-31 08:24:16 +00007401 bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007402
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007403 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
7404 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007405 uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8d6bbdb2006-02-12 08:07:37 +00007406
Dan Gohmana119de82009-06-14 23:30:43 +00007407 // shl i32 X, 32 = 0 and srl i8 Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate
7408 // a signed shift.
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007409 //
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007410 if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
Chris Lattner0737c242007-02-02 05:29:55 +00007411 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007412 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007413 else {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007414 I.setOperand(1, Context->getConstantInt(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007415 return &I;
Chris Lattner8adac752004-02-23 20:30:06 +00007416 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007417 }
7418
7419 // ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
7420 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
7421 if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
7422 if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007423 return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007424 Context->getConstantExprShl(BOOp, Op1));
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007425
7426 // Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
7427 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
7428 if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI, this))
7429 return R;
7430 if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
7431 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
7432 return NV;
7433
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007434 // Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
7435 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
7436 Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
7437 // If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
7438 // place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
7439 // require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
7440 // confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
7441 // xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
7442 if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
7443 isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
7444 // Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007445 Constant *ShAmt = Context->getConstantExprZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007446 Instruction *NSh = BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007447 I.getName());
7448 InsertNewInstBefore(NSh, I); // (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
7449
7450 // For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
7451 // part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
7452 // clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
7453 // other xforms later if dead.
Dan Gohmanc6ac3222009-06-16 19:55:29 +00007454 unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
7455 unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007456 APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
7457
7458 // The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
7459 // between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
7460 // shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
7461 // mask as appropriate.
7462 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
7463 MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
7464 else {
7465 assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
7466 MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
7467 }
7468
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007469 Instruction *And =
7470 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NSh, Context->getConstantInt(MaskV),
7471 TI->getName());
Chris Lattner8999dd32007-12-22 09:07:47 +00007472 InsertNewInstBefore(And, I); // shift1 & 0x00FF
7473
7474 // Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
7475 return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
7476 }
7477 }
7478
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007479 if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007480 if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
7481 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
7482 Value *V1, *V2;
7483 ConstantInt *CC;
7484 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007485 default: break;
7486 case Instruction::Add:
7487 case Instruction::And:
7488 case Instruction::Or:
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007489 case Instruction::Xor: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007490 // These operators commute.
7491 // Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007492 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007493 match(Op0BO->getOperand(1), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
7494 m_Specific(Op1)), *Context)){
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007495 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007496 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007497 Op0BO->getName());
7498 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007499 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007500 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007501 Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007502 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007503 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007504 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, Context->getConstantInt(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007505 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007506 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007507
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007508 // Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007509 Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner3c698492007-03-05 00:11:19 +00007510 if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007511 match(Op0BOOp1,
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007512 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007513 m_ConstantInt(CC)), *Context) &&
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00007514 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007515 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007516 Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
7517 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007518 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7519 Instruction *XM =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007520 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1,
7521 Context->getConstantExprShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007522 V1->getName()+".mask");
7523 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7524
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007525 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007526 }
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007527 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007528
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007529 // FALL THROUGH.
7530 case Instruction::Sub: {
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007531 // Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007532 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007533 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
7534 m_Specific(Op1)), *Context)){
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007535 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007536 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7537 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007538 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007539 Instruction *X =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007540 BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007541 Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007542 InsertNewInstBefore(X, I); // (X + (Y << C))
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00007543 uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007544 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, Context->getConstantInt(
Zhou Sheng90b96812007-03-30 05:45:18 +00007545 APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007546 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007547
Chris Lattner13d4ab42006-05-31 21:14:00 +00007548 // Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007549 if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
7550 match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
7551 m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00007552 m_ConstantInt(CC)), *Context) && V2 == Op1 &&
Chris Lattner9a4cacb2006-02-09 07:41:14 +00007553 cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
7554 ->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007555 Instruction *YS = BinaryOperator::CreateShl(
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007556 Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1,
7557 Op0BO->getName());
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007558 InsertNewInstBefore(YS, I); // (Y << C)
7559 Instruction *XM =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007560 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1,
7561 Context->getConstantExprShl(CC, Op1),
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007562 V1->getName()+".mask");
7563 InsertNewInstBefore(XM, I); // X & (CC << C)
7564
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007565 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
Chris Lattner150f12a2005-09-18 06:30:59 +00007566 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007567
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007568 break;
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00007569 }
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007570 }
7571
7572
7573 // If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
7574 // shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
7575 if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
7576 bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
7577 bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
7578
7579 switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007580 default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
Chris Lattner1f7e1602004-10-08 03:46:20 +00007581 case Instruction::Add:
7582 isValid = isLeftShift;
7583 break;
Chris Lattnerdf17af12003-08-12 21:53:41 +00007584 case Instruction::Or:
7585 case Instruction::Xor:
7586 highBitSet = false;
7587 break;
7588 case Instruction::And:
7589 highBitSet = true;
7590 break;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007591 }
7592
7593 // If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
7594 // by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
7595 // The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
7596 // the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
7597 // operation.
7598 //
Chris Lattnerc95ba442007-12-06 06:25:04 +00007599 if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007600 isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007601
7602 if (isValid) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007603 Constant *NewRHS = Context->getConstantExpr(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007604
7605 Instruction *NewShift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007606 BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007607 InsertNewInstBefore(NewShift, I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007608 NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007609
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007610 return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
Chris Lattner4d5542c2006-01-06 07:12:35 +00007611 NewRHS);
7612 }
7613 }
7614 }
7615 }
7616
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007617 // Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00007618 BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
7619 if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
7620 ShiftOp = 0;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007621
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007622 if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007623 ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +00007624 uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
7625 uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007626 assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
7627 if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
7628 Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007629
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007630 uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007631
7632 const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
7633
7634 // Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
Chris Lattner7f3da2d2007-02-03 23:28:07 +00007635 if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007636 // If this is oversized composite shift, then unsigned shifts get 0, ashr
7637 // saturates.
7638 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits) {
7639 if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007640 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007641 AmtSum = TypeBits-1; // Saturate to 31 for i32 ashr.
7642 }
7643
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007644 return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007645 Context->getConstantInt(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007646 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
7647 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007648 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007649 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Context->getNullValue(I.getType()));
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007650
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007651 // ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007652 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007653 } else if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
7654 I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7655 // ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
Chris Lattner344c7c52009-03-20 22:41:15 +00007656 if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
7657 AmtSum = TypeBits-1;
7658
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007659 Instruction *Shift =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007660 BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, AmtSum));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007661 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7662
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007663 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007664 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007665 }
7666
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007667 // Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
7668 // right. See if the amounts are equal.
7669 if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
7670 // If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
7671 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007672 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007673 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007674 }
7675 // If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
7676 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
Zhou Sheng3a507fd2007-04-01 17:13:37 +00007677 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007678 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007679 }
7680 // We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
7681 // NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
7682 // types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
7683 // generators.
7684 const Type *SExtType = 0;
7685 switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007686 case 1 :
7687 case 8 :
7688 case 16 :
7689 case 32 :
7690 case 64 :
7691 case 128:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007692 SExtType = Context->getIntegerType(Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Shenge9e03f62007-03-28 15:02:20 +00007693 break;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007694 default: break;
7695 }
7696 if (SExtType) {
7697 Instruction *NewTrunc = new TruncInst(X, SExtType, "sext");
7698 InsertNewInstBefore(NewTrunc, I);
7699 return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, Ty);
7700 }
7701 // Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
7702 } else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007703 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007704
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007705 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007706 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7707 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7708 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007709 Instruction *Shift =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007710 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnere8d56c52006-01-07 01:32:28 +00007711 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7712
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007713 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007714 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007715 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007716
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007717 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007718 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7719 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7720 Instruction *Shift =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007721 BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007722 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007723
Reid Spencerd5e30f02007-03-26 17:18:58 +00007724 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007725 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattner11021cb2005-09-18 05:12:10 +00007726 }
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007727
7728 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
7729 } else {
7730 assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
Zhou Sheng4351c642007-04-02 08:20:41 +00007731 uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007732
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007733 // (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007734 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7735 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
7736 ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
7737 Instruction *Shift =
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007738 BinaryOperator::Create(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007739 Context->getConstantInt(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007740 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7741
Reid Spencer55702aa2007-03-25 21:11:44 +00007742 APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007743 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007744 }
7745
Chris Lattnerb0b991a2007-02-05 05:57:49 +00007746 // (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007747 if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
7748 assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
7749 Instruction *Shift =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007750 BinaryOperator::CreateShl(X, Context->getConstantInt(Ty, ShiftDiff));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007751 InsertNewInstBefore(Shift, I);
7752
Reid Spencer68d27cf2007-03-26 23:45:51 +00007753 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007754 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift, Context->getConstantInt(Mask));
Chris Lattnerb87056f2007-02-05 00:57:54 +00007755 }
7756
7757 // We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00007758 }
Chris Lattnerad0124c2006-01-06 07:52:12 +00007759 }
Chris Lattner3f5b8772002-05-06 16:14:14 +00007760 return 0;
7761}
7762
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +00007763
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007764/// DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr - Analyze 'Val', seeing if it is a simple linear
7765/// expression. If so, decompose it, returning some value X, such that Val is
7766/// X*Scale+Offset.
7767///
7768static Value *DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(Value *Val, unsigned &Scale,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00007769 int &Offset, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007770 assert(Val->getType() == Type::Int32Ty && "Unexpected allocation size type!");
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007771 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Val)) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007772 Offset = CI->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007773 Scale = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007774 return Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007775 } else if (BinaryOperator *I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Val)) {
7776 if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
7777 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
7778 // This is a value scaled by '1 << the shift amt'.
7779 Scale = 1U << RHS->getZExtValue();
7780 Offset = 0;
7781 return I->getOperand(0);
7782 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul) {
7783 // This value is scaled by 'RHS'.
7784 Scale = RHS->getZExtValue();
7785 Offset = 0;
7786 return I->getOperand(0);
7787 } else if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
7788 // We have X+C. Check to see if we really have (X*C2)+C1,
7789 // where C1 is divisible by C2.
7790 unsigned SubScale;
7791 Value *SubVal =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007792 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(I->getOperand(0), SubScale,
7793 Offset, Context);
Chris Lattner6a94de22007-10-12 05:30:59 +00007794 Offset += RHS->getZExtValue();
7795 Scale = SubScale;
7796 return SubVal;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007797 }
7798 }
7799 }
7800
7801 // Otherwise, we can't look past this.
7802 Scale = 1;
7803 Offset = 0;
7804 return Val;
7805}
7806
7807
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007808/// PromoteCastOfAllocation - If we find a cast of an allocation instruction,
7809/// try to eliminate the cast by moving the type information into the alloc.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007810Instruction *InstCombiner::PromoteCastOfAllocation(BitCastInst &CI,
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007811 AllocationInst &AI) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00007812 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(CI.getType());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007813
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007814 // Remove any uses of AI that are dead.
7815 assert(!CI.use_empty() && "Dead instructions should be removed earlier!");
Chris Lattner535014f2007-02-15 22:52:10 +00007816
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007817 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI.use_begin(), E = AI.use_end(); UI != E; ) {
7818 Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI++);
7819 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(User)) {
7820 while (UI != E && *UI == User)
7821 ++UI; // If this instruction uses AI more than once, don't break UI.
7822
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007823 ++NumDeadInst;
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +00007824 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *User;
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +00007825 EraseInstFromFunction(*User);
Chris Lattnerb53c2382005-10-24 06:22:12 +00007826 }
7827 }
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00007828
7829 // This requires TargetData to get the alloca alignment and size information.
7830 if (!TD) return 0;
7831
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007832 // Get the type really allocated and the type casted to.
7833 const Type *AllocElTy = AI.getAllocatedType();
7834 const Type *CastElTy = PTy->getElementType();
7835 if (!AllocElTy->isSized() || !CastElTy->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007836
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +00007837 unsigned AllocElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(AllocElTy);
7838 unsigned CastElTyAlign = TD->getABITypeAlignment(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007839 if (CastElTyAlign < AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
7840
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007841 // If the allocation has multiple uses, only promote it if we are strictly
7842 // increasing the alignment of the resultant allocation. If we keep it the
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007843 // same, we open the door to infinite loops of various kinds. (A reference
7844 // from a dbg.declare doesn't count as a use for this purpose.)
7845 if (!AI.hasOneUse() && !hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI) &&
7846 CastElTyAlign == AllocElTyAlign) return 0;
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007847
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00007848 uint64_t AllocElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AllocElTy);
7849 uint64_t CastElTySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(CastElTy);
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007850 if (CastElTySize == 0 || AllocElTySize == 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner18e78bb2005-10-24 06:26:18 +00007851
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007852 // See if we can satisfy the modulus by pulling a scale out of the array
7853 // size argument.
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007854 unsigned ArraySizeScale;
7855 int ArrayOffset;
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007856 Value *NumElements = // See if the array size is a decomposable linear expr.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007857 DecomposeSimpleLinearExpr(AI.getOperand(0), ArraySizeScale,
7858 ArrayOffset, Context);
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007859
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007860 // If we can now satisfy the modulus, by using a non-1 scale, we really can
7861 // do the xform.
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007862 if ((AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale) % CastElTySize != 0 ||
7863 (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset ) % CastElTySize != 0) return 0;
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007864
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007865 unsigned Scale = (AllocElTySize*ArraySizeScale)/CastElTySize;
7866 Value *Amt = 0;
7867 if (Scale == 1) {
7868 Amt = NumElements;
7869 } else {
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007870 // If the allocation size is constant, form a constant mul expression
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007871 Amt = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Scale);
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +00007872 if (isa<ConstantInt>(NumElements))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007873 Amt = Context->getConstantExprMul(cast<ConstantInt>(NumElements),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007874 cast<ConstantInt>(Amt));
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00007875 // otherwise multiply the amount and the number of elements
Chris Lattner46d232d2009-03-17 17:55:15 +00007876 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007877 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Amt, NumElements, "tmp");
Chris Lattner455fcc82005-10-29 03:19:53 +00007878 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
Chris Lattner8142b0a2005-10-27 06:12:00 +00007879 }
Chris Lattner0ddac2a2005-10-27 05:53:56 +00007880 }
7881
Jeff Cohen86796be2007-04-04 16:58:57 +00007882 if (int Offset = (AllocElTySize*ArrayOffset)/CastElTySize) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00007883 Value *Off = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Offset, true);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00007884 Instruction *Tmp = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Amt, Off, "tmp");
Chris Lattnercfd65102005-10-29 04:36:15 +00007885 Amt = InsertNewInstBefore(Tmp, AI);
7886 }
7887
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007888 AllocationInst *New;
7889 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Owen Anderson50dead02009-07-15 23:53:25 +00007890 New = new MallocInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007891 else
Owen Anderson50dead02009-07-15 23:53:25 +00007892 New = new AllocaInst(CastElTy, Amt, AI.getAlignment());
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007893 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +00007894 New->takeName(&AI);
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007895
Dale Johannesena0a66372009-03-05 00:39:02 +00007896 // If the allocation has one real use plus a dbg.declare, just remove the
7897 // declare.
7898 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(&AI)) {
7899 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
7900 }
7901 // If the allocation has multiple real uses, insert a cast and change all
7902 // things that used it to use the new cast. This will also hack on CI, but it
7903 // will die soon.
7904 else if (!AI.hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007905 AddUsesToWorkList(AI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00007906 // New is the allocation instruction, pointer typed. AI is the original
7907 // allocation instruction, also pointer typed. Thus, cast to use is BitCast.
7908 CastInst *NewCast = new BitCastInst(New, AI.getType(), "tmpcast");
Chris Lattner39387a52005-10-24 06:35:18 +00007909 InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, AI);
7910 AI.replaceAllUsesWith(NewCast);
7911 }
Chris Lattnerb3f83972005-10-24 06:03:58 +00007912 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, New);
7913}
7914
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007915/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType - Return true if we can take the specified value
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007916/// and return it as type Ty without inserting any new casts and without
7917/// changing the computed value. This is used by code that tries to decide
7918/// whether promoting or shrinking integer operations to wider or smaller types
7919/// will allow us to eliminate a truncate or extend.
7920///
7921/// This is a truncation operation if Ty is smaller than V->getType(), or an
7922/// extension operation if Ty is larger.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007923///
7924/// If CastOpc is a truncation, then Ty will be a type smaller than V. We
7925/// should return true if trunc(V) can be computed by computing V in the smaller
7926/// type. If V is an instruction, then trunc(inst(x,y)) can be computed as
7927/// inst(trunc(x),trunc(y)), which only makes sense if x and y can be
7928/// efficiently truncated.
7929///
7930/// If CastOpc is a sext or zext, we are asking if the low bits of the value can
7931/// bit computed in a larger type, which is then and'd or sext_in_reg'd to get
7932/// the final result.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007933bool InstCombiner::CanEvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007934 unsigned CastOpc,
7935 int &NumCastsRemoved){
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007936 // We can always evaluate constants in another type.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007937 if (isa<Constant>(V))
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007938 return true;
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007939
7940 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007941 if (!I) return false;
7942
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007943 const Type *OrigTy = V->getType();
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007944
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007945 // If this is an extension or truncate, we can often eliminate it.
7946 if (isa<TruncInst>(I) || isa<ZExtInst>(I) || isa<SExtInst>(I)) {
7947 // If this is a cast from the destination type, we can trivially eliminate
7948 // it, and this will remove a cast overall.
7949 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty) {
7950 // If the first operand is itself a cast, and is eliminable, do not count
7951 // this as an eliminable cast. We would prefer to eliminate those two
7952 // casts first.
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00007953 if (!isa<CastInst>(I->getOperand(0)) && I->hasOneUse())
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007954 ++NumCastsRemoved;
7955 return true;
7956 }
7957 }
7958
7959 // We can't extend or shrink something that has multiple uses: doing so would
7960 // require duplicating the instruction in general, which isn't profitable.
7961 if (!I->hasOneUse()) return false;
7962
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00007963 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
7964 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007965 case Instruction::Add:
7966 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00007967 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00007968 case Instruction::And:
7969 case Instruction::Or:
7970 case Instruction::Xor:
7971 // These operators can all arbitrarily be extended or truncated.
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007972 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007973 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00007974 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00007975 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007976
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00007977 case Instruction::UDiv:
7978 case Instruction::URem: {
7979 // UDiv and URem can be truncated if all the truncated bits are zero.
7980 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
7981 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7982 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth) {
7983 APInt Mask = APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth);
7984 if (MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0), Mask) &&
7985 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(1), Mask)) {
7986 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
7987 NumCastsRemoved) &&
7988 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, CastOpc,
7989 NumCastsRemoved);
7990 }
7991 }
7992 break;
7993 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00007994 case Instruction::Shl:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00007995 // If we are truncating the result of this SHL, and if it's a shift of a
7996 // constant amount, we can always perform a SHL in a smaller type.
7997 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00007998 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
7999 if (BitWidth < OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits() &&
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00008000 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth)
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008001 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008002 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008003 }
8004 break;
8005 case Instruction::LShr:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008006 // If this is a truncate of a logical shr, we can truncate it to a smaller
8007 // lshr iff we know that the bits we would otherwise be shifting in are
8008 // already zeros.
8009 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008010 uint32_t OrigBitWidth = OrigTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8011 uint32_t BitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00008012 if (BitWidth < OrigBitWidth &&
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008013 MaskedValueIsZero(I->getOperand(0),
Zhou Sheng302748d2007-03-30 17:20:39 +00008014 APInt::getHighBitsSet(OrigBitWidth, OrigBitWidth-BitWidth)) &&
8015 CI->getLimitedValue(BitWidth) < BitWidth) {
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008016 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008017 NumCastsRemoved);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008018 }
8019 }
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008020 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008021 case Instruction::ZExt:
8022 case Instruction::SExt:
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008023 case Instruction::Trunc:
8024 // If this is the same kind of case as our original (e.g. zext+zext), we
Chris Lattner5543a852007-08-02 17:23:38 +00008025 // can safely replace it. Note that replacing it does not reduce the number
8026 // of casts in the input.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008027 if (Opc == CastOpc)
8028 return true;
8029
8030 // sext (zext ty1), ty2 -> zext ty2
Evan Cheng661d9c32009-01-15 17:09:07 +00008031 if (CastOpc == Instruction::SExt && Opc == Instruction::ZExt)
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008032 return true;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008033 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008034 case Instruction::Select: {
8035 SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I);
8036 return CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getTrueValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008037 NumCastsRemoved) &&
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008038 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SI->getFalseValue(), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008039 NumCastsRemoved);
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008040 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008041 case Instruction::PHI: {
8042 // We can change a phi if we can change all operands.
8043 PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I);
8044 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
8045 if (!CanEvaluateInDifferentType(PN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, CastOpc,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008046 NumCastsRemoved))
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008047 return false;
8048 return true;
8049 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008050 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008051 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
8052 break;
8053 }
8054
8055 return false;
8056}
8057
8058/// EvaluateInDifferentType - Given an expression that
8059/// CanEvaluateInDifferentType returns true for, actually insert the code to
8060/// evaluate the expression.
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008061Value *InstCombiner::EvaluateInDifferentType(Value *V, const Type *Ty,
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008062 bool isSigned) {
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008063 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008064 return Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(C, Ty,
8065 isSigned /*Sext or ZExt*/);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008066
8067 // Otherwise, it must be an instruction.
8068 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(V);
Chris Lattner01859e82006-05-20 23:14:03 +00008069 Instruction *Res = 0;
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008070 unsigned Opc = I->getOpcode();
8071 switch (Opc) {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008072 case Instruction::Add:
8073 case Instruction::Sub:
Nick Lewyckye6b0c002008-01-22 05:08:48 +00008074 case Instruction::Mul:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008075 case Instruction::And:
8076 case Instruction::Or:
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008077 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008078 case Instruction::AShr:
8079 case Instruction::LShr:
Eli Friedman070a9812009-07-13 22:46:01 +00008080 case Instruction::Shl:
8081 case Instruction::UDiv:
8082 case Instruction::URem: {
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008083 Value *LHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(0), Ty, isSigned);
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008084 Value *RHS = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008085 Res = BinaryOperator::Create((Instruction::BinaryOps)Opc, LHS, RHS);
Chris Lattner46b96052006-11-29 07:18:39 +00008086 break;
8087 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008088 case Instruction::Trunc:
8089 case Instruction::ZExt:
8090 case Instruction::SExt:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008091 // If the source type of the cast is the type we're trying for then we can
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008092 // just return the source. There's no need to insert it because it is not
8093 // new.
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008094 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() == Ty)
8095 return I->getOperand(0);
8096
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008097 // Otherwise, must be the same type of cast, so just reinsert a new one.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008098 Res = CastInst::Create(cast<CastInst>(I)->getOpcode(), I->getOperand(0),
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008099 Ty);
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008100 break;
Nick Lewyckyb8cd6a42008-07-05 21:19:34 +00008101 case Instruction::Select: {
8102 Value *True = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(1), Ty, isSigned);
8103 Value *False = EvaluateInDifferentType(I->getOperand(2), Ty, isSigned);
8104 Res = SelectInst::Create(I->getOperand(0), True, False);
8105 break;
8106 }
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008107 case Instruction::PHI: {
8108 PHINode *OPN = cast<PHINode>(I);
8109 PHINode *NPN = PHINode::Create(Ty);
8110 for (unsigned i = 0, e = OPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
8111 Value *V =EvaluateInDifferentType(OPN->getIncomingValue(i), Ty, isSigned);
8112 NPN->addIncoming(V, OPN->getIncomingBlock(i));
8113 }
8114 Res = NPN;
8115 break;
8116 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008117 default:
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008118 // TODO: Can handle more cases here.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008119 llvm_unreachable("Unreachable!");
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008120 break;
8121 }
8122
Chris Lattner8114b712008-06-18 04:00:49 +00008123 Res->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner70074e02006-05-13 02:06:03 +00008124 return InsertNewInstBefore(Res, *I);
8125}
8126
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008127/// @brief Implement the transforms common to all CastInst visitors.
8128Instruction *InstCombiner::commonCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner79d35b32003-06-23 21:59:52 +00008129 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8130
Dan Gohman23d9d272007-05-11 21:10:54 +00008131 // Many cases of "cast of a cast" are eliminable. If it's eliminable we just
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008132 // eliminate it now.
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008133 if (CastInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008134 if (Instruction::CastOps opc =
8135 isEliminableCastPair(CSrc, CI.getOpcode(), CI.getType(), TD)) {
8136 // The first cast (CSrc) is eliminable so we need to fix up or replace
8137 // the second cast (CI). CSrc will then have a good chance of being dead.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008138 return CastInst::Create(opc, CSrc->getOperand(0), CI.getType());
Chris Lattner8fd217c2002-08-02 20:00:25 +00008139 }
8140 }
Chris Lattnera710ddc2004-05-25 04:29:21 +00008141
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008142 // If we are casting a select then fold the cast into the select
Chris Lattner6e7ba452005-01-01 16:22:27 +00008143 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Src))
8144 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoSelect(CI, SI, this))
8145 return NV;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008146
8147 // If we are casting a PHI then fold the cast into the PHI
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008148 if (isa<PHINode>(Src))
8149 if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(CI))
8150 return NV;
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008151
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008152 return 0;
8153}
8154
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008155/// FindElementAtOffset - Given a type and a constant offset, determine whether
8156/// or not there is a sequence of GEP indices into the type that will land us at
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008157/// the specified offset. If so, fill them into NewIndices and return the
8158/// resultant element type, otherwise return null.
8159static const Type *FindElementAtOffset(const Type *Ty, int64_t Offset,
8160 SmallVectorImpl<Value*> &NewIndices,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008161 const TargetData *TD,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008162 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008163 if (!TD) return 0;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008164 if (!Ty->isSized()) return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008165
8166 // Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
8167 // might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
8168 // is something like [0 x {int, int}]
8169 const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType();
8170 int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008171 if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(Ty)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008172 FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
Chris Lattner31a69cb2009-01-11 20:41:36 +00008173 Offset -= FirstIdx*TySize;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008174
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008175 // Handle hosts where % returns negative instead of values [0..TySize).
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008176 if (Offset < 0) {
8177 --FirstIdx;
8178 Offset += TySize;
8179 assert(Offset >= 0);
8180 }
8181 assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize && "Out of range offset");
8182 }
8183
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008184 NewIndices.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008185
8186 // Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
8187 while (Offset) {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008188 // Indexing into tail padding between struct/array elements.
8189 if (uint64_t(Offset*8) >= TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008190 return 0;
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008191
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008192 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) {
8193 const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008194 assert(Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes() &&
8195 "Offset must stay within the indexed type");
8196
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008197 unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008198 NewIndices.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Elt));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008199
8200 Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
8201 Ty = STy->getElementType(Elt);
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008202 } else if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +00008203 uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AT->getElementType());
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008204 assert(EltSize && "Cannot index into a zero-sized array");
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008205 NewIndices.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008206 Offset %= EltSize;
Chris Lattner1c412d92009-01-11 20:23:52 +00008207 Ty = AT->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008208 } else {
Chris Lattnerdbc3bc22009-01-11 20:15:20 +00008209 // Otherwise, we can't index into the middle of this atomic type, bail.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008210 return 0;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008211 }
8212 }
8213
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +00008214 return Ty;
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008215}
8216
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008217/// @brief Implement the transforms for cast of pointer (bitcast/ptrtoint)
8218Instruction *InstCombiner::commonPointerCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8219 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8220
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008221 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src)) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008222 // If casting the result of a getelementptr instruction with no offset, turn
8223 // this into a cast of the original pointer!
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008224 if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
8225 // Changing the cast operand is usually not a good idea but it is safe
8226 // here because the pointer operand is being replaced with another
8227 // pointer operand so the opcode doesn't need to change.
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008228 AddToWorkList(GEP);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008229 CI.setOperand(0, GEP->getOperand(0));
8230 return &CI;
8231 }
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008232
8233 // If the GEP has a single use, and the base pointer is a bitcast, and the
8234 // GEP computes a constant offset, see if we can convert these three
8235 // instructions into fewer. This typically happens with unions and other
8236 // non-type-safe code.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008237 if (TD && GEP->hasOneUse() && isa<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008238 if (GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()) {
8239 // We are guaranteed to get a constant from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008240 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
8241 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(GEP, CI, *this));
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008242 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
8243
8244 // Get the base pointer input of the bitcast, and the type it points to.
8245 Value *OrigBase = cast<BitCastInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))->getOperand(0);
8246 const Type *GEPIdxTy =
8247 cast<PointerType>(OrigBase->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008248 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008249 if (FindElementAtOffset(GEPIdxTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008250 // If we were able to index down into an element, create the GEP
8251 // and bitcast the result. This eliminates one bitcast, potentially
8252 // two.
8253 Instruction *NGEP = GetElementPtrInst::Create(OrigBase,
8254 NewIndices.begin(),
8255 NewIndices.end(), "");
8256 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, CI);
8257 NGEP->takeName(GEP);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008258
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +00008259 if (isa<BitCastInst>(CI))
8260 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
8261 assert(isa<PtrToIntInst>(CI));
8262 return new PtrToIntInst(NGEP, CI.getType());
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +00008263 }
8264 }
8265 }
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008266 }
8267
8268 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8269}
8270
Chris Lattnerddfa57b2009-04-08 05:41:03 +00008271/// isSafeIntegerType - Return true if this is a basic integer type, not a crazy
8272/// type like i42. We don't want to introduce operations on random non-legal
8273/// integer types where they don't already exist in the code. In the future,
8274/// we should consider making this based off target-data, so that 32-bit targets
8275/// won't get i64 operations etc.
8276static bool isSafeIntegerType(const Type *Ty) {
8277 switch (Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {
8278 case 8:
8279 case 16:
8280 case 32:
8281 case 64:
8282 return true;
8283 default:
8284 return false;
8285 }
8286}
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008287
Eli Friedmaneb7f7a82009-07-13 20:58:59 +00008288/// commonIntCastTransforms - This function implements the common transforms
8289/// for trunc, zext, and sext.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008290Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIntCastTransforms(CastInst &CI) {
8291 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8292 return Result;
8293
8294 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8295 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8296 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008297 uint32_t SrcBitSize = SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
8298 uint32_t DestBitSize = DestTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008299
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008300 // See if we can simplify any instructions used by the LHS whose sole
8301 // purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
Chris Lattner886ab6c2009-01-31 08:15:18 +00008302 if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(CI))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008303 return &CI;
8304
8305 // If the source isn't an instruction or has more than one use then we
8306 // can't do anything more.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008307 Instruction *SrcI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Src);
8308 if (!SrcI || !Src->hasOneUse())
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008309 return 0;
8310
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008311 // Attempt to propagate the cast into the instruction for int->int casts.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008312 int NumCastsRemoved = 0;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008313 // Only do this if the dest type is a simple type, don't convert the
8314 // expression tree to something weird like i93 unless the source is also
8315 // strange.
8316 if ((isSafeIntegerType(DestTy->getScalarType()) ||
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008317 !isSafeIntegerType(SrcI->getType()->getScalarType())) &&
8318 CanEvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008319 CI.getOpcode(), NumCastsRemoved)) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008320 // If this cast is a truncate, evaluting in a different type always
Chris Lattner951626b2007-08-02 06:11:14 +00008321 // eliminates the cast, so it is always a win. If this is a zero-extension,
8322 // we need to do an AND to maintain the clear top-part of the computation,
8323 // so we require that the input have eliminated at least one cast. If this
8324 // is a sign extension, we insert two new casts (to do the extension) so we
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008325 // require that two casts have been eliminated.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008326 bool DoXForm = false;
8327 bool JustReplace = false;
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008328 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
8329 default:
8330 // All the others use floating point so we shouldn't actually
8331 // get here because of the check above.
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008332 llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type");
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008333 case Instruction::Trunc:
8334 DoXForm = true;
8335 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008336 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008337 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 1;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008338 if (!DoXForm && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008339 // If it's unnecessary to issue an AND to clear the high bits, it's
8340 // always profitable to do this xform.
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008341 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, false);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008342 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8343 if (MaskedValueIsZero(TryRes, Mask))
8344 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008345
8346 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008347 if (TryI->use_empty())
8348 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
8349 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008350 break;
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008351 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008352 case Instruction::SExt: {
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008353 DoXForm = NumCastsRemoved >= 2;
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008354 if (!DoXForm && !isa<TruncInst>(SrcI) && 0) {
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008355 // If we do not have to emit the truncate + sext pair, then it's always
8356 // profitable to do this xform.
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008357 //
8358 // It's not safe to eliminate the trunc + sext pair if one of the
8359 // eliminated cast is a truncate. e.g.
8360 // t2 = trunc i32 t1 to i16
8361 // t3 = sext i16 t2 to i32
8362 // !=
8363 // i32 t1
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008364 Value *TryRes = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy, true);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008365 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(TryRes);
8366 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
8367 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, TryRes);
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008368
8369 if (Instruction *TryI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TryRes))
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008370 if (TryI->use_empty())
8371 EraseInstFromFunction(*TryI);
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008372 }
Chris Lattnerc739cd62007-03-03 05:27:34 +00008373 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008374 }
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008375 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008376
8377 if (DoXForm) {
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008378 DOUT << "ICE: EvaluateInDifferentType converting expression type to avoid"
8379 << " cast: " << CI;
Reid Spencerc55b2432006-12-13 18:21:21 +00008380 Value *Res = EvaluateInDifferentType(SrcI, DestTy,
8381 CI.getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008382 if (JustReplace)
Chris Lattner39c27ed2009-01-31 19:05:27 +00008383 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008385
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008386 assert(Res->getType() == DestTy);
8387 switch (CI.getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00008388 default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown cast type!");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008389 case Instruction::Trunc:
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008390 // Just replace this cast with the result.
8391 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8392 case Instruction::ZExt: {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008393 assert(SrcBitSize < DestBitSize && "Not a zext?");
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008394
8395 // If the high bits are already zero, just replace this cast with the
8396 // result.
8397 APInt Mask(APInt::getBitsSet(DestBitSize, SrcBitSize, DestBitSize));
8398 if (MaskedValueIsZero(Res, Mask))
8399 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8400
8401 // We need to emit an AND to clear the high bits.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008402 Constant *C = Context->getConstantInt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DestBitSize,
Chris Lattnercd1d6d52007-04-02 05:48:58 +00008403 SrcBitSize));
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008404 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Res, C);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008405 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008406 case Instruction::SExt: {
8407 // If the high bits are already filled with sign bit, just replace this
8408 // cast with the result.
8409 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Res);
8410 if (NumSignBits > (DestBitSize - SrcBitSize))
Evan Chengf35fd542009-01-15 17:01:23 +00008411 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8412
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008413 // We need to emit a cast to truncate, then a cast to sext.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008414 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::SExt,
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008415 InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Res, Src->getType(),
8416 CI), DestTy);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008417 }
Evan Cheng4e56ab22009-01-16 02:11:43 +00008418 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008419 }
8420 }
8421
8422 Value *Op0 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 0 ? SrcI->getOperand(0) : 0;
8423 Value *Op1 = SrcI->getNumOperands() > 1 ? SrcI->getOperand(1) : 0;
8424
8425 switch (SrcI->getOpcode()) {
8426 case Instruction::Add:
8427 case Instruction::Mul:
8428 case Instruction::And:
8429 case Instruction::Or:
8430 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattner01deb9d2007-04-03 17:43:25 +00008431 // If we are discarding information, rewrite.
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008432 if (DestBitSize < SrcBitSize && DestBitSize != 1) {
8433 // Don't insert two casts unless at least one can be eliminated.
8434 if (!ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op1, DestTy, TD) ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008435 !ValueRequiresCast(CI.getOpcode(), Op0, DestTy, TD)) {
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008436 Value *Op0c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op0, DestTy, *SrcI);
8437 Value *Op1c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op1, DestTy, *SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008438 return BinaryOperator::Create(
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +00008439 cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI)->getOpcode(), Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008440 }
8441 }
8442
8443 // cast (xor bool X, true) to int --> xor (cast bool X to int), 1
8444 if (isa<ZExtInst>(CI) && SrcBitSize == 1 &&
8445 SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor &&
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +00008446 Op1 == Context->getTrue() &&
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00008447 (!Op0->hasOneUse() || !isa<CmpInst>(Op0))) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00008448 Value *New = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, Op0, DestTy, CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008449 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(New,
8450 Context->getConstantInt(CI.getType(), 1));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008451 }
8452 break;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008453
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008454 case Instruction::Shl: {
8455 // Canonicalize trunc inside shl, if we can.
8456 ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1);
8457 if (CI && DestBitSize < SrcBitSize &&
8458 CI->getLimitedValue(DestBitSize) < DestBitSize) {
8459 Value *Op0c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op0, DestTy, *SrcI);
8460 Value *Op1c = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op1, DestTy, *SrcI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008461 return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0c, Op1c);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008462 }
8463 break;
Eli Friedman65445c52009-07-13 21:45:57 +00008464 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008465 }
8466 return 0;
8467}
8468
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008469Instruction *InstCombiner::visitTrunc(TruncInst &CI) {
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008470 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8471 return Result;
8472
8473 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8474 const Type *Ty = CI.getType();
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008475 uint32_t DestBitWidth = Ty->getScalarSizeInBits();
8476 uint32_t SrcBitWidth = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008477
8478 // Canonicalize trunc x to i1 -> (icmp ne (and x, 1), 0)
Eli Friedman191a0ae2009-07-18 09:21:25 +00008479 if (DestBitWidth == 1) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008480 Constant *One = Context->getConstantInt(Src->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008481 Src = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Src, One, "tmp"), CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008482 Value *Zero = Context->getNullValue(Src->getType());
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +00008483 return new ICmpInst(*Context, ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, Src, Zero);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008484 }
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008485
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008486 // Optimize trunc(lshr(), c) to pull the shift through the truncate.
8487 ConstantInt *ShAmtV = 0;
8488 Value *ShiftOp = 0;
8489 if (Src->hasOneUse() &&
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00008490 match(Src, m_LShr(m_Value(ShiftOp), m_ConstantInt(ShAmtV)), *Context)) {
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008491 uint32_t ShAmt = ShAmtV->getLimitedValue(SrcBitWidth);
8492
8493 // Get a mask for the bits shifting in.
8494 APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcBitWidth, ShAmt).shl(DestBitWidth));
8495 if (MaskedValueIsZero(ShiftOp, Mask)) {
8496 if (ShAmt >= DestBitWidth) // All zeros.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008497 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Context->getNullValue(Ty));
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008498
8499 // Okay, we can shrink this. Truncate the input, then return a new
8500 // shift.
8501 Value *V1 = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, ShiftOp, Ty, CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008502 Value *V2 = Context->getConstantExprTrunc(ShAmtV, Ty);
Chris Lattner4f9797d2009-03-24 18:15:30 +00008503 return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(V1, V2);
Chris Lattner6aa5eb12006-11-29 07:04:07 +00008504 }
8505 }
8506
8507 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008508}
8509
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008510/// transformZExtICmp - Transform (zext icmp) to bitwise / integer operations
8511/// in order to eliminate the icmp.
8512Instruction *InstCombiner::transformZExtICmp(ICmpInst *ICI, Instruction &CI,
8513 bool DoXform) {
8514 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
8515 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
8516 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
8517 if (ConstantInt *Op1C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(ICI->getOperand(1))) {
8518 const APInt &Op1CV = Op1C->getValue();
8519
8520 // zext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>u31 true if signbit set.
8521 // zext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>u31)^1 true if signbit clear.
8522 if ((ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
8523 (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT &&Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
8524 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8525
8526 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008527 Value *Sh = Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008528 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008529 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In, Sh,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008530 In->getName()+".lobit"),
8531 CI);
8532 if (In->getType() != CI.getType())
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008533 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008534 false/*ZExt*/, "tmp", &CI);
8535
8536 if (ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008537 Constant *One = Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008538 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One,
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008539 In->getName()+".not"),
8540 CI);
8541 }
8542
8543 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8544 }
8545
8546
8547
8548 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8549 // zext (X == 0) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8550 // zext (X == 1) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8551 // zext (X == 2) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8552 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X iff X has only the low bit set.
8553 // zext (X != 0) to i32 --> X>>1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8554 // zext (X != 1) to i32 --> X^1 iff X has only the low bit set.
8555 // zext (X != 2) to i32 --> (X>>1)^1 iff X has only the 2nd bit set.
8556 if ((Op1CV == 0 || Op1CV.isPowerOf2()) &&
8557 // This only works for EQ and NE
8558 ICI->isEquality()) {
8559 // If Op1C some other power of two, convert:
8560 uint32_t BitWidth = Op1C->getType()->getBitWidth();
8561 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
8562 APInt TypeMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth));
8563 ComputeMaskedBits(ICI->getOperand(0), TypeMask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
8564
8565 APInt KnownZeroMask(~KnownZero);
8566 if (KnownZeroMask.isPowerOf2()) { // Exactly 1 possible 1?
8567 if (!DoXform) return ICI;
8568
8569 bool isNE = ICI->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
8570 if (Op1CV != 0 && (Op1CV != KnownZeroMask)) {
8571 // (X&4) == 2 --> false
8572 // (X&4) != 2 --> true
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008573 Constant *Res = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int1Ty, isNE);
8574 Res = Context->getConstantExprZExt(Res, CI.getType());
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008575 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Res);
8576 }
8577
8578 uint32_t ShiftAmt = KnownZeroMask.logBase2();
8579 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
8580 if (ShiftAmt) {
8581 // Perform a logical shr by shiftamt.
8582 // Insert the shift to put the result in the low bit.
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008583 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(In,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008584 Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(), ShiftAmt),
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008585 In->getName()+".lobit"), CI);
8586 }
8587
8588 if ((Op1CV != 0) == isNE) { // Toggle the low bit.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008589 Constant *One = Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(), 1);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008590 In = BinaryOperator::CreateXor(In, One, "tmp");
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008591 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(In), CI);
8592 }
8593
8594 if (CI.getType() == In->getType())
8595 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, In);
8596 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008597 return CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, CI.getType(), false/*ZExt*/);
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008598 }
8599 }
8600 }
8601
8602 return 0;
8603}
8604
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008605Instruction *InstCombiner::visitZExt(ZExtInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008606 // If one of the common conversion will work ..
8607 if (Instruction *Result = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8608 return Result;
8609
8610 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8611
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008612 // If this is a TRUNC followed by a ZEXT then we are dealing with integral
8613 // types and if the sizes are just right we can convert this into a logical
8614 // 'and' which will be much cheaper than the pair of casts.
8615 if (TruncInst *CSrc = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Src)) { // A->B->C cast
8616 // Get the sizes of the types involved. We know that the intermediate type
8617 // will be smaller than A or C, but don't know the relation between A and C.
8618 Value *A = CSrc->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008619 unsigned SrcSize = A->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8620 unsigned MidSize = CSrc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8621 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008622 // If we're actually extending zero bits, then if
8623 // SrcSize < DstSize: zext(a & mask)
8624 // SrcSize == DstSize: a & mask
8625 // SrcSize > DstSize: trunc(a) & mask
8626 if (SrcSize < DstSize) {
8627 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008628 Constant *AndConst = Context->getConstantInt(A->getType(), AndValue);
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008629 Instruction *And =
8630 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, AndConst, CSrc->getName()+".mask");
8631 InsertNewInstBefore(And, CI);
8632 return new ZExtInst(And, CI.getType());
8633 } else if (SrcSize == DstSize) {
8634 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008635 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Context->getConstantInt(A->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008636 AndValue));
Chris Lattnera84f47c2009-02-17 20:47:23 +00008637 } else if (SrcSize > DstSize) {
8638 Instruction *Trunc = new TruncInst(A, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8639 InsertNewInstBefore(Trunc, CI);
8640 APInt AndValue(APInt::getLowBitsSet(DstSize, MidSize));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008641 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Trunc,
8642 Context->getConstantInt(Trunc->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008643 AndValue));
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008644 }
8645 }
8646
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008647 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Src))
8648 return transformZExtICmp(ICI, CI);
Chris Lattnera2e2c9b2007-04-11 06:53:04 +00008649
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008650 BinaryOperator *SrcI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Src);
8651 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
8652 // zext (or icmp, icmp) --> or (zext icmp), (zext icmp) if at least one
8653 // of the (zext icmp) will be transformed.
8654 ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0));
8655 ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SrcI->getOperand(1));
8656 if (LHS && RHS && LHS->hasOneUse() && RHS->hasOneUse() &&
8657 (transformZExtICmp(LHS, CI, false) ||
8658 transformZExtICmp(RHS, CI, false))) {
8659 Value *LCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, LHS, CI.getType(), CI);
8660 Value *RCast = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::ZExt, RHS, CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008661 return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::Or, LCast, RCast);
Chris Lattner66bc3252007-04-11 05:45:39 +00008662 }
Evan Chengb98a10e2008-03-24 00:21:34 +00008663 }
8664
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008665 // zext(trunc(t) & C) -> (t & zext(C)).
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008666 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8667 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8668 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(SrcI->getOperand(0))) {
8669 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008670 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType())
8671 return
8672 BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(TI0,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008673 Context->getConstantExprZExt(C, CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmana392c782009-06-17 23:17:05 +00008674 }
8675
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008676 // zext((trunc(t) & C) ^ C) -> ((t & zext(C)) ^ zext(C)).
8677 if (SrcI && SrcI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Xor && SrcI->hasOneUse())
8678 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SrcI->getOperand(1)))
8679 if (BinaryOperator *And = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(SrcI->getOperand(0)))
8680 if (And->getOpcode() == Instruction::And && And->hasOneUse() &&
8681 And->getOperand(1) == C)
8682 if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(And->getOperand(0))) {
8683 Value *TI0 = TI->getOperand(0);
8684 if (TI0->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008685 Constant *ZC = Context->getConstantExprZExt(C, CI.getType());
Dan Gohmanfd3daa72009-06-18 16:30:21 +00008686 Instruction *NewAnd = BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(TI0, ZC, "tmp");
8687 InsertNewInstBefore(NewAnd, *And);
8688 return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, ZC);
8689 }
8690 }
8691
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008692 return 0;
8693}
8694
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008695Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSExt(SExtInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008696 if (Instruction *I = commonIntCastTransforms(CI))
8697 return I;
8698
Chris Lattner8a9f5712007-04-11 06:57:46 +00008699 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8700
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00008701 // Canonicalize sign-extend from i1 to a select.
8702 if (Src->getType() == Type::Int1Ty)
8703 return SelectInst::Create(Src,
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00008704 Context->getAllOnesValue(CI.getType()),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008705 Context->getNullValue(CI.getType()));
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008706
8707 // See if the value being truncated is already sign extended. If so, just
8708 // eliminate the trunc/sext pair.
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00008709 if (Operator::getOpcode(Src) == Instruction::Trunc) {
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008710 Value *Op = cast<User>(Src)->getOperand(0);
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008711 unsigned OpBits = Op->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8712 unsigned MidBits = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8713 unsigned DestBits = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Dan Gohmanf35c8822008-05-20 21:01:12 +00008714 unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op);
8715
8716 if (OpBits == DestBits) {
8717 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 24 sign
8718 // bits, it is already ready.
8719 if (NumSignBits > DestBits-MidBits)
8720 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Op);
8721 } else if (OpBits < DestBits) {
8722 // Op is i32, Mid is i8, and Dest is i64. If Op has more than 24 sign
8723 // bits, just sext from i32.
8724 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8725 return new SExtInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8726 } else {
8727 // Op is i64, Mid is i8, and Dest is i32. If Op has more than 56 sign
8728 // bits, just truncate to i32.
8729 if (NumSignBits > OpBits-MidBits)
8730 return new TruncInst(Op, CI.getType(), "tmp");
8731 }
8732 }
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008733
8734 // If the input is a shl/ashr pair of a same constant, then this is a sign
8735 // extension from a smaller value. If we could trust arbitrary bitwidth
8736 // integers, we could turn this into a truncate to the smaller bit and then
8737 // use a sext for the whole extension. Since we don't, look deeper and check
8738 // for a truncate. If the source and dest are the same type, eliminate the
8739 // trunc and extend and just do shifts. For example, turn:
8740 // %a = trunc i32 %i to i8
8741 // %b = shl i8 %a, 6
8742 // %c = ashr i8 %b, 6
8743 // %d = sext i8 %c to i32
8744 // into:
8745 // %a = shl i32 %i, 30
8746 // %d = ashr i32 %a, 30
8747 Value *A = 0;
8748 ConstantInt *BA = 0, *CA = 0;
8749 if (match(Src, m_AShr(m_Shl(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(BA)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00008750 m_ConstantInt(CA)), *Context) &&
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008751 BA == CA && isa<TruncInst>(A)) {
8752 Value *I = cast<TruncInst>(A)->getOperand(0);
8753 if (I->getType() == CI.getType()) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008754 unsigned MidSize = Src->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
8755 unsigned SrcDstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008756 unsigned ShAmt = CA->getZExtValue()+SrcDstSize-MidSize;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008757 Constant *ShAmtV = Context->getConstantInt(CI.getType(), ShAmt);
Chris Lattner46bbad22008-08-06 07:35:52 +00008758 I = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateShl(I, ShAmtV,
8759 CI.getName()), CI);
8760 return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(I, ShAmtV);
8761 }
8762 }
8763
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00008764 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008765}
8766
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008767/// FitsInFPType - Return a Constant* for the specified FP constant if it fits
8768/// in the specified FP type without changing its value.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008769static Constant *FitsInFPType(ConstantFP *CFP, const fltSemantics &Sem,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008770 LLVMContext *Context) {
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008771 bool losesInfo;
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008772 APFloat F = CFP->getValueAPF();
Dale Johannesen23a98552008-10-09 23:00:39 +00008773 (void)F.convert(Sem, APFloat::rmNearestTiesToEven, &losesInfo);
8774 if (!losesInfo)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008775 return Context->getConstantFP(F);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008776 return 0;
8777}
8778
8779/// LookThroughFPExtensions - If this is an fp extension instruction, look
8780/// through it until we get the source value.
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00008781static Value *LookThroughFPExtensions(Value *V, LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008782 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V))
8783 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FPExt)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008784 return LookThroughFPExtensions(I->getOperand(0), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008785
8786 // If this value is a constant, return the constant in the smallest FP type
8787 // that can accurately represent it. This allows us to turn
8788 // (float)((double)X+2.0) into x+2.0f.
8789 if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V)) {
8790 if (CFP->getType() == Type::PPC_FP128Ty)
8791 return V; // No constant folding of this.
8792 // See if the value can be truncated to float and then reextended.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008793 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEsingle, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008794 return V;
8795 if (CFP->getType() == Type::DoubleTy)
8796 return V; // Won't shrink.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008797 if (Value *V = FitsInFPType(CFP, APFloat::IEEEdouble, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008798 return V;
8799 // Don't try to shrink to various long double types.
8800 }
8801
8802 return V;
8803}
8804
8805Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPTrunc(FPTruncInst &CI) {
8806 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8807 return I;
8808
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008809 // If we have fptrunc(fadd (fpextend x), (fpextend y)), where x and y are
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008810 // smaller than the destination type, we can eliminate the truncate by doing
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008811 // the add as the smaller type. This applies to fadd/fsub/fmul/fdiv as well as
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008812 // many builtins (sqrt, etc).
8813 BinaryOperator *OpI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(CI.getOperand(0));
8814 if (OpI && OpI->hasOneUse()) {
8815 switch (OpI->getOpcode()) {
8816 default: break;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00008817 case Instruction::FAdd:
8818 case Instruction::FSub:
8819 case Instruction::FMul:
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008820 case Instruction::FDiv:
8821 case Instruction::FRem:
8822 const Type *SrcTy = OpI->getType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008823 Value *LHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(0), Context);
8824 Value *RHSTrunc = LookThroughFPExtensions(OpI->getOperand(1), Context);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008825 if (LHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy &&
8826 RHSTrunc->getType() != SrcTy) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008827 unsigned DstSize = CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008828 // If the source types were both smaller than the destination type of
8829 // the cast, do this xform.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008830 if (LHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize &&
8831 RHSTrunc->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <= DstSize) {
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008832 LHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, LHSTrunc,
8833 CI.getType(), CI);
8834 RHSTrunc = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::FPExt, RHSTrunc,
8835 CI.getType(), CI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00008836 return BinaryOperator::Create(OpI->getOpcode(), LHSTrunc, RHSTrunc);
Chris Lattnerb7530652008-01-27 05:29:54 +00008837 }
8838 }
8839 break;
8840 }
8841 }
8842 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008843}
8844
8845Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPExt(CastInst &CI) {
8846 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8847}
8848
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008849Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToUI(FPToUIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008850 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8851 if (OpI == 0)
8852 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8853
8854 // fptoui(uitofp(X)) --> X
8855 // fptoui(sitofp(X)) --> X
8856 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8857 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8858 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8859 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8860 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8861 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008862 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < /*extra bit for sign */
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008863 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8864 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008865
8866 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008867}
8868
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008869Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFPToSI(FPToSIInst &FI) {
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008870 Instruction *OpI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FI.getOperand(0));
8871 if (OpI == 0)
8872 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
8873
8874 // fptosi(sitofp(X)) --> X
8875 // fptosi(uitofp(X)) --> X
8876 // This is safe if the intermediate type has enough bits in its mantissa to
8877 // accurately represent all values of X. For example, do not do this with
8878 // i64->float->i64. This is also safe for sitofp case, because any negative
8879 // 'X' value would cause an undefined result for the fptoui.
8880 if ((isa<UIToFPInst>(OpI) || isa<SIToFPInst>(OpI)) &&
8881 OpI->getOperand(0)->getType() == FI.getType() &&
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00008882 (int)FI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() <=
Chris Lattner5af5f462008-08-06 05:13:06 +00008883 OpI->getType()->getFPMantissaWidth())
8884 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FI, OpI->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner0c7a9a02008-05-19 20:25:04 +00008885
8886 return commonCastTransforms(FI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008887}
8888
8889Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8890 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8891}
8892
8893Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSIToFP(CastInst &CI) {
8894 return commonCastTransforms(CI);
8895}
8896
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008897Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPtrToInt(PtrToIntInst &CI) {
8898 // If the destination integer type is smaller than the intptr_t type for
8899 // this target, do a ptrtoint to intptr_t then do a trunc. This allows the
8900 // trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for extending
8901 // ptrtoint's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero extends its
8902 // pointers.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008903 if (TD &&
8904 CI.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008905 Value *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new PtrToIntInst(CI.getOperand(0),
8906 TD->getIntPtrType(),
8907 "tmp"), CI);
8908 return new TruncInst(P, CI.getType());
8909 }
8910
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008911 return commonPointerCastTransforms(CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008912}
8913
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008914Instruction *InstCombiner::visitIntToPtr(IntToPtrInst &CI) {
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008915 // If the source integer type is larger than the intptr_t type for
8916 // this target, do a trunc to the intptr_t type, then inttoptr of it. This
8917 // allows the trunc to be exposed to other transforms. Don't do this for
8918 // extending inttoptr's, because we don't know if the target sign or zero
8919 // extends to pointers.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00008920 if (TD &&
8921 CI.getOperand(0)->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits() >
Chris Lattnera0e69692009-03-24 18:35:40 +00008922 TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
8923 Value *P = InsertNewInstBefore(new TruncInst(CI.getOperand(0),
8924 TD->getIntPtrType(),
8925 "tmp"), CI);
8926 return new IntToPtrInst(P, CI.getType());
8927 }
8928
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008929 if (Instruction *I = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8930 return I;
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008931
Chris Lattnerf9d9e452008-01-08 07:23:51 +00008932 return 0;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008933}
8934
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008935Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBitCast(BitCastInst &CI) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008936 // If the operands are integer typed then apply the integer transforms,
8937 // otherwise just apply the common ones.
8938 Value *Src = CI.getOperand(0);
8939 const Type *SrcTy = Src->getType();
8940 const Type *DestTy = CI.getType();
8941
Eli Friedman7e25d452009-07-13 20:53:00 +00008942 if (isa<PointerType>(SrcTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008943 if (Instruction *I = commonPointerCastTransforms(CI))
8944 return I;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008945 } else {
8946 if (Instruction *Result = commonCastTransforms(CI))
8947 return Result;
8948 }
8949
8950
8951 // Get rid of casts from one type to the same type. These are useless and can
8952 // be replaced by the operand.
8953 if (DestTy == Src->getType())
8954 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Src);
8955
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008956 if (const PointerType *DstPTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(DestTy)) {
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008957 const PointerType *SrcPTy = cast<PointerType>(SrcTy);
8958 const Type *DstElTy = DstPTy->getElementType();
8959 const Type *SrcElTy = SrcPTy->getElementType();
8960
Nate Begeman83ad90a2008-03-31 00:22:16 +00008961 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the bitcast, which is
8962 // required for changing types.
8963 if (SrcPTy->getAddressSpace() != DstPTy->getAddressSpace())
8964 return 0;
8965
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008966 // If we are casting a malloc or alloca to a pointer to a type of the same
8967 // size, rewrite the allocation instruction to allocate the "right" type.
8968 if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(Src))
8969 if (Instruction *V = PromoteCastOfAllocation(CI, *AI))
8970 return V;
8971
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +00008972 // If the source and destination are pointers, and this cast is equivalent
8973 // to a getelementptr X, 0, 0, 0... turn it into the appropriate gep.
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008974 // This can enhance SROA and other transforms that want type-safe pointers.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00008975 Constant *ZeroUInt = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008976 unsigned NumZeros = 0;
8977 while (SrcElTy != DstElTy &&
8978 isa<CompositeType>(SrcElTy) && !isa<PointerType>(SrcElTy) &&
8979 SrcElTy->getNumContainedTypes() /* not "{}" */) {
8980 SrcElTy = cast<CompositeType>(SrcElTy)->getTypeAtIndex(ZeroUInt);
8981 ++NumZeros;
8982 }
Chris Lattner4e998b22004-09-29 05:07:12 +00008983
Chris Lattnerd3e28342007-04-27 17:44:50 +00008984 // If we found a path from the src to dest, create the getelementptr now.
8985 if (SrcElTy == DstElTy) {
8986 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Idxs(NumZeros+1, ZeroUInt);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00008987 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src, Idxs.begin(), Idxs.end(), "",
8988 ((Instruction*) NULL));
Chris Lattner9fb92132006-04-12 18:09:35 +00008989 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00008990 }
Chris Lattner24c8e382003-07-24 17:35:25 +00008991
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +00008992 if (const VectorType *DestVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
8993 if (DestVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
8994 if (!isa<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
8995 Value *Elem = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast, Src,
8996 DestVTy->getElementType(), CI);
8997 return InsertElementInst::Create(Context->getUndef(DestTy), Elem,
8998 Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty));
8999 }
9000 // FIXME: Canonicalize bitcast(insertelement) -> insertelement(bitcast)
9001 }
9002 }
9003
9004 if (const VectorType *SrcVTy = dyn_cast<VectorType>(SrcTy)) {
9005 if (SrcVTy->getNumElements() == 1) {
9006 if (!isa<VectorType>(DestTy)) {
9007 Instruction *Elem =
9008 new ExtractElementInst(Src, Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty));
9009 InsertNewInstBefore(Elem, CI);
9010 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Elem, DestTy);
9011 }
9012 }
9013 }
9014
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009015 if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(Src)) {
9016 if (SVI->hasOneUse()) {
9017 // Okay, we have (bitconvert (shuffle ..)). Check to see if this is
9018 // a bitconvert to a vector with the same # elts.
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +00009019 if (isa<VectorType>(DestTy) &&
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +00009020 cast<VectorType>(DestTy)->getNumElements() ==
9021 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() &&
9022 SVI->getType()->getNumElements() ==
9023 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements()) {
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009024 CastInst *Tmp;
9025 // If either of the operands is a cast from CI.getType(), then
9026 // evaluating the shuffle in the casted destination's type will allow
9027 // us to eliminate at least one cast.
9028 if (((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(0))) &&
9029 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy) ||
9030 ((Tmp = dyn_cast<CastInst>(SVI->getOperand(1))) &&
9031 Tmp->getOperand(0)->getType() == DestTy)) {
Eli Friedmand1fd1da2008-11-30 21:09:11 +00009032 Value *LHS = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
9033 SVI->getOperand(0), DestTy, CI);
9034 Value *RHS = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::BitCast,
9035 SVI->getOperand(1), DestTy, CI);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009036 // Return a new shuffle vector. Use the same element ID's, as we
9037 // know the vector types match #elts.
9038 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS, SVI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattner01575b72006-05-25 23:24:33 +00009039 }
9040 }
9041 }
9042 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +00009043 return 0;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +00009044}
9045
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009046/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
9047/// %C = or %A, %B
9048/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
9049/// into:
9050/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
9051/// %D = or %A, %C
9052///
9053/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
9054/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
9055/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
9056///
9057static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
9058 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
9059 case Instruction::Add:
9060 case Instruction::Mul:
9061 case Instruction::And:
9062 case Instruction::Or:
9063 case Instruction::Xor:
9064 return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
9065 case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
9066 case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00009067 case Instruction::LShr:
9068 case Instruction::AShr:
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009069 return 1;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009070 default:
9071 return 0; // Cannot fold
9072 }
9073}
9074
9075/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
9076/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009077static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +00009078 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009079 switch (I->getOpcode()) {
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009080 default: llvm_unreachable("This cannot happen!");
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009081 case Instruction::Add:
9082 case Instruction::Sub:
9083 case Instruction::Or:
9084 case Instruction::Xor:
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009085 case Instruction::Shl:
Reid Spencer3822ff52006-11-08 06:47:33 +00009086 case Instruction::LShr:
9087 case Instruction::AShr:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009088 return Context->getNullValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009089 case Instruction::And:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009090 return Context->getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009091 case Instruction::Mul:
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009092 return Context->getConstantInt(I->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009093 }
9094}
9095
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009096/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
9097/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
9098Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
9099 Instruction *FI) {
9100 if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
9101 // If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
9102 // merge.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009103 if (TI->isCast()) {
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009104 if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
9105 return 0;
9106 } else {
9107 return 0; // unknown unary op.
9108 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009109
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009110 // Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009111 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
9112 FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009113 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009114 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +00009115 TI->getType());
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009116 }
9117
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +00009118 // Only handle binary operators here.
9119 if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009120 return 0;
9121
9122 // Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
9123 Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
9124 bool MatchIsOpZero;
9125 if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9126 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9127 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9128 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9129 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9130 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9131 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9132 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9133 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9134 MatchIsOpZero = false;
9135 } else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
9136 return 0;
9137 } else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
9138 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
9139 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
9140 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
9141 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9142 } else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
9143 MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
9144 OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
9145 OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
9146 MatchIsOpZero = true;
9147 } else {
9148 return 0;
9149 }
9150
9151 // If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +00009152 SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
9153 OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009154 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
9155
9156 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
9157 if (MatchIsOpZero)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009158 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009159 else
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009160 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009161 }
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009162 llvm_unreachable("Shouldn't get here");
Reid Spencera07cb7d2007-02-02 14:41:37 +00009163 return 0;
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009164}
9165
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009166static bool isSelect01(Constant *C1, Constant *C2) {
9167 ConstantInt *C1I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C1);
9168 if (!C1I)
9169 return false;
9170 ConstantInt *C2I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C2);
9171 if (!C2I)
9172 return false;
9173 return (C1I->isZero() || C1I->isOne()) && (C2I->isZero() || C2I->isOne());
9174}
9175
9176/// FoldSelectIntoOp - Try fold the select into one of the operands to
9177/// facilitate further optimization.
9178Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value *TrueVal,
9179 Value *FalseVal) {
9180 // See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
9181 // transformation we are doing here.
9182 if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal)) {
9183 if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9184 !isa<Constant>(FalseVal)) {
9185 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
9186 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9187 if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
9188 OpToFold = 1;
9189 } else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
9190 OpToFold = 2;
9191 }
9192
9193 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009194 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009195 Value *OOp = TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9196 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9197 // between 0 and 1.
9198 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9199 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OOp, C);
9200 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9201 NewSel->takeName(TVI);
9202 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
9203 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009204 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009205 }
9206 }
9207 }
9208 }
9209 }
9210
9211 if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal)) {
9212 if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
9213 !isa<Constant>(TrueVal)) {
9214 if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
9215 unsigned OpToFold = 0;
9216 if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
9217 OpToFold = 1;
9218 } else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
9219 OpToFold = 2;
9220 }
9221
9222 if (OpToFold) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009223 Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI, Context);
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009224 Value *OOp = FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
9225 // Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
9226 // between 0 and 1.
9227 if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
9228 Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C, OOp);
9229 InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
9230 NewSel->takeName(FVI);
9231 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
9232 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
Torok Edwinc23197a2009-07-14 16:55:14 +00009233 llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009234 }
9235 }
9236 }
9237 }
9238 }
9239
9240 return 0;
9241}
9242
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009243/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
9244/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
9245///
9246Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
9247 ICmpInst *ICI) {
9248 bool Changed = false;
9249 ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
9250 Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
9251 Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
9252 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9253 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9254
9255 // Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
9256 // can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
9257 // place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
9258 if (ICI->hasOneUse())
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009259 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009260 switch (Pred) {
9261 default: break;
9262 case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
9263 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
9264 // X < MIN ? T : F --> F
9265 if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
9266 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9267 // X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009268 Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI, Context);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009269 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9270 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9271 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9272 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9273 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9274 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9275 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9276 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9277 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9278 Changed = true;
9279 }
9280 break;
9281 }
9282 case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
9283 case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
9284 // X > MAX ? T : F --> F
9285 if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
9286 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9287 // X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009288 Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI, Context);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009289 if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
9290 (CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
9291 Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
9292 CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
9293 std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
9294 ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
9295 ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
9296 SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
9297 SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
9298 Changed = true;
9299 }
9300 break;
9301 }
9302 }
9303
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009304 // (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
9305 // (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009306 CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00009307 if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>(), *Context) &&
9308 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<0>(), *Context))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009309 Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +00009310 else if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<0>(), *Context) &&
9311 match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>(), *Context))
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009312 Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
9313
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009314 if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
9315 // If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
9316 // to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
9317 // cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
9318 const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
9319
9320 // sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
9321 // sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
9322 if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
Chris Lattnercb504b92008-11-16 05:38:51 +00009323 (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009324 Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009325 Value *Sh = Context->getConstantInt(In->getType(),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +00009326 In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009327 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
9328 In->getName()+".lobit"),
9329 *ICI);
Dan Gohman21440ac2008-11-02 00:17:33 +00009330 if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
9331 In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009332 true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
9333
9334 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00009335 In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, In,
Dan Gohman1975d032008-10-30 20:40:10 +00009336 In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
9337
9338 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
9339 }
9340 }
9341 }
9342
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009343 if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
9344 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
9345 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9347 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
9348 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9349 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9350 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9351
9352 } else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
9353 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
9354 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
9355 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9356 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
9357 if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
9358 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9359 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
9360 }
9361
9362 /// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer ABS
9363
9364 return Changed ? &SI : 0;
9365}
9366
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009367Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009368 Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
9369 Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
9370 Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
9371
9372 // select true, X, Y -> X
9373 // select false, X, Y -> Y
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009374 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009375 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009376
9377 // select C, X, X -> X
9378 if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
9379 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9380
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +00009381 if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
9382 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9383 if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
9384 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9385 if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
9386 if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
9387 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
9388 else
9389 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9390 }
9391
Reid Spencer4fe16d62007-01-11 18:21:29 +00009392 if (SI.getType() == Type::Int1Ty) {
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009393 if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009394 if (C->getZExtValue()) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009395 // Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009396 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009397 } else {
9398 // Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
9399 Value *NotCond =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00009400 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009401 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009402 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009403 }
Reid Spencera54b7cb2007-01-12 07:05:14 +00009404 } else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Reid Spencer579dca12007-01-12 04:24:46 +00009405 if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009406 // Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009407 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009408 } else {
9409 // Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
9410 Value *NotCond =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00009411 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, CondVal,
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009412 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009413 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009414 }
9415 }
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009416
9417 // select a, b, a -> a&b
9418 // select a, a, b -> a|b
9419 if (CondVal == TrueVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009420 return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
Chris Lattnercfa59752007-11-25 21:27:53 +00009421 else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009422 return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
Zhou Sheng6b6b6ef2007-01-11 12:24:14 +00009423 }
Chris Lattner0c199a72004-04-08 04:43:23 +00009424
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009425 // Selecting between two integer constants?
9426 if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
9427 if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009428 // select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009429 if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009430 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009431 } else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009432 // select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
Chris Lattner2eefe512004-04-09 19:05:30 +00009433 Value *NotCond =
Owen Anderson73c6b712009-07-13 20:58:05 +00009434 InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(*Context, CondVal,
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009435 "not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009436 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
Chris Lattner82e14fe2004-04-09 18:19:44 +00009437 }
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009438
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009439 if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009440 // If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
Chris Lattnerba417832007-04-11 06:12:58 +00009441 // have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009442 // non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
9443 // cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009444 if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
Chris Lattner65b72ba2006-09-18 04:22:48 +00009445 if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009446 cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
9447 if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
9448 if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009449 isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
9450 (ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
9451 ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009452 isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
9453 // Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009454 // know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
9455 // true or false val is the zero.
Reid Spencer2ec619a2007-03-23 21:24:59 +00009456 bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009457 ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009458 Value *V = ICA;
9459 if (ShouldNotVal)
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009460 V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
Chris Lattner457dd822004-06-09 07:59:58 +00009461 Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
9462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
9463 }
Chris Lattnerb8456462006-09-20 04:44:59 +00009464 }
Chris Lattnerc32b30a2004-03-30 19:37:13 +00009465 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009466
9467 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009468 if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
9469 if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009470 // Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009471 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9472 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9473 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9474 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9475 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9476 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9477 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9478 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9479 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009480 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009481 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009482 // Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009483 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009484 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009485 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009486
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009487 } else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009488 // Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
Dale Johannesen5a2174f2007-10-03 17:45:27 +00009489 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
9490 // This is not safe in general for floating point:
9491 // consider X== -0, Y== +0.
9492 // It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
9493 ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
9494 if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
9495 !CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
9496 ((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
9497 !CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
9498 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
9499 }
Chris Lattnerd76956d2004-04-10 22:21:27 +00009500 // Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009501 if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
9502 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009503 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009504 }
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009505 // NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +00009506 }
9507
9508 // See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
Dan Gohman81b28ce2008-09-16 18:46:06 +00009509 if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
9510 if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
9511 return Result;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009512
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009513 if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
9514 if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
9515 if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009516 Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
9517
Chris Lattner6fb5a4a2005-01-19 21:50:18 +00009518 // Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
9519 if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
9520 if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
9521 return IV;
9522
9523 // Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
9524 // even legal for FP.
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009525 if ((TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9526 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9527 (TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9528 FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009529 AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
Dan Gohmanae3a0be2009-06-04 22:49:04 +00009530 } else if ((FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
9531 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
9532 (FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
9533 TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009534 AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
9535 }
9536
9537 if (AddOp) {
9538 Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
9539 if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
9540 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
9541 } else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
9542 OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
9543 }
9544
9545 if (OtherAddOp) {
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009546 // So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
9547 // select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
9548 Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
9549 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009550 NegVal = Context->getConstantExprNeg(C);
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009551 } else {
9552 NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
Owen Anderson0a5372e2009-07-13 04:09:18 +00009553 BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(*Context, SubOp->getOperand(1),
9554 "tmp"), SI);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009555 }
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009556
9557 Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
9558 Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
9559 if (AddOp != TI)
9560 std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
9561 Instruction *NewSel =
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +00009562 SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
9563 NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
Chris Lattner97f37a42006-02-24 18:05:58 +00009564
9565 NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +00009566 return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
Chris Lattner87875da2005-01-13 22:52:24 +00009567 }
9568 }
9569 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +00009570
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009571 // See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
Chris Lattner42a75512007-01-15 02:27:26 +00009572 if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
Evan Chengde621922009-03-31 20:42:45 +00009573 Instruction *FoldI = FoldSelectIntoOp(SI, TrueVal, FalseVal);
9574 if (FoldI)
9575 return FoldI;
Chris Lattnere576b912004-04-09 23:46:01 +00009576 }
Chris Lattnera1df33c2005-04-24 07:30:14 +00009577
9578 if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
9579 SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
9580 SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
9581 SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
9582 return &SI;
9583 }
9584
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009585 return 0;
9586}
9587
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009588/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
9589/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
9590/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
9591/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
9592/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
9593///
9594static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9595 unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009596
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009597 User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
9598 if (!U) return Align;
9599
Dan Gohmanca178902009-07-17 20:47:02 +00009600 switch (Operator::getOpcode(U)) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009601 default: break;
9602 case Instruction::BitCast:
9603 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
9604 case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009605 // If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
9606 bool AllZeroOperands = true;
Gabor Greif52ed3632008-06-12 21:51:29 +00009607 for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +00009608 if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
9609 !cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009610 AllZeroOperands = false;
9611 break;
9612 }
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009613
9614 if (AllZeroOperands) {
9615 // Treat this like a bitcast.
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009616 return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
Chris Lattnerf2369f22007-08-09 19:05:49 +00009617 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009618 break;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009619 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009620 }
9621
9622 if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
9623 // If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
9624 // of the global.
9625 if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
Dan Gohmanecd0fb52009-02-16 23:02:21 +00009626 if (GV->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9627 Align = GV->getAlignment();
9628 else {
9629 GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9630 Align = PrefAlign;
9631 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009632 }
9633 } else if (AllocationInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocationInst>(V)) {
9634 // If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up. We
9635 // don't do this for malloc, because some systems can't respect the request.
9636 if (isa<AllocaInst>(AI)) {
Dan Gohmanecd0fb52009-02-16 23:02:21 +00009637 if (AI->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
9638 Align = AI->getAlignment();
9639 else {
9640 AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
9641 Align = PrefAlign;
9642 }
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009643 }
9644 }
9645
9646 return Align;
9647}
9648
9649/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
9650/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
9651/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
9652/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
9653unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
9654 unsigned PrefAlign) {
9655 unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
9656 sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
9657 APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
9658 APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
9659 ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
9660 unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
9661 unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
9662
9663 if (PrefAlign > Align)
9664 Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
9665
9666 // We don't need to make any adjustment.
9667 return Align;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009668}
9669
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009670Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
Dan Gohmaneee962e2008-04-10 18:43:06 +00009671 unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
Dan Gohmanbc989d42009-02-22 18:06:32 +00009672 unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009673 unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009674 unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009675
9676 if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009677 MI->setAlignment(Context->getConstantInt(MI->getAlignmentType(),
9678 MinAlign, false));
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009679 return MI;
9680 }
9681
9682 // If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
9683 // load/store.
9684 ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
9685 if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
9686
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009687 // Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
9688 // if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
9689 // A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
9690 // case.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009691 unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009692 if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
9693
9694 if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009695 return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009696
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009697 // Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009698 Type *NewPtrTy =
9699 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(Context->getIntegerType(Size<<3));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009700
9701 // Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
9702 // that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
9703 // from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
9704 // an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
9705 // dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
9706 // integer datatype.
9707 if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
9708 const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +00009709 if (TD && SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009710 // The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
9711 // down through these levels if so.
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009712 while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009713 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
9714 if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
9715 SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
9716 else
9717 break;
9718 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
9719 if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
9720 SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
9721 else
9722 break;
9723 } else
9724 break;
9725 }
9726
Dan Gohman8f8e2692008-05-23 01:52:21 +00009727 if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009728 NewPtrTy = Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(SrcETy);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009729 }
9730 }
9731
9732
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009733 // If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
9734 // infer, use it.
9735 SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
9736 DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
9737
9738 Value *Src = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy, *MI);
9739 Value *Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy, *MI);
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009740 Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
9741 InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
9742 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
9743
9744 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009745 MI->setOperand(3, Context->getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
Chris Lattner37ac6082008-01-14 00:28:35 +00009746 return MI;
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009747}
Chris Lattner3d69f462004-03-12 05:52:32 +00009748
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009749Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
9750 unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009751 if (MI->getAlignment() < Alignment) {
Owen Andersona547b472009-07-09 18:36:20 +00009752 MI->setAlignment(Context->getConstantInt(MI->getAlignmentType(),
9753 Alignment, false));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009754 return MI;
9755 }
9756
9757 // Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
9758 ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
9759 ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
9760 if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::Int8Ty)
9761 return 0;
9762 uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerdfe964c2009-03-08 03:59:00 +00009763 Alignment = MI->getAlignment();
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009764
9765 // If the length is zero, this is a no-op
9766 if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
9767
9768 // memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
9769 if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009770 const Type *ITy = Context->getIntegerType(Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009771
9772 Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009773 Dest = InsertBitCastBefore(Dest, Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(ITy), *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009774
9775 // Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
9776 if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
9777
9778 // Extract the fill value and store.
9779 uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009780 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(Context->getConstantInt(ITy, Fill),
9781 Dest, false, Alignment), *MI);
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009782
9783 // Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009784 MI->setLength(Context->getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009785 return MI;
9786 }
9787
9788 return 0;
9789}
9790
9791
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009792/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
9793/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
9794/// the heavy lifting.
9795///
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +00009796Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
Chris Lattneraab6ec42009-05-13 17:39:14 +00009797 // If the caller function is nounwind, mark the call as nounwind, even if the
9798 // callee isn't.
9799 if (CI.getParent()->getParent()->doesNotThrow() &&
9800 !CI.doesNotThrow()) {
9801 CI.setDoesNotThrow();
9802 return &CI;
9803 }
9804
9805
9806
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009807 IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
9808 if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
9809
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009810 // Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
9811 // visitCallSite.
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009812 if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009813 bool Changed = false;
9814
9815 // memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
9816 if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
9817 if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9818
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009819 if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +00009820 if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009821 // Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
9822 // transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
9823 // alignment is sufficient.
9824 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +00009825 }
9826
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009827 // If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
9828 // then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
9829 // into a call to memcpy.
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009830 if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009831 if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
9832 if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
9833 Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
Chris Lattner824b9582008-11-21 16:42:48 +00009834 Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy;
9835 const Type *Tys[1];
9836 Tys[0] = CI.getOperand(3)->getType();
9837 CI.setOperand(0,
9838 Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID, Tys, 1));
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009839 Changed = true;
9840 }
Chris Lattnera935db82008-05-28 05:30:41 +00009841
9842 // memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
9843 if (MMI->getSource() == MMI->getDest())
9844 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009845 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +00009846
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009847 // If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
9848 // set, update the alignment.
Chris Lattner3ce5e882009-03-08 03:37:16 +00009849 if (isa<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
Chris Lattnerf497b022008-01-13 23:50:23 +00009850 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
9851 return I;
Chris Lattner69ea9d22008-04-30 06:39:11 +00009852 } else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
9853 if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
9854 return I;
Chris Lattner95a959d2006-03-06 20:18:44 +00009855 }
9856
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +00009857 if (Changed) return II;
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009858 }
9859
9860 switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
9861 default: break;
9862 case Intrinsic::bswap:
9863 // bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
9864 if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
9865 if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
9866 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
9867 break;
9868 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
9869 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
9870 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
9871 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
9872 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
9873 // Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9874 // Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
9875 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9876 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009877 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(II->getType()),
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009878 CI);
9879 return new LoadInst(Ptr);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009880 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009881 break;
9882 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
9883 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
9884 // Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9885 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
9886 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009887 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009888 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy, CI);
9889 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
9890 }
9891 break;
9892 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
9893 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
9894 case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009895 // Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
9896 if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
9897 const Type *OpPtrTy =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009898 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009899 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy, CI);
9900 return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
9901 }
9902 break;
9903
9904 case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
9905 // These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
9906 // we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +00009907 unsigned VWidth =
9908 cast<VectorType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType())->getNumElements();
9909 APInt DemandedElts(VWidth, 1);
9910 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
9911 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009912 UndefElts)) {
9913 II->setOperand(1, V);
9914 return II;
9915 }
9916 break;
9917 }
9918
9919 case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
9920 // Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
9921 if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
9922 assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +00009923
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009924 // Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
9925 bool AllEltsOk = true;
9926 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
9927 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
9928 !isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
9929 AllEltsOk = false;
9930 break;
9931 }
9932 }
9933
9934 if (AllEltsOk) {
9935 // Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
9936 Value *Op0 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(1),Mask->getType(),CI);
9937 Value *Op1 =InsertBitCastBefore(II->getOperand(2),Mask->getType(),CI);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +00009938 Value *Result = Context->getUndef(Op0->getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009939
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009940 // Only extract each element once.
9941 Value *ExtractedElts[32];
9942 memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
9943
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009944 for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009945 if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
9946 continue;
9947 unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
9948 Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
9949
9950 if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
9951 Instruction *Elt =
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +00009952 new ExtractElementInst(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1,
9953 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Idx&15, false), "tmp");
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009954 InsertNewInstBefore(Elt, CI);
9955 ExtractedElts[Idx] = Elt;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009956 }
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009957
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009958 // Insert this value into the result vector.
9959 Result = InsertElementInst::Create(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +00009960 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i, false),
9961 "tmp");
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009962 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Result), CI);
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009963 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009964 return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009965 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009966 }
9967 break;
Chris Lattnere2ed0572006-04-06 19:19:17 +00009968
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009969 case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
9970 // If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
9971 // happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
9972 if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
9973 if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
9974 BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
9975 if (&*++BI == II)
9976 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +00009977 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +00009978 }
9979
9980 // Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
9981 // same block without an intervening call/alloca.
9982 BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
9983 TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
9984 bool CannotRemove = false;
9985 for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
9986 if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI)) {
9987 CannotRemove = true;
9988 break;
9989 }
Chris Lattneraa0bf522008-06-25 05:59:28 +00009990 if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
9991 if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
9992 // If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
9993 if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
9994 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
9995 // Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
9996 } else {
9997 // If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
9998 // restore.
Chris Lattnerbf1d8a72008-02-18 06:12:38 +00009999 CannotRemove = true;
10000 break;
10001 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010002 }
Chris Lattnera728ddc2006-01-13 21:28:09 +000010003 }
Chris Lattner0521e3c2008-06-18 04:33:20 +000010004
10005 // If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
10006 // allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
10007 if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
10008 return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
10009 break;
10010 }
Chris Lattner35b9e482004-10-12 04:52:52 +000010011 }
10012
Chris Lattner8b0ea312006-01-13 20:11:04 +000010013 return visitCallSite(II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010014}
10015
10016// InvokeInst simplification
10017//
10018Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010019 return visitCallSite(&II);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010020}
10021
Dale Johannesenda30ccb2008-04-25 21:16:07 +000010022/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
10023/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010024static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
10025 const CastInst * const CI,
10026 const TargetData * const TD,
10027 const int ix) {
10028 if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
10029 return false;
10030
10031 // The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
10032 // can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
10033 // passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010034 if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010035 return true;
10036
10037 const Type* SrcTy =
10038 cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
10039 const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
10040 if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
10041 return false;
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010042 if (!TD || TD->getTypeAllocSize(SrcTy) != TD->getTypeAllocSize(DstTy))
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010043 return false;
10044 return true;
10045}
10046
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010047// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
10048//
10049Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010050 bool Changed = false;
10051
10052 // If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
10053 // to the arguments of the call/invoke.
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010054 if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
10055
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010056 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010057
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010058 if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
10059 if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
10060 Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
10061 // If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
10062 // be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +000010063 new StoreInst(Context->getTrue(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010064 Context->getUndef(Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
10065 OldCall);
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010066 if (!OldCall->use_empty())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010067 OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getUndef(OldCall->getType()));
Chris Lattner08b22ec2005-05-13 07:09:09 +000010068 if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
10069 return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
10070 return 0;
10071 }
10072
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010073 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
10074 // This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
10075 // undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
10076 // that we can't modify the CFG here.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +000010077 new StoreInst(Context->getTrue(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010078 Context->getUndef(Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)),
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010079 CS.getInstruction());
10080
10081 if (!CS.getInstruction()->use_empty())
10082 CS.getInstruction()->
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010083 replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getUndef(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010084
10085 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
10086 // Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010087 BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +000010088 Context->getTrue(), II);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010089 }
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000010090 return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
10091 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010092
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010093 if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
10094 if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
10095 if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
10096 return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
10097
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010098 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10099 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
10100 if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
Dale Johannesen63e7eb42008-04-23 01:03:05 +000010101 int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010102 // See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
10103 // the call.
10104 for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010105 E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
10106 CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
10107 if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
10108 *I = CI->getOperand(0);
10109 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010110 }
Dale Johannesen1f530a52008-04-23 18:34:37 +000010111 }
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010112 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010113
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010114 if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010115 // Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
Duncan Sandsf0c33542007-12-19 21:13:37 +000010116 CS.setDoesNotThrow();
Duncan Sandsece2c042007-12-16 15:51:49 +000010117 Changed = true;
10118 }
10119
Chris Lattner6c266db2003-10-07 22:54:13 +000010120 return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
Chris Lattnera44d8a22003-10-07 22:32:43 +000010121}
10122
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010123// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
10124// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
10125//
10126bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
10127 if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
10128 ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010129 if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
10130 !isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010131 return false;
Reid Spencer8863f182004-07-18 00:38:32 +000010132 Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010133 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010134 const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010135
10136 // Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
10137 // would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
10138 // be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
10139 //
10140 const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
10141 const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010142 const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010143
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010144 if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
Devang Patel75e6f022008-03-11 18:04:06 +000010145 return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
10146
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010147 // Check to see if we are changing the return type...
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010148 if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000010149 if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010150 // Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
10151 // a pointer to an integer of the same size.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010152 !((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || !TD ||
10153 OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
10154 (isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || !TD ||
10155 NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType())))
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010156 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010157
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010158 if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010159 // void -> non-void is handled specially
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010160 NewRetTy != Type::VoidTy && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010161 return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
10162
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010163 if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010164 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010165 if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
Duncan Sands6c3470e2008-01-07 17:16:06 +000010166 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
10167 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010168
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010169 // If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
10170 // a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
10171 // because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
10172 // the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
10173 if (!Caller->use_empty())
10174 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
10175 for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
10176 UI != E; ++UI)
10177 if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
10178 if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
Chris Lattneraeb2a1d2004-02-08 21:44:31 +000010179 PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
Chris Lattnerf78616b2004-01-14 06:06:08 +000010180 return false;
10181 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010182
10183 unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
10184 unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010185
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010186 CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
10187 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
10188 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
Andrew Lenharthb8e604c2006-06-28 01:01:52 +000010189 const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010190
10191 if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010192 return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
10193
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010194 if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
10195 & Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010196 return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010197
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010198 // Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
10199 // integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
Chris Lattnerec479922007-01-06 02:09:32 +000010200 bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000010201 (TD && ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) || ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType()) &&
10202 (isa<PointerType>(ActTy) || ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType())));
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010203 if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010204 }
10205
10206 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
Reid Spencer5cbf9852007-01-30 20:08:39 +000010207 Callee->isDeclaration())
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010208 return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010209
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010210 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
10211 !CallerPAL.isEmpty())
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010212 // In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010213 // won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
10214 // that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010215 for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
10216 if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010217 break;
Devang Pateleaf42ab2008-09-23 23:03:40 +000010218 Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010219 if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010220 return false;
10221 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010222
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010223 // Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
10224 // inserting cast instructions as necessary...
10225 std::vector<Value*> Args;
10226 Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010227 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010228 attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
10229
10230 // Get any return attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010231 Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010232
10233 // If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
10234 // with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010235 RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010236
10237 // Add the new return attributes.
10238 if (RAttrs)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010239 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010240
10241 AI = CS.arg_begin();
10242 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10243 const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
10244 if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
10245 Args.push_back(*AI);
10246 } else {
Reid Spencer8a903db2006-12-18 08:47:13 +000010247 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010248 false, ParamTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010249 CastInst *NewCast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp");
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010250 Args.push_back(InsertNewInstBefore(NewCast, *Caller));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010251 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010252
10253 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010254 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010255 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010256 }
10257
10258 // If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
10259 // now...
10260 for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010261 Args.push_back(Context->getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010262
10263 // If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning...
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010264 if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010265 if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
Bill Wendlinge8156192006-12-07 01:30:32 +000010266 cerr << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
10267 << Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010268 } else {
10269 // Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list...
10270 for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
10271 const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
10272 if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
10273 // Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010274 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false,
10275 PTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010276 Instruction *Cast = CastInst::Create(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010277 InsertNewInstBefore(Cast, *Caller);
10278 Args.push_back(Cast);
10279 } else {
10280 Args.push_back(*AI);
10281 }
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010282
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010283 // Add any parameter attributes.
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010284 if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010285 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
Duncan Sandse1e520f2008-01-13 08:02:44 +000010286 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010287 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000010288 }
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010289
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010290 if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
10291 attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
10292
Duncan Sandsf413cdf2008-06-01 07:38:42 +000010293 if (NewRetTy == Type::VoidTy)
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010294 Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010295
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010296 const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),attrVec.end());
Duncan Sandsad9a9e12008-01-06 18:27:01 +000010297
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010298 Instruction *NC;
10299 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010300 NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010301 Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10302 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Reid Spencered3fa852007-07-30 19:53:57 +000010303 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010304 cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010305 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010306 NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
10307 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010308 CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
10309 if (CI->isTailCall())
Chris Lattnera9e92112005-05-06 06:48:21 +000010310 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
Duncan Sandsdc024672007-11-27 13:23:08 +000010311 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010312 cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010313 }
10314
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000010315 // Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010316 Value *NV = NC;
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010317 if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010318 if (NV->getType() != Type::VoidTy) {
Reid Spencerc5b206b2006-12-31 05:48:39 +000010319 Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
Duncan Sandsa9d0c9d2008-01-06 10:12:28 +000010320 OldRetTy, false);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010321 NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010322
10323 // If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
10324 // non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
10325 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000010326 BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerbb609042003-10-30 00:46:41 +000010327 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
10328 } else {
10329 // Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
10330 InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
10331 }
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000010332 AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010333 } else {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010334 NV = Context->getUndef(Caller->getType());
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010335 }
10336 }
10337
10338 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
10339 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
Chris Lattnerf22a5c62007-03-02 19:59:19 +000010340 Caller->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000010341 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010342 return true;
10343}
10344
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010345// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
10346// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
10347//
10348Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
10349 Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
10350 const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
10351 const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010352 const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010353
10354 // If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
10355 // otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010356 if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010357 return 0;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010358
10359 IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
10360 cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
10361
Anton Korobeynikov0b12ecf2008-05-07 22:54:15 +000010362 Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010363 const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
10364 const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
10365
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010366 const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010367 if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010368 unsigned NestIdx = 1;
10369 const Type *NestTy = 0;
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010370 Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010371
10372 // Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
10373 for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
10374 E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010375 if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010376 // Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
10377 NestTy = *I;
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010378 NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010379 break;
10380 }
10381
10382 if (NestTy) {
10383 Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
10384 std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
10385 NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
10386
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010387 SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
Chris Lattner58d74912008-03-12 17:45:29 +000010388 NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010389
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010390 // Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010391 // mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
10392
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010393 // Add any result attributes.
10394 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010395 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010396
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010397 {
10398 unsigned Idx = 1;
10399 CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
10400 do {
10401 if (Idx == NestIdx) {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010402 // Add the chain argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010403 Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
10404 if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
10405 NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
10406 NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010407 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010408 }
10409
10410 if (I == E)
10411 break;
10412
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010413 // Add the original argument and attributes.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010414 NewArgs.push_back(*I);
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010415 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010416 NewAttrs.push_back
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010417 (AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010418
10419 ++Idx, ++I;
10420 } while (1);
10421 }
10422
Devang Patel19c87462008-09-26 22:53:05 +000010423 // Add any function attributes.
10424 if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
10425 NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
10426
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010427 // The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
10428 // Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010429 // with the chain parameter inserted.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010430
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010431 std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010432 NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
10433
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010434 // Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010435 // mean appending it.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010436 {
10437 unsigned Idx = 1;
10438 FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
10439 E = FTy->param_end();
10440
10441 do {
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010442 if (Idx == NestIdx)
10443 // Add the chain's type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010444 NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010445
10446 if (I == E)
10447 break;
10448
Duncan Sandsb0c9b932008-01-14 19:52:09 +000010449 // Add the original type.
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010450 NewTypes.push_back(*I);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010451
10452 ++Idx, ++I;
10453 } while (1);
10454 }
10455
10456 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
10457 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
10458 FunctionType *NewFTy =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010459 Context->getFunctionType(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes,
10460 FTy->isVarArg());
10461 Constant *NewCallee =
10462 NestF->getType() == Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(NewFTy) ?
10463 NestF : Context->getConstantExprBitCast(NestF,
10464 Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(NewFTy));
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010465 const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),NewAttrs.end());
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010466
10467 Instruction *NewCaller;
10468 if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010469 NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
10470 II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
10471 NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10472 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010473 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010474 cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010475 } else {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010476 NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
10477 Caller->getName(), Caller);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010478 if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
10479 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
10480 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
10481 setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
Devang Patel05988662008-09-25 21:00:45 +000010482 cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010483 }
10484 if (Caller->getType() != Type::VoidTy && !Caller->use_empty())
10485 Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
10486 Caller->eraseFromParent();
10487 RemoveFromWorkList(Caller);
10488 return 0;
10489 }
10490 }
10491
10492 // Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
10493 // parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
10494 // code sort out any function type mismatches.
10495 Constant *NewCallee =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010496 NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF :
10497 Context->getConstantExprBitCast(NestF, PTy);
Duncan Sandscdb6d922007-09-17 10:26:40 +000010498 CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
10499 return CS.getInstruction();
10500}
10501
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010502/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(c,d)]
10503/// and if a/b/c/d and the add's all have a single use, turn this into two phi's
10504/// and a single binop.
10505Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10506 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010507 assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010508 unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010509 Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10510 Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
10511
10512 const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
10513 const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010514
10515 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
10516 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010517 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010518 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Chris Lattnera90a24c2006-11-01 04:55:47 +000010519 if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010520 // Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010521 // types or GEP's with different index types.
10522 I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
10523 I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010524 return 0;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010525
10526 // If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
10527 if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
10528 if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
10529 cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
10530 return 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010531
10532 // Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
10533 if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
10534 if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010535 }
10536
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010537 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform!
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010538
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010539 Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010540 Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner53738a42006-11-08 19:42:28 +000010541 PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010542 if (LHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010543 NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
10544 FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010545 NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10546 NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010547 InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
10548 LHSVal = NewLHS;
10549 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010550
10551 if (RHSVal == 0) {
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000010552 NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
10553 FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010554 NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
10555 NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010556 InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
10557 RHSVal = NewRHS;
10558 }
10559
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010560 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010561 if (NewLHS || NewRHS) {
10562 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10563 Instruction *InInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10564 if (NewLHS) {
10565 Value *NewInLHS = InInst->getOperand(0);
10566 NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10567 }
10568 if (NewRHS) {
10569 Value *NewInRHS = InInst->getOperand(1);
10570 NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10571 }
Chris Lattnerf6fd94d2006-11-08 19:29:23 +000010572 }
10573 }
10574
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010575 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010576 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner38b3dcc2008-12-01 03:42:51 +000010577 CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000010578 return CmpInst::Create(*Context, CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
10579 LHSVal, RHSVal);
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010580}
10581
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010582Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10583 GetElementPtrInst *FirstInst =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10584
10585 SmallVector<Value*, 16> FixedOperands(FirstInst->op_begin(),
10586 FirstInst->op_end());
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010587 // This is true if all GEP bases are allocas and if all indices into them are
10588 // constants.
10589 bool AllBasePointersAreAllocas = true;
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010590
10591 // Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, all have one use, and all
10592 // kill their operands (i.e. the operands have one use).
10593 for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
10594 GetElementPtrInst *GEP= dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10595 if (!GEP || !GEP->hasOneUse() || GEP->getType() != FirstInst->getType() ||
10596 GEP->getNumOperands() != FirstInst->getNumOperands())
10597 return 0;
10598
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010599 // Keep track of whether or not all GEPs are of alloca pointers.
10600 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas &&
10601 (!isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) ||
10602 !GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()))
10603 AllBasePointersAreAllocas = false;
10604
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010605 // Compare the operand lists.
10606 for (unsigned op = 0, e = FirstInst->getNumOperands(); op != e; ++op) {
10607 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op) == GEP->getOperand(op))
10608 continue;
10609
10610 // Don't merge two GEPs when two operands differ (introducing phi nodes)
10611 // if one of the PHIs has a constant for the index. The index may be
10612 // substantially cheaper to compute for the constants, so making it a
10613 // variable index could pessimize the path. This also handles the case
10614 // for struct indices, which must always be constant.
10615 if (isa<ConstantInt>(FirstInst->getOperand(op)) ||
10616 isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(op)))
10617 return 0;
10618
10619 if (FirstInst->getOperand(op)->getType() !=GEP->getOperand(op)->getType())
10620 return 0;
10621 FixedOperands[op] = 0; // Needs a PHI.
10622 }
10623 }
10624
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010625 // If all of the base pointers of the PHI'd GEPs are from allocas, don't
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010626 // bother doing this transformation. At best, this will just save a bit of
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010627 // offset calculation, but all the predecessors will have to materialize the
10628 // stack address into a register anyway. We'd actually rather *clone* the
10629 // load up into the predecessors so that we have a load of a gep of an alloca,
10630 // which can usually all be folded into the load.
10631 if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas)
10632 return 0;
10633
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010634 // Otherwise, this is safe to transform. Insert PHI nodes for each operand
10635 // that is variable.
10636 SmallVector<PHINode*, 16> OperandPhis(FixedOperands.size());
10637
10638 bool HasAnyPHIs = false;
10639 for (unsigned i = 0, e = FixedOperands.size(); i != e; ++i) {
10640 if (FixedOperands[i]) continue; // operand doesn't need a phi.
10641 Value *FirstOp = FirstInst->getOperand(i);
10642 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstOp->getType(),
10643 FirstOp->getName()+".pn");
10644 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10645
10646 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(e);
10647 NewPN->addIncoming(FirstOp, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
10648 OperandPhis[i] = NewPN;
10649 FixedOperands[i] = NewPN;
10650 HasAnyPHIs = true;
10651 }
10652
10653
10654 // Add all operands to the new PHIs.
10655 if (HasAnyPHIs) {
10656 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10657 GetElementPtrInst *InGEP =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
10658 BasicBlock *InBB = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
10659
10660 for (unsigned op = 0, e = OperandPhis.size(); op != e; ++op)
10661 if (PHINode *OpPhi = OperandPhis[op])
10662 OpPhi->addIncoming(InGEP->getOperand(op), InBB);
10663 }
10664 }
10665
10666 Value *Base = FixedOperands[0];
10667 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
10668 FixedOperands.end());
10669}
10670
10671
Chris Lattner21550882009-02-23 05:56:17 +000010672/// isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe to
10673/// sink the load out of the block that defines it. This means that it must be
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010674/// obvious the value of the load is not changed from the point of the load to
10675/// the end of the block it is in.
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010676///
10677/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
10678/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
10679/// to a register.
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010680static bool isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010681 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
10682
10683 for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
10684 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
10685 return false;
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010686
10687 // Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
10688 // profitable to do this xform.
10689 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
10690 bool isAddressTaken = false;
10691 for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
10692 UI != E; ++UI) {
10693 if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
10694 if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
10695 // If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
10696 if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
10697 }
10698 isAddressTaken = true;
10699 break;
10700 }
10701
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010702 if (!isAddressTaken && AI->isStaticAlloca())
Chris Lattnerfd905ca2007-02-01 22:30:07 +000010703 return false;
10704 }
10705
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010706 // If this load is a load from a GEP with a constant offset from an alloca,
10707 // then we don't want to sink it. In its present form, it will be
10708 // load [constant stack offset]. Sinking it will cause us to have to
10709 // materialize the stack addresses in each predecessor in a register only to
10710 // do a shared load from register in the successor.
10711 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(L->getOperand(0)))
10712 if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
10713 if (AI->isStaticAlloca() && GEP->hasAllConstantIndices())
10714 return false;
10715
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010716 return true;
10717}
10718
Chris Lattner9fe38862003-06-19 17:00:31 +000010719
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010720// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
10721// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
10722// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
10723Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
10724 Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
10725
10726 // Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
10727 // If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
10728 // the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
10729 // code size and simplifying code.
10730 Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
10731 const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010732 bool isVolatile = false;
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010733 if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
10734 CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
Reid Spencer832254e2007-02-02 02:16:23 +000010735 } else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010736 // Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
10737 // otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010738 ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
Chris Lattner7da52b22006-11-01 04:51:18 +000010739 if (ConstantOp == 0)
10740 return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010741 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(FirstInst)) {
10742 isVolatile = LI->isVolatile();
10743 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
10744 // load and the PHI.
10745 if (LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010746 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010747 return 0;
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010748
10749 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10750 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10751 // the path through the other successor.
10752 if (isVolatile &&
10753 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10754 return 0;
10755
Chris Lattner9c080502006-11-01 07:43:41 +000010756 } else if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst)) {
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010757 return FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PN);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010758 } else {
10759 return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
10760 }
10761
10762 // Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
10763 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10764 if (!isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))) return 0;
10765 Instruction *I = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010766 if (!I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010767 return 0;
10768 if (CastSrcTy) {
10769 if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
10770 return 0; // Cast operation must match.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010771 } else if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(I)) {
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010772 // We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
10773 // the load and the PHI.
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010774 if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
10775 LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
Chris Lattner36d3e322009-02-21 00:46:50 +000010776 !isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
Chris Lattner76c73142006-11-01 07:13:54 +000010777 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010778
Chris Lattner71042962008-07-08 17:18:32 +000010779 // If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
10780 // successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
10781 // the path through the other successor.
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010782 if (isVolatile &&
10783 LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
10784 return 0;
Chris Lattner40700fe2008-04-29 17:28:22 +000010785
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010786 } else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
10787 return 0;
10788 }
10789 }
10790
10791 // Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
10792 // correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000010793 PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
10794 PN.getName()+".in");
Chris Lattner55517062005-01-29 00:39:08 +000010795 NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010796
10797 Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
10798 NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010799
10800 // Add all operands to the new PHI.
Chris Lattnerb5893442004-11-14 19:29:34 +000010801 for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10802 Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
10803 if (NewInVal != InVal)
10804 InVal = 0;
10805 NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
10806 }
10807
10808 Value *PhiVal;
10809 if (InVal) {
10810 // The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
10811 // common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
10812 PhiVal = InVal;
10813 delete NewPN;
10814 } else {
10815 InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
10816 PhiVal = NewPN;
10817 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010818
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010819 // Insert and return the new operation.
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000010820 if (CastInst* FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010821 return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010822 if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000010823 return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010824 if (CmpInst *CIOp = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst))
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000010825 return CmpInst::Create(*Context, CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000010826 PhiVal, ConstantOp);
Chris Lattner54545ac2008-04-29 17:13:43 +000010827 assert(isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst) && "Unknown operation");
10828
10829 // If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
10830 // and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
10831 // insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
10832 if (isVolatile)
10833 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
10834 cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
10835
10836 return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile);
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000010837}
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010838
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010839/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
10840/// that is dead.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010841static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
10842 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010843 if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
10844 if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
10845
10846 // Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010847 if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010848 return true;
Chris Lattner92103de2007-08-28 04:23:55 +000010849
10850 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10851 if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
10852 return false;
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010853
10854 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
10855 return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000010856
Chris Lattnera3fd1c52005-01-17 05:10:15 +000010857 return false;
10858}
10859
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010860/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
10861/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
10862/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10863static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
10864 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
10865 // See if we already saw this PHI node.
10866 if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
10867 return true;
10868
10869 // Don't scan crazily complex things.
10870 if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
10871 return false;
10872
10873 // Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
10874 // the value.
10875 for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
10876 Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
10877 if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
10878 if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10879 return false;
10880 } else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
10881 return false;
10882 }
10883
10884 return true;
10885}
10886
10887
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010888// PHINode simplification
10889//
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010890Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
Owen Andersonb64ab872006-07-10 22:15:25 +000010891 // If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000010892 if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
Owen Andersond1b78a12006-07-10 19:03:49 +000010893
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010894 if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
10895 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
10896
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010897 // If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
10898 // reducing code size.
10899 if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
Chris Lattner05f18922008-12-01 02:34:36 +000010900 isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1)) &&
10901 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0))->getOpcode() ==
10902 cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1))->getOpcode() &&
10903 // FIXME: The hasOneUse check will fail for PHIs that use the value more
10904 // than themselves more than once.
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010905 PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
10906 if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
10907 return Result;
10908
10909 // If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
10910 // this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
10911 // PHI)... break the cycle.
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010912 if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
10913 Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
10914 if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
Chris Lattner0e5444b2007-03-26 20:40:50 +000010915 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010916 PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
10917 if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010918 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, Context->getUndef(PN.getType()));
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010919 }
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010920
10921 // If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
10922 // the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
10923 // induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
10924 // common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
10925 // are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
10926 // late.
10927 if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
10928 (isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
10929 PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010930 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, Context->getUndef(PN.getType()));
Chris Lattnerff9f13a2007-01-15 07:30:06 +000010931 }
10932 }
Owen Anderson7e057142006-07-10 22:03:18 +000010933
Chris Lattnercf5008a2007-11-06 21:52:06 +000010934 // We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
10935 // same value, for example:
10936 // z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
10937 // where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
10938 // quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
10939 // so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
10940 {
10941 unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
10942 // Scan for the first non-phi operand.
10943 while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
10944 isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
10945 ++InValNo;
10946
10947 if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
10948 Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
10949
10950 // Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
10951 // there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
10952 for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
10953 Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
10954 if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
10955 break;
10956 }
10957
10958 // If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
10959 // phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
10960 // the value.
10961 if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
10962 SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
10963 if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
10964 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
10965 }
10966 }
10967 }
Chris Lattner60921c92003-12-19 05:58:40 +000010968 return 0;
Chris Lattner473945d2002-05-06 18:06:38 +000010969}
10970
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010971static Value *InsertCastToIntPtrTy(Value *V, const Type *DTy,
10972 Instruction *InsertPoint,
10973 InstCombiner *IC) {
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000010974 unsigned PtrSize = DTy->getScalarSizeInBits();
10975 unsigned VTySize = V->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000010976 // We must cast correctly to the pointer type. Ensure that we
10977 // sign extend the integer value if it is smaller as this is
10978 // used for address computation.
10979 Instruction::CastOps opcode =
10980 (VTySize < PtrSize ? Instruction::SExt :
10981 (VTySize == PtrSize ? Instruction::BitCast : Instruction::Trunc));
10982 return IC->InsertCastBefore(opcode, V, DTy, *InsertPoint);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000010983}
10984
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000010985
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010986Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010987 Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner9bc14642007-04-28 00:57:34 +000010988 // Is it 'getelementptr %P, i32 0' or 'getelementptr %P'
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000010989 // If so, eliminate the noop.
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010990 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 1)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000010991 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010992
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010993 if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000010994 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, Context->getUndef(GEP.getType()));
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000010995
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000010996 bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
10997 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
10998 HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isNullValue();
10999
11000 if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2 && HasZeroPointerIndex)
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011001 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, PtrOp);
Chris Lattnera1be5662002-05-02 17:06:02 +000011002
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011003 // Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
11004 bool MadeChange = false;
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000011005
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011006 gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011007 for (User::op_iterator i = GEP.op_begin() + 1, e = GEP.op_end();
11008 i != e; ++i, ++GTI) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011009 if (TD && isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) {
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011010 if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*i)) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000011011 if (CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::ZExt ||
11012 CI->getOpcode() == Instruction::SExt) {
11013 const Type *SrcTy = CI->getOperand(0)->getType();
11014 // We can eliminate a cast from i32 to i64 iff the target
11015 // is a 32-bit pointer target.
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000011016 if (SrcTy->getScalarSizeInBits() >= TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner76b7a062007-01-15 07:02:54 +000011017 MadeChange = true;
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011018 *i = CI->getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011019 }
11020 }
11021 }
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011022 // If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000011023 // to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need.
11024 // If the incoming value needs a cast instruction,
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011025 // insert it. This explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more
11026 // obvious.
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011027 Value *Op = *i;
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011028 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) > TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000011029 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011030 *i = Context->getConstantExprTrunc(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Chris Lattner4f1134e2004-04-17 18:16:10 +000011031 MadeChange = true;
11032 } else {
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000011033 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::Trunc, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
11034 GEP);
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000011035 *i = Op;
Chris Lattnercb69a4e2004-04-07 18:38:20 +000011036 MadeChange = true;
11037 }
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000011038 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Op->getType()) < TD->getPointerSizeInBits()) {
11039 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011040 *i = Context->getConstantExprSExt(C, TD->getIntPtrType());
Dan Gohman4f833d42008-09-11 23:06:38 +000011041 MadeChange = true;
11042 } else {
11043 Op = InsertCastBefore(Instruction::SExt, Op, TD->getIntPtrType(),
11044 GEP);
11045 *i = Op;
11046 MadeChange = true;
11047 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011048 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011049 }
Chris Lattnerdb9654e2007-03-25 20:43:09 +000011050 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011051 if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
11052
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011053 // Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
11054 // is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
11055 // getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
11056 //
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000011057 SmallVector<Value*, 8> SrcGEPOperands;
Chris Lattner574da9b2005-01-13 20:14:25 +000011058 if (User *Src = dyn_castGetElementPtr(PtrOp))
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000011059 SrcGEPOperands.append(Src->op_begin(), Src->op_end());
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000011060
11061 if (!SrcGEPOperands.empty()) {
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011062 // Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
11063 // chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
11064 // avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
11065 //
11066 if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(SrcGEPOperands[0]) &&
11067 cast<Instruction>(SrcGEPOperands[0])->getNumOperands() == 2)
11068 return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
11069
Chris Lattner72588fc2007-02-15 22:48:32 +000011070 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011071
11072 // Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
11073 bool EndsWithSequential = false;
11074 for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*cast<User>(PtrOp)),
11075 E = gep_type_end(*cast<User>(PtrOp)); I != E; ++I)
Chris Lattnerbe97b4e2004-05-08 22:41:42 +000011076 EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011077
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011078 // Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011079 if (EndsWithSequential) {
Chris Lattnerdecd0812003-03-05 22:33:14 +000011080 // Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
11081 // With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
11082 //
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011083 Value *Sum, *SO1 = SrcGEPOperands.back(), *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011084 if (SO1 == Context->getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011085 Sum = GO1;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011086 } else if (GO1 == Context->getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011087 Sum = SO1;
11088 } else {
11089 // If they aren't the same type, convert both to an integer of the
11090 // target's pointer size.
11091 if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType()) {
11092 if (Constant *SO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO1)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011093 SO1 =
11094 Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(SO1C, GO1->getType(), true);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011095 } else if (Constant *GO1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(GO1)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011096 GO1 =
11097 Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(GO1C, SO1->getType(), true);
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011098 } else if (TD) {
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000011099 unsigned PS = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
11100 if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(SO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011101 // Convert GO1 to SO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000011102 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, SO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011103
Duncan Sands514ab342007-11-01 20:53:16 +000011104 } else if (TD->getTypeSizeInBits(GO1->getType()) == PS) {
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011105 // Convert SO1 to GO1's type.
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000011106 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, GO1->getType(), &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011107 } else {
11108 const Type *PT = TD->getIntPtrType();
Reid Spencer17212df2006-12-12 09:18:51 +000011109 SO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(SO1, PT, &GEP, this);
11110 GO1 = InsertCastToIntPtrTy(GO1, PT, &GEP, this);
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011111 }
11112 }
11113 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011114 if (isa<Constant>(SO1) && isa<Constant>(GO1))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011115 Sum = Context->getConstantExprAdd(cast<Constant>(SO1),
11116 cast<Constant>(GO1));
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011117 else {
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011118 Sum = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
Chris Lattner48595f12004-06-10 02:07:29 +000011119 InsertNewInstBefore(cast<Instruction>(Sum), GEP);
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011120 }
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011121 }
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011122
11123 // Recycle the GEP we already have if possible.
11124 if (SrcGEPOperands.size() == 2) {
11125 GEP.setOperand(0, SrcGEPOperands[0]);
11126 GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
11127 return &GEP;
11128 } else {
11129 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
11130 SrcGEPOperands.end()-1);
11131 Indices.push_back(Sum);
11132 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
11133 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011134 } else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
Chris Lattner28977af2004-04-05 01:30:19 +000011135 cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011136 SrcGEPOperands.size() != 1) {
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011137 // Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
Chris Lattnerebd985c2004-03-25 22:59:29 +000011138 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), SrcGEPOperands.begin()+1,
11139 SrcGEPOperands.end());
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000011140 Indices.insert(Indices.end(), GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
11141 }
11142
11143 if (!Indices.empty())
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011144 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(SrcGEPOperands[0], Indices.begin(),
11145 Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000011146
Chris Lattner620ce142004-05-07 22:09:22 +000011147 } else if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(PtrOp)) {
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000011148 // GEP of global variable. If all of the indices for this GEP are
11149 // constants, we can promote this to a constexpr instead of an instruction.
11150
11151 // Scan for nonconstants...
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011152 SmallVector<Constant*, 8> Indices;
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000011153 User::op_iterator I = GEP.idx_begin(), E = GEP.idx_end();
11154 for (; I != E && isa<Constant>(*I); ++I)
11155 Indices.push_back(cast<Constant>(*I));
11156
11157 if (I == E) { // If they are all constants...
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011158 Constant *CE = Context->getConstantExprGetElementPtr(GV,
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011159 &Indices[0],Indices.size());
Chris Lattner9b761232002-08-17 22:21:59 +000011160
11161 // Replace all uses of the GEP with the new constexpr...
11162 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, CE);
11163 }
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011164 } else if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) { // Is the operand a cast?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011165 if (!isa<PointerType>(X->getType())) {
11166 // Not interesting. Source pointer must be a cast from pointer.
11167 } else if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011168 // transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
11169 // into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011170 //
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011171 // Likewise, transform: GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
11172 // into : GEP i8* X, ...
11173 //
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011174 // This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011175 const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
11176 const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011177 if (const ArrayType *CATy =
11178 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType())) {
11179 // GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
11180 if (CATy->getElementType() == XTy->getElementType()) {
11181 // -> GEP i8* X, ...
11182 SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
11183 return GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
11184 GEP.getName());
11185 } else if (const ArrayType *XATy =
11186 dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType())) {
11187 // GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011188 if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011189 // -> GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011190 // At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
11191 // to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
11192 // array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
11193 // is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
11194 GEP.setOperand(0, X);
11195 return &GEP;
11196 }
Duncan Sands5b7cfb02009-03-02 09:18:21 +000011197 }
11198 }
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011199 } else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
11200 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011201 // %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
11202 // into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011203 const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
11204 const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011205 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011206 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
11207 TD->getTypeAllocSize(ResElTy)) {
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011208 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011209 Idx[0] = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011210 Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnereed48272005-09-13 00:40:14 +000011211 Value *V = InsertNewInstBefore(
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011212 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()), GEP);
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011213 // V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
11214 return new BitCastInst(V, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011215 }
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011216
11217 // Transform things like:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011218 // getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011219 // (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011220 // getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011221
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011222 if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) && ResElTy == Type::Int8Ty) {
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011223 uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011224 TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011225
11226 // Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
11227 // allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
11228 Value *NewIdx = 0;
11229 ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
11230 if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
11231 NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011232 Scale =
11233 Context->getConstantInt(cast<IntegerType>(NewIdx->getType()), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011234 } else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011235 NewIdx = Context->getConstantInt(CI->getType(), 1);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011236 Scale = CI;
11237 } else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
11238 if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
11239 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
Zhou Sheng0e2d3ac2007-03-30 09:29:48 +000011240 ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11241 uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011242 Scale = Context->getConstantInt(cast<IntegerType>(Inst->getType()),
Dan Gohman6de29f82009-06-15 22:12:54 +000011243 1ULL << ShAmtVal);
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011244 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11245 } else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
11246 isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
11247 Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
11248 NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
11249 }
11250 }
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011251
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011252 // If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011253 // out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
11254 // signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
11255 // operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
Chris Lattner58b1ac72009-02-25 18:20:01 +000011256 if (ArrayEltSize && Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011257 Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011258 Scale = Context->getConstantInt(Scale->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011259 Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011260 if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011261 Constant *C =
11262 Context->getConstantExprIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
Wojciech Matyjewiczed223252007-12-12 15:21:32 +000011263 false /*ZExt*/);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000011264 Instruction *Sc = BinaryOperator::CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011265 NewIdx = InsertNewInstBefore(Sc, GEP);
11266 }
11267
11268 // Insert the new GEP instruction.
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011269 Value *Idx[2];
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011270 Idx[0] = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011271 Idx[1] = NewIdx;
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011272 Instruction *NewGEP =
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011273 GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011274 NewGEP = InsertNewInstBefore(NewGEP, GEP);
11275 // The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
11276 return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner7835cdd2005-09-13 18:36:04 +000011277 }
11278 }
Chris Lattnerc6bd1952004-02-22 05:25:17 +000011279 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011280 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011281
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011282 /// See if we can simplify:
11283 /// X = bitcast A to B*
11284 /// Y = gep X, <...constant indices...>
11285 /// into a gep of the original struct. This is important for SROA and alias
11286 /// analysis of unions. If "A" is also a bitcast, wait for A/X to be merged.
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011287 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(PtrOp)) {
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011288 if (TD &&
11289 !isa<BitCastInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) && GEP.hasAllConstantIndices()) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011290 // Determine how much the GEP moves the pointer. We are guaranteed to get
11291 // a constant back from EmitGEPOffset.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011292 ConstantInt *OffsetV =
11293 cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(&GEP, GEP, *this));
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011294 int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
11295
11296 // If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, just replace the GEP
11297 // with a bitcast of the real input to the dest type.
11298 if (Offset == 0) {
11299 // If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
11300 // converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
11301 if (isa<AllocationInst>(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
11302 // See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
11303 if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
11304 if (I != BCI) {
11305 I->takeName(BCI);
11306 BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
11307 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
11308 }
11309 return &GEP;
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011310 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011311 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011312 return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011313 }
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011314
11315 // Otherwise, if the offset is non-zero, we need to find out if there is a
11316 // field at Offset in 'A's type. If so, we can pull the cast through the
11317 // GEP.
11318 SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
11319 const Type *InTy =
11320 cast<PointerType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011321 if (FindElementAtOffset(InTy, Offset, NewIndices, TD, Context)) {
Chris Lattner46cd5a12009-01-09 05:44:56 +000011322 Instruction *NGEP =
11323 GetElementPtrInst::Create(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
11324 NewIndices.end());
11325 if (NGEP->getType() == GEP.getType()) return NGEP;
11326 InsertNewInstBefore(NGEP, GEP);
11327 NGEP->takeName(&GEP);
11328 return new BitCastInst(NGEP, GEP.getType());
11329 }
Chris Lattner58407792009-01-09 04:53:57 +000011330 }
11331 }
11332
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000011333 return 0;
11334}
11335
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011336Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocationInst(AllocationInst &AI) {
11337 // Convert: malloc Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: malloc [C x Ty], 1
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011338 if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000011339 if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
11340 const Type *NewTy =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011341 Context->getArrayType(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011342 AllocationInst *New = 0;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011343
11344 // Create and insert the replacement instruction...
11345 if (isa<MallocInst>(AI))
Owen Anderson50dead02009-07-15 23:53:25 +000011346 New = new MallocInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011347 else {
11348 assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
Owen Anderson50dead02009-07-15 23:53:25 +000011349 New = new AllocaInst(NewTy, 0, AI.getAlignment(), AI.getName());
Chris Lattner0006bd72002-11-09 00:49:43 +000011350 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011351
11352 InsertNewInstBefore(New, AI);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011353
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011354 // Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011355 // allocas if possible...also skip interleaved debug info
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011356 //
11357 BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
Dale Johannesena8915182009-03-11 22:19:43 +000011358 while (isa<AllocationInst>(*It) || isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(*It)) ++It;
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011359
11360 // Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
11361 // insert our getelementptr instruction...
11362 //
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011363 Value *NullIdx = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
David Greeneb8f74792007-09-04 15:46:09 +000011364 Value *Idx[2];
11365 Idx[0] = NullIdx;
11366 Idx[1] = NullIdx;
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011367 Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::Create(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
11368 New->getName()+".sub", It);
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011369
11370 // Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
11371 // allocation.
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011372 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011373 } else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011374 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Context->getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011375 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011376 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011377
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011378 if (TD && isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized()) {
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011379 // If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
Chris Lattner46d232d2009-03-17 17:55:15 +000011380 // Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate
11381 // and return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
Duncan Sands777d2302009-05-09 07:06:46 +000011382 if (TD->getTypeAllocSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011383 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Context->getNullValue(AI.getType()));
Dan Gohman6893cd72009-01-13 20:18:38 +000011384
11385 // If the alignment is 0 (unspecified), assign it the preferred alignment.
11386 if (AI.getAlignment() == 0)
11387 AI.setAlignment(TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI.getAllocatedType()));
11388 }
Chris Lattner7c881df2004-03-19 06:08:10 +000011389
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000011390 return 0;
11391}
11392
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011393Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFreeInst(FreeInst &FI) {
11394 Value *Op = FI.getOperand(0);
11395
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011396 // free undef -> unreachable.
11397 if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
11398 // Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
Owen Andersonb3056fa2009-07-21 18:03:38 +000011399 new StoreInst(Context->getTrue(),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011400 Context->getUndef(Context->getPointerTypeUnqual(Type::Int1Ty)), &FI);
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011401 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11402 }
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011403
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011404 // If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
11405 // when lots of inlining happens.
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011406 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000011407 return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
Chris Lattner6fe55412007-04-14 00:20:02 +000011408
11409 // Change free <ty>* (cast <ty2>* X to <ty>*) into free <ty2>* X
11410 if (BitCastInst *CI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Op)) {
11411 FI.setOperand(0, CI->getOperand(0));
11412 return &FI;
11413 }
11414
11415 // Change free (gep X, 0,0,0,0) into free(X)
11416 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11417 if (GEPI->hasAllZeroIndices()) {
11418 AddToWorkList(GEPI);
11419 FI.setOperand(0, GEPI->getOperand(0));
11420 return &FI;
11421 }
11422 }
11423
11424 // Change free(malloc) into nothing, if the malloc has a single use.
11425 if (MallocInst *MI = dyn_cast<MallocInst>(Op))
11426 if (MI->hasOneUse()) {
11427 EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
11428 return EraseInstFromFunction(*MI);
11429 }
Chris Lattner6160e852004-02-28 04:57:37 +000011430
Chris Lattner67b1e1b2003-12-07 01:24:23 +000011431 return 0;
11432}
11433
11434
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011435/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011436static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011437 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011438 User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011439 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000011440 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011441
Nick Lewycky48f95ad2009-05-08 06:47:37 +000011442 if (TD) {
11443 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(CI)) {
11444 // Instead of loading constant c string, use corresponding integer value
11445 // directly if string length is small enough.
11446 std::string Str;
11447 if (GetConstantStringInfo(CE->getOperand(0), Str) && !Str.empty()) {
11448 unsigned len = Str.length();
11449 const Type *Ty = cast<PointerType>(CE->getType())->getElementType();
11450 unsigned numBits = Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
11451 // Replace LI with immediate integer store.
11452 if ((numBits >> 3) == len + 1) {
11453 APInt StrVal(numBits, 0);
11454 APInt SingleChar(numBits, 0);
11455 if (TD->isLittleEndian()) {
11456 for (signed i = len-1; i >= 0; i--) {
11457 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i] & UCHAR_MAX;
11458 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11459 }
11460 } else {
11461 for (unsigned i = 0; i < len; i++) {
11462 SingleChar = (uint64_t) Str[i] & UCHAR_MAX;
11463 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11464 }
11465 // Append NULL at the end.
11466 SingleChar = 0;
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011467 StrVal = (StrVal << 8) | SingleChar;
11468 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011469 Value *NL = Context->getConstantInt(StrVal);
Nick Lewycky48f95ad2009-05-08 06:47:37 +000011470 return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, NL);
Bill Wendling587c01d2008-02-26 10:53:30 +000011471 }
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011472 }
11473 }
11474 }
11475
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011476 const PointerType *DestTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType());
11477 const Type *DestPTy = DestTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011478 if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
Mon P Wang6753f952009-02-07 22:19:29 +000011479
11480 // If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the cast.
11481 if (DestTy->getAddressSpace() != SrcTy->getAddressSpace())
11482 return 0;
11483
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011484 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011485
Reid Spencer42230162007-01-22 05:51:25 +000011486 if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011487 isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011488 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11489 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11490 // constants.
11491 if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
11492 if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
11493 if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
Chris Lattner55eb1c42007-01-31 04:40:53 +000011494 Value *Idxs[2];
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011495 Idxs[0] = Idxs[1] = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
11496 CastOp = Context->getConstantExprGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011497 SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11498 SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
11499 }
11500
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011501 if (IC.getTargetData() &&
11502 (SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000011503 isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
Chris Lattnerb1515fe2005-03-29 06:37:47 +000011504 // Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
11505 // casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
11506 (isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011507 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
11508 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011509
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011510 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11511 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
11512 // the result of the loaded value.
11513 Value *NewLoad = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(CastOp,
11514 CI->getName(),
11515 LI.isVolatile()),LI);
11516 // Now cast the result of the load.
Reid Spencerd977d862006-12-12 23:36:14 +000011517 return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
Chris Lattnerf9527852005-01-31 04:50:46 +000011518 }
Chris Lattnerb89e0712004-07-13 01:49:43 +000011519 }
11520 }
11521 return 0;
11522}
11523
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011524Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
11525 Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
Chris Lattner5f16a132004-01-12 04:13:56 +000011526
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011527 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011528 if (TD) {
11529 unsigned KnownAlign =
11530 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(LI.getType()));
11531 if (KnownAlign >
11532 (LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
11533 LI.getAlignment()))
11534 LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11535 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011536
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011537 // load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011538 if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011539 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011540 return Res;
11541
11542 // None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
11543 if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
Chris Lattner62f254d2005-09-12 22:00:15 +000011544
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011545 // Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
11546 // where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
11547 // separated by a few arithmetic operations.
11548 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011549 if (Value *AvailableVal = FindAvailableLoadedValue(Op, LI.getParent(), BBI,6))
11550 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, AvailableVal);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011551
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011552 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
11553 const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
11554 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
11555 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) &&
11556 cast<PointerType>(GEPI0->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011557 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11558 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11559 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11560 // CFG.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011561 new StoreInst(Context->getUndef(LI.getType()),
11562 Context->getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
11563 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getUndef(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011564 }
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011565 }
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011566
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011567 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op)) {
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011568 // load null/undef -> undef
Christopher Lambb15147e2007-12-29 07:56:53 +000011569 // TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
11570 if (isa<UndefValue>(C) || (C->isNullValue() &&
11571 cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0)) {
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011572 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
11573 // this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
11574 // unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011575 new StoreInst(Context->getUndef(LI.getType()),
11576 Context->getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
11577 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getUndef(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner17be6352004-10-18 02:59:09 +000011578 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011579
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011580 // Instcombine load (constant global) into the value loaded.
11581 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op))
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011582 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011583 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, GV->getInitializer());
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000011584
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011585 // Instcombine load (constantexpr_GEP global, 0, ...) into the value loaded.
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011586 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op)) {
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011587 if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr) {
11588 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(CE->getOperand(0)))
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011589 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer())
Chris Lattner363f2a22005-09-26 05:28:06 +000011590 if (Constant *V =
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000011591 ConstantFoldLoadThroughGEPConstantExpr(GV->getInitializer(), CE,
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +000011592 *Context))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011593 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, V);
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011594 if (CE->getOperand(0)->isNullValue()) {
11595 // Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
11596 // that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
11597 // an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
11598 // CFG.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011599 new StoreInst(Context->getUndef(LI.getType()),
11600 Context->getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
11601 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getUndef(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011602 }
11603
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011604 } else if (CE->isCast()) {
Devang Patel99db6ad2007-10-18 19:52:32 +000011605 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011606 return Res;
11607 }
Anton Korobeynikov07e6e562008-02-20 11:26:25 +000011608 }
Chris Lattnere87597f2004-10-16 18:11:37 +000011609 }
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011610
11611 // If this load comes from anywhere in a constant global, and if the global
11612 // is all undef or zero, we know what it loads.
Duncan Sands5d0392c2008-10-01 15:25:41 +000011613 if (GlobalVariable *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(Op->getUnderlyingObject())){
Duncan Sands64da9402009-03-21 21:27:31 +000011614 if (GV->isConstant() && GV->hasDefinitiveInitializer()) {
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011615 if (GV->getInitializer()->isNullValue())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011616 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getNullValue(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011617 else if (isa<UndefValue>(GV->getInitializer()))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011618 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, Context->getUndef(LI.getType()));
Chris Lattner8d2e8882007-08-11 18:48:48 +000011619 }
11620 }
Chris Lattnerf499eac2004-04-08 20:39:49 +000011621
Chris Lattner37366c12005-05-01 04:24:53 +000011622 if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011623 // Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
11624 // helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
11625 // exposes redundancy in the code.
11626 //
11627 // Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
11628 // introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
11629 // the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
11630 // but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
11631 // unconditionally.
11632 //
11633 if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
11634 // load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
Chris Lattner8a375202004-09-19 19:18:10 +000011635 if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
11636 isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011637 Value *V1 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(1),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000011638 SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011639 Value *V2 = InsertNewInstBefore(new LoadInst(SI->getOperand(2),
Chris Lattner79f0c8e2004-09-20 10:15:10 +000011640 SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val"), LI);
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000011641 return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011642 }
11643
Chris Lattner684fe212004-09-23 15:46:00 +000011644 // load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
11645 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
11646 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11647 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
11648 return &LI;
11649 }
11650
11651 // load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
11652 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
11653 if (C->isNullValue()) {
11654 LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
11655 return &LI;
11656 }
Chris Lattnerc10aced2004-09-19 18:43:46 +000011657 }
11658 }
Chris Lattner833b8a42003-06-26 05:06:25 +000011659 return 0;
11660}
11661
Reid Spencer55af2b52007-01-19 21:20:31 +000011662/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011663/// when possible. This makes it generally easy to do alias analysis and/or
11664/// SROA/mem2reg of the memory object.
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011665static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
11666 User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
11667 Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000011668 LLVMContext *Context = IC.getContext();
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011669
11670 const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011671 const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
11672 if (SrcTy == 0) return 0;
11673
11674 const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011675
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011676 if (!DestPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(DestPTy))
11677 return 0;
11678
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011679 /// NewGEPIndices - If SrcPTy is an aggregate type, we can emit a "noop gep"
11680 /// to its first element. This allows us to handle things like:
11681 /// store i32 xxx, (bitcast {foo*, float}* %P to i32*)
11682 /// on 32-bit hosts.
11683 SmallVector<Value*, 4> NewGEPIndices;
11684
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011685 // If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
11686 // see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
11687 // constants.
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011688 if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcPTy) || isa<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
11689 // Index through pointer.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011690 Constant *Zero = Context->getNullValue(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011691 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11692
11693 while (1) {
11694 if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
Torok Edwin08ffee52009-01-24 17:16:04 +000011695 if (!STy->getNumElements()) /* Struct can be empty {} */
Torok Edwin629e92b2009-01-24 11:30:49 +000011696 break;
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011697 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11698 SrcPTy = STy->getElementType(0);
11699 } else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy)) {
11700 NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
11701 SrcPTy = ATy->getElementType();
11702 } else {
11703 break;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011704 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011705 }
11706
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011707 SrcTy = Context->getPointerType(SrcPTy, SrcTy->getAddressSpace());
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011708 }
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011709
11710 if (!SrcPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy))
11711 return 0;
11712
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011713 // If the pointers point into different address spaces or if they point to
11714 // values with different sizes, we can't do the transformation.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011715 if (!IC.getTargetData() ||
11716 SrcTy->getAddressSpace() !=
Chris Lattner71759c42009-01-16 20:12:52 +000011717 cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getAddressSpace() ||
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011718 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) !=
11719 IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy))
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011720 return 0;
11721
11722 // Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
11723 // the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
11724 // the store, cast the value to be stored.
11725 Value *NewCast;
11726 Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
11727 Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
11728 const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
11729 const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
11730 if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11731 if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
11732 opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
11733 } else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
11734 if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
11735 opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011736 }
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011737
11738 // SIOp0 is a pointer to aggregate and this is a store to the first field,
11739 // emit a GEP to index into its first field.
11740 if (!NewGEPIndices.empty()) {
11741 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011742 CastOp = Context->getConstantExprGetElementPtr(C, &NewGEPIndices[0],
Chris Lattner3914f722009-01-24 01:00:13 +000011743 NewGEPIndices.size());
11744 else
11745 CastOp = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
11746 GetElementPtrInst::Create(CastOp, NewGEPIndices.begin(),
11747 NewGEPIndices.end()), SI);
11748 }
11749
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011750 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SIOp0))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011751 NewCast = Context->getConstantExprCast(opcode, C, CastDstTy);
Chris Lattner1b8eaf52009-01-16 20:08:59 +000011752 else
11753 NewCast = IC.InsertNewInstBefore(
11754 CastInst::Create(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy, SIOp0->getName()+".c"),
11755 SI);
11756 return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011757}
11758
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011759/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
11760/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
11761/// value in code like this:
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011762/// %t0 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011763/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
Dan Gohman0f8b53f2009-03-03 02:55:14 +000011764/// %t1 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011765/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
11766///
11767static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
11768 // Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
11769 if (A == B) return true;
11770
11771 // Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
11772 if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
11773 isa<CastInst>(A) ||
11774 isa<PHINode>(A) ||
11775 isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
11776 if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
11777 if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalTo(BI))
11778 return true;
11779
11780 // Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
11781 return false;
11782}
11783
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011784// If this instruction has two uses, one of which is a llvm.dbg.declare,
11785// return the llvm.dbg.declare.
11786DbgDeclareInst *InstCombiner::hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V) {
11787 if (!V->hasNUses(2))
11788 return 0;
11789 for (Value::use_iterator UI = V->use_begin(), E = V->use_end();
11790 UI != E; ++UI) {
11791 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI))
11792 return DI;
11793 if (isa<BitCastInst>(UI) && UI->hasOneUse()) {
11794 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI->use_begin()))
11795 return DI;
11796 }
11797 }
11798 return 0;
11799}
11800
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011801Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
11802 Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
11803 Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
11804
11805 if (isa<UndefValue>(Ptr)) { // store X, undef -> noop (even if volatile)
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011806 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011807 ++NumCombined;
11808 return 0;
11809 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011810
11811 // If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
11812 // alloca dead.
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011813 // If the RHS is an alloca with a two uses, the other one being a
11814 // llvm.dbg.declare, zapify the store and the declare, making the
11815 // alloca dead. We must do this to prevent declare's from affecting
11816 // codegen.
11817 if (!SI.isVolatile()) {
11818 if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
11819 if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011820 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11821 ++NumCombined;
11822 return 0;
11823 }
Dale Johannesen4945c652009-03-03 21:26:39 +000011824 if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
11825 if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11826 if (GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
11827 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11828 ++NumCombined;
11829 return 0;
11830 }
11831 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
11832 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11833 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11834 ++NumCombined;
11835 return 0;
11836 }
11837 }
11838 }
11839 }
11840 if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Ptr)) {
11841 EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
11842 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11843 ++NumCombined;
11844 return 0;
11845 }
Chris Lattner836692d2007-01-15 06:51:56 +000011846 }
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011847
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011848 // Attempt to improve the alignment.
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000011849 if (TD) {
11850 unsigned KnownAlign =
11851 GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(Val->getType()));
11852 if (KnownAlign >
11853 (SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
11854 SI.getAlignment()))
11855 SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
11856 }
Dan Gohman9941f742007-07-20 16:34:21 +000011857
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011858 // Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consecutive
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011859 // stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
11860 // situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
11861 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
11862 for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
11863 --ScanInsts) {
Dale Johannesen0d6596b2009-03-04 01:20:34 +000011864 --BBI;
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011865 // Don't count debug info directives, lest they affect codegen,
11866 // and we skip pointer-to-pointer bitcasts, which are NOPs.
11867 // It is necessary for correctness to skip those that feed into a
11868 // llvm.dbg.declare, as these are not present when debugging is off.
Dale Johannesen4ded40a2009-03-03 22:36:47 +000011869 if (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
Dale Johannesencdb16aa2009-03-04 01:53:05 +000011870 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011871 ScanInsts++;
Dale Johannesenacb51a32009-03-03 01:43:03 +000011872 continue;
11873 }
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011874
11875 if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
11876 // Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
Chris Lattner4aebaee2008-11-27 08:56:30 +000011877 if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() &&equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
11878 SI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011879 ++NumDeadStore;
11880 ++BBI;
11881 EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
11882 continue;
11883 }
11884 break;
11885 }
11886
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011887 // If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
11888 // the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
11889 // then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
11890 if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
Dan Gohman2276a7b2008-10-15 23:19:35 +000011891 if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
11892 !SI.isVolatile()) {
Chris Lattnerb4db97f2006-05-26 19:19:20 +000011893 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
11894 ++NumCombined;
11895 return 0;
11896 }
11897 // Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
11898 // may not be dead.
11899 break;
11900 }
11901
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011902 // Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
Chris Lattner0ef546e2008-05-08 17:20:30 +000011903 if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011904 break;
11905 }
11906
11907
11908 if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011909
11910 // store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
Chris Lattner3590abf2009-06-11 17:54:56 +000011911 if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr) &&
11912 cast<PointerType>(Ptr->getType())->getAddressSpace() == 0) {
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011913 if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000011914 SI.setOperand(0, Context->getUndef(Val->getType()));
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011915 if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000011916 AddToWorkList(U); // Dropped a use.
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011917 ++NumCombined;
11918 }
11919 return 0; // Do not modify these!
11920 }
11921
11922 // store undef, Ptr -> noop
11923 if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
Chris Lattner9ca96412006-02-08 03:25:32 +000011924 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011925 ++NumCombined;
11926 return 0;
11927 }
11928
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011929 // If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
11930 // source instead.
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000011931 if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011932 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11933 return Res;
11934 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
Reid Spencer3da59db2006-11-27 01:05:10 +000011935 if (CE->isCast())
Chris Lattnerfcfe33a2005-01-31 05:51:45 +000011936 if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
11937 return Res;
11938
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011939
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000011940 // If this store is the last instruction in the basic block (possibly
11941 // excepting debug info instructions and the pointer bitcasts that feed
11942 // into them), and if the block ends with an unconditional branch, try
11943 // to move it to the successor block.
11944 BBI = &SI;
11945 do {
11946 ++BBI;
11947 } while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
11948 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType())));
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011949 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011950 if (BI->isUnconditional())
11951 if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
11952 return 0; // xform done!
Chris Lattner408902b2005-09-12 23:23:25 +000011953
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000011954 return 0;
11955}
11956
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011957/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
11958/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
11959/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11960///
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011961/// Simplify things like:
11962/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
11963/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
11964///
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011965bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
11966 BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
11967
11968 // Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
11969 // so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
11970 // if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011971 BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011972
11973 // Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
11974 // the other predecessor.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011975 pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
11976 BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011977 if (*PI != StoreBB)
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011978 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011979 ++PI;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011980 if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011981 return false;
11982
11983 if (*PI != StoreBB) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011984 if (OtherBB)
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011985 return false;
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011986 OtherBB = *PI;
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011987 }
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011988 if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011989 return false;
Eli Friedman66fe80a2008-06-13 21:17:49 +000011990
11991 // Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
11992 // for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
11993 if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
11994 return false;
11995
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011996 // Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
11997 BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000011998 BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000011999 if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012000 return false;
12001
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012002 // If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
12003 // else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
12004 StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
12005 if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012006 --BBI;
Dale Johannesen4084c4e2009-03-05 02:06:48 +000012007 // Skip over debugging info.
12008 while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
12009 (isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
12010 if (BBI==OtherBB->begin())
12011 return false;
12012 --BBI;
12013 }
12014 // If this isn't a store, or isn't a store to the same location, bail out.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012015 OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
12016 if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
12017 return false;
12018 } else {
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000012019 // Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012020 // destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
12021 if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
12022 OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
12023 return false;
12024
12025 // Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
Chris Lattnerd717c182007-05-05 22:32:24 +000012026 // if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
12027 // lives in OtherBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012028 for (;; --BBI) {
12029 // Check to see if we find the matching store.
12030 if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
12031 if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1))
12032 return false;
12033 break;
12034 }
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012035 // If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
12036 // value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
12037 if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012038 BBI == OtherBB->begin())
12039 return false;
12040 }
12041
12042 // In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012043 // make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
12044 // StoreBB.
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012045 for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
12046 // FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
Eli Friedman6903a242008-06-13 22:02:12 +000012047 if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012048 return false;
12049 }
12050 }
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012051
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012052 // Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012053 Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
12054 if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
Gabor Greif051a9502008-04-06 20:25:17 +000012055 PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012056 PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
12057 PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
Chris Lattner31755a02007-04-15 01:02:18 +000012058 PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
12059 MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012060 }
12061
12062 // Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
12063 // insert it.
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012064 BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattner3284d1f2007-04-15 00:07:55 +000012065 InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
12066 OtherStore->isVolatile()), *BBI);
12067
12068 // Nuke the old stores.
12069 EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
12070 EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
12071 ++NumCombined;
12072 return true;
12073}
12074
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000012075
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000012076Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
12077 // Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
Reid Spencer4b828e62005-06-18 17:37:34 +000012078 Value *X = 0;
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000012079 BasicBlock *TrueDest;
12080 BasicBlock *FalseDest;
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +000012081 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest), *Context) &&
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000012082 !isa<Constant>(X)) {
12083 // Swap Destinations and condition...
12084 BI.setCondition(X);
12085 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12086 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
12087 return &BI;
12088 }
12089
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012090 // Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
12091 FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
12092 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +000012093 TrueDest, FalseDest), *Context))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012094 if ((FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
12095 FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
12096 FCmpInst *I = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012097 FCmpInst::Predicate NewPred = FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000012098 Instruction *NewSCC = new FCmpInst(I, NewPred, X, Y, "");
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012099 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012100 // Swap Destinations and condition...
12101 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
12102 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12103 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012104 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012105 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012106 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012107 return &BI;
12108 }
12109
12110 // Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
12111 ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
12112 if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
Owen Andersonc7d2ce72009-07-10 17:35:01 +000012113 TrueDest, FalseDest), *Context))
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012114 if ((IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
12115 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
12116 IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) && BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse()) {
12117 ICmpInst *I = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012118 ICmpInst::Predicate NewPred = ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred);
Owen Anderson333c4002009-07-09 23:48:35 +000012119 Instruction *NewSCC = new ICmpInst(I, NewPred, X, Y, "");
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012120 NewSCC->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000012121 // Swap Destinations and condition...
Chris Lattneracd1f0f2004-07-30 07:50:03 +000012122 BI.setCondition(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000012123 BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
12124 BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012125 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000012126 I->eraseFromParent();;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012127 AddToWorkList(NewSCC);
Chris Lattner40f5d702003-06-04 05:10:11 +000012128 return &BI;
12129 }
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012130
Chris Lattnerc4d10eb2003-06-04 04:46:00 +000012131 return 0;
12132}
Chris Lattner0864acf2002-11-04 16:18:53 +000012133
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012134Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
12135 Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
12136 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
12137 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
12138 if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
12139 // change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
12140 for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012141 SI.setOperand(i,
12142 Context->getConstantExprSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012143 AddRHS));
12144 SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012145 AddToWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner46238a62004-07-03 00:26:11 +000012146 return &SI;
12147 }
12148 }
12149 return 0;
12150}
12151
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012152Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012153 Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012154
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012155 if (!EV.hasIndices())
12156 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
12157
12158 if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
12159 if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012160 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Context->getUndef(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012161
12162 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012163 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Context->getNullValue(EV.getType()));
Matthijs Kooijman780ae5e2008-07-16 12:55:45 +000012164
12165 if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
12166 // Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
12167 Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
12168 if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
12169 // Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
12170 // first index
12171 return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
12172 else
12173 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
12174 }
12175 return 0; // Can't handle other constants
12176 }
12177 if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
12178 // We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
12179 const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
12180 for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
12181 exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
12182 exti != exte && insi != inse;
12183 ++exti, ++insi) {
12184 if (*insi != *exti)
12185 // The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
12186 // This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
12187 // replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
12188 // operand of the insert. i.e., replace
12189 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12190 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
12191 // with
12192 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
12193 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12194 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
12195 }
12196 if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
12197 // Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
12198 // %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12199 // %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
12200 // with "i32 42"
12201 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
12202 if (exti == exte) {
12203 // The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
12204 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
12205 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
12206 // with
12207 // %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
12208 // %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
12209 // by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
12210 // insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
12211 Value *NewEV = InsertNewInstBefore(
12212 ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
12213 EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end()),
12214 EV);
12215 return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12216 insi, inse);
12217 }
12218 if (insi == inse)
12219 // The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
12220 // We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
12221 // operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
12222 // i.e., replace
12223 // %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
12224 // %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
12225 // with
12226 // %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
12227 return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
12228 exti, exte);
12229 }
12230 // Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
12231 // already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
12232 // will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
12233 // the value inserted, if appropriate).
Matthijs Kooijmana9012ec2008-06-11 14:05:05 +000012234 return 0;
12235}
12236
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012237/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
12238/// is to leave as a vector operation.
12239static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
12240 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
12241 return true;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012242 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012243 if (isConstant) return true;
12244 // If all elts are the same, we can extract.
12245 Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
12246 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
12247 if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
12248 return false;
12249 return true;
12250 }
12251 Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
12252 if (!I) return false;
12253
12254 // Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
12255 // this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
12256 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
12257 isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
12258 return true;
12259 if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
12260 return true;
12261 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
12262 if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
12263 (CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12264 CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12265 return true;
Reid Spencere4d87aa2006-12-23 06:05:41 +000012266 if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
12267 if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
12268 (CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
12269 CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
12270 return true;
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012271
12272 return false;
12273}
12274
Chris Lattnerd2b7cec2007-02-14 05:52:17 +000012275/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
12276///
12277/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
12278/// elements in the input.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012279static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
12280 unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
12281 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12282 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
12283 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
12284 return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
12285
12286 std::vector<unsigned> Result;
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012287 const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012288 for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
12289 if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012290 Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
12291 else
Gabor Greif177dd3f2008-06-12 21:37:33 +000012292 Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012293 return Result;
12294}
12295
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012296/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
12297/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
12298/// extracted from the vector.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012299static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012300 LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012301 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
12302 const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012303 unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
12304 if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012305 return Context->getUndef(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012306
12307 if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012308 return Context->getUndef(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012309 else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012310 return Context->getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012311 else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012312 return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
12313 else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12314 // If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012315 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
12316 return 0;
12317 unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012318
12319 // If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
12320 // inserted value.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012321 if (EltNo == IIElt)
12322 return III->getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012323
12324 // Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
12325 // vector input.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012326 return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo, Context);
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012327 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012328 unsigned LHSWidth =
12329 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012330 unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012331 if (InEl < LHSWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012332 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl, Context);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012333 else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012334 return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth, Context);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012335 else
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012336 return Context->getUndef(PTy->getElementType());
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012337 }
12338
12339 // Otherwise, we don't know.
12340 return 0;
12341}
12342
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012343Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012344 // If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012345 if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012346 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Context->getUndef(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012347
Dan Gohman07a96762007-07-16 14:29:03 +000012348 // If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012349 if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012350 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Context->getNullValue(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner1f13c882006-03-31 18:25:14 +000012351
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012352 if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Matthijs Kooijmanb4d6a5a2008-06-11 09:00:12 +000012353 // If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
12354 // that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
12355 // (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012356 Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012357 for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012358 if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
12359 op0 = 0;
12360 break;
12361 }
12362 if (op0)
12363 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012364 }
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012365
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012366 // If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
12367 // find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012368 if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012369 unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012370 unsigned VectorWidth =
12371 cast<VectorType>(EI.getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012372
12373 // If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
12374 // crashing the code below.
12375 if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012376 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Context->getUndef(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattner85464092007-04-09 01:37:55 +000012377
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012378 // This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
12379 // If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
12380 // property.
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012381 if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012382 APInt UndefElts(VectorWidth, 0);
12383 APInt DemandedMask(VectorWidth, 1 << IndexVal);
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012384 if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012385 DemandedMask, UndefElts)) {
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012386 EI.setOperand(0, V);
12387 return &EI;
12388 }
12389 }
12390
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012391 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012392 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012393
12394 // If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
12395 // the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
12396 // it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
12397 if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
12398 if (const VectorType *VT =
12399 dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
12400 if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012401 if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0),
12402 IndexVal, Context))
Chris Lattnerb7300fa2007-04-14 23:02:14 +000012403 return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
12404 }
Chris Lattner389a6f52006-04-10 23:06:36 +000012405 }
Chris Lattner6e6b0da2006-03-31 23:01:56 +000012406
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012407 if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012408 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
12409 // Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
12410 // profitable to do so
12411 if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012412 bool isConstantElt = isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1));
12413 if (CheapToScalarize(BO, isConstantElt)) {
12414 ExtractElementInst *newEI0 =
12415 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
12416 EI.getName()+".lhs");
12417 ExtractElementInst *newEI1 =
12418 new ExtractElementInst(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
12419 EI.getName()+".rhs");
12420 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI0, EI);
12421 InsertNewInstBefore(newEI1, EI);
Gabor Greif7cbd8a32008-05-16 19:29:10 +000012422 return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
Chris Lattner220b0cf2006-03-05 00:22:33 +000012423 }
Reid Spencer3ed469c2006-11-02 20:25:50 +000012424 } else if (isa<LoadInst>(I)) {
Christopher Lamb43ad6b32007-12-17 01:12:55 +000012425 unsigned AS =
12426 cast<PointerType>(I->getOperand(0)->getType())->getAddressSpace();
Chris Lattner6d0339d2008-01-13 22:23:22 +000012427 Value *Ptr = InsertBitCastBefore(I->getOperand(0),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012428 Context->getPointerType(EI.getType(), AS),EI);
Gabor Greifb1dbcd82008-05-15 10:04:30 +000012429 GetElementPtrInst *GEP =
12430 GetElementPtrInst::Create(Ptr, EI.getOperand(1), I->getName()+".gep");
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012431 InsertNewInstBefore(GEP, EI);
12432 return new LoadInst(GEP);
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012433 }
12434 }
12435 if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
12436 // Extracting the inserted element?
12437 if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
12438 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
12439 // If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
12440 // be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
12441 if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) &&
12442 isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
12443 AddUsesToWorkList(EI);
12444 EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
12445 return &EI;
12446 }
12447 } else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
12448 // If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
12449 // it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012450 if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
12451 unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012452 Value *Src;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012453 unsigned LHSWidth =
12454 cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
12455
12456 if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012457 Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012458 else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
12459 SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012460 Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
12461 } else {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012462 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Context->getUndef(EI.getType()));
Chris Lattnerdf084ff2006-03-30 22:02:40 +000012463 }
Owen Anderson9adc0ab2009-07-14 23:09:55 +000012464 return new ExtractElementInst(Src,
12465 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, SrcIdx, false));
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012466 }
12467 }
Eli Friedman2451a642009-07-18 23:06:53 +000012468 // FIXME: Canonicalize extractelement(bitcast) -> bitcast(extractelement)
Chris Lattner73fa49d2006-05-25 22:53:38 +000012469 }
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012470 return 0;
12471}
12472
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012473/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
12474/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
12475/// Otherwise, return false.
12476static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012477 std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012478 LLVMContext *Context) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012479 assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
12480 "Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012481 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012482
12483 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012484 Mask.assign(NumElts, Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012485 return true;
12486 } else if (V == LHS) {
12487 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012488 Mask.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012489 return true;
12490 } else if (V == RHS) {
12491 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012492 Mask.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i+NumElts));
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012493 return true;
12494 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12495 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12496 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12497 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12498 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12499
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012500 if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
12501 return false;
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012502 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012503
12504 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
12505 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12506 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012507 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012508 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012509 Mask[InsertedIdx] = Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty);
Chris Lattnerd929f062006-04-27 21:14:21 +000012510 return true;
12511 }
12512 } else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
12513 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012514 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12515 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012516 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012517
12518 // This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
12519 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
12520 // Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
12521 // transitively ok.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012522 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask, Context)) {
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012523 // If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
12524 if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012525 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012526 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012527 } else {
12528 assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012529 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012530 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012531
12532 }
12533 return true;
12534 }
12535 }
12536 }
12537 }
12538 }
12539 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
12540
12541 return false;
12542}
12543
12544/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
12545/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
12546/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012547static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
Owen Anderson07cf79e2009-07-06 23:00:19 +000012548 Value *&RHS, LLVMContext *Context) {
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012549 assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012550 (RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012551 "Invalid shuffle!");
Reid Spencer9d6565a2007-02-15 02:26:10 +000012552 unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012553
12554 if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012555 Mask.assign(NumElts, Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012556 return V;
12557 } else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012558 Mask.assign(NumElts, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, 0));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012559 return V;
12560 } else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
12561 // If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
12562 Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
12563 Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
12564 Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
12565
12566 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12567 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12568 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
12569 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012570 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
12571 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012572
12573 // Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
12574 // otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012575 if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
12576 RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012577 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS, Context);
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012578 Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012579 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012580 return V;
12581 }
12582
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012583 if (VecOp == RHS) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012584 Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask,
12585 RHS, Context);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012586 // Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
12587 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
12588 if (i != InsertedIdx)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012589 Mask[i] = Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, NumElts+i);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012590 }
12591 return V;
12592 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012593
12594 // If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
12595 // vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012596 if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask,
12597 Context))
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012598 return EI->getOperand(0);
12599
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012600 }
12601 }
12602 }
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012603 // TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012604
12605 // Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
12606 for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012607 Mask.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, i));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012608 return V;
12609}
12610
12611Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
12612 Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
12613 Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
12614 Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
12615
Chris Lattner599ded12007-04-09 01:11:16 +000012616 // Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
12617 if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
12618 ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012619
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012620 // If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
12621 // indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
12622 if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
12623 if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
12624 EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
Eli Friedman76e7ba82009-07-18 19:04:16 +000012625 unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
Chris Lattnere34e9a22007-04-14 23:32:02 +000012626 unsigned ExtractedIdx =
12627 cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
Reid Spencerb83eb642006-10-20 07:07:24 +000012628 unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012629
12630 if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
12631 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12632
12633 if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012634 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, Context->getUndef(IE.getType()));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012635
12636 // If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
12637 // back into the same place, just use the input vector.
12638 if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
12639 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
12640
12641 // We could theoretically do this for ANY input. However, doing so could
12642 // turn chains of insertelement instructions into a chain of shufflevector
12643 // instructions, and right now we do not merge shufflevectors. As such,
12644 // only do this in a situation where it is clear that there is benefit.
12645 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp) || isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp)) {
12646 // Turn this into shuffle(EIOp0, VecOp, Mask). The result has all of
12647 // the values of VecOp, except then one read from EIOp0.
12648 // Build a new shuffle mask.
12649 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
12650 if (isa<UndefValue>(VecOp))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012651 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012652 else {
12653 assert(isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(VecOp) && "Unknown thing");
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012654 Mask.assign(NumVectorElts, Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty,
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012655 NumVectorElts));
12656 }
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012657 Mask[InsertedIdx] =
12658 Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, ExtractedIdx);
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012659 return new ShuffleVectorInst(EI->getOperand(0), VecOp,
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012660 Context->getConstantVector(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012661 }
12662
12663 // If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
12664 // (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
12665 if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
12666 std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012667 Value *RHS = 0;
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012668 Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS, Context);
12669 if (RHS == 0) RHS = Context->getUndef(LHS->getType());
Chris Lattner7f6cc0c2006-04-16 00:51:47 +000012670 // We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012671 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS,
12672 Context->getConstantVector(Mask));
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012673 }
12674 }
12675 }
12676
Eli Friedmanb9a4cac2009-06-06 20:08:03 +000012677 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(VecOp->getType())->getNumElements();
12678 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12679 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12680 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&IE, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts))
12681 return &IE;
12682
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012683 return 0;
12684}
12685
12686
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012687Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
12688 Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12689 Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012690 std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012691
12692 bool MadeChange = false;
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012693
Chris Lattner867b99f2006-10-05 06:55:50 +000012694 // Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012695 if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012696 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, Context->getUndef(SVI.getType()));
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012697
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012698 unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
Mon P Wangaeb06d22008-11-10 04:46:22 +000012699
12700 if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
12701 return 0;
12702
Evan Cheng388df622009-02-03 10:05:09 +000012703 APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
12704 APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
12705 if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012706 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12707 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Dan Gohman488fbfc2008-09-09 18:11:14 +000012708 MadeChange = true;
Dan Gohman3139ff82008-09-11 22:47:57 +000012709 }
Chris Lattnerefb47352006-04-15 01:39:45 +000012710
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012711 // Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
12712 // Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
12713 if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
12714 if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012715 // shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
12716 return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12717 }
12718
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012719 // Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
12720 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12721 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012722 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012723 Elts.push_back(Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012724 else {
12725 if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012726 (Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012727 Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012728 Elts.push_back(Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012729 } else {
Mon P Wang4f5ca2c2008-08-20 02:23:25 +000012730 Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012731 Elts.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, Mask[i]));
Dan Gohman4ce96272008-08-06 18:17:32 +000012732 }
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012733 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012734 }
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012735 SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012736 SVI.setOperand(1, Context->getUndef(RHS->getType()));
12737 SVI.setOperand(2, Context->getConstantVector(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012738 LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
12739 RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012740 MadeChange = true;
12741 }
12742
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012743 // Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012744 bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012745
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012746 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
12747 if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
12748 // Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
12749 isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
12750
12751 // Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
12752 isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
Chris Lattner706126d2006-04-16 00:03:56 +000012753 }
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012754
Chris Lattner863bcff2006-05-25 23:48:38 +000012755 // Eliminate identity shuffles.
12756 if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
12757 if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012758
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012759 // If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
12760 // one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
12761 // we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
12762 // program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
12763 // shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
12764 // we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
12765 // masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
12766 // which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
12767 // (splat(splat)) -> splat.
12768 if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
12769 if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
12770 std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
12771
12772 std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
12773 for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
12774 if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
12775 NewMask.push_back(2*e);
12776 else
12777 NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
12778
12779 // If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this shuffle mask, do
12780 // the replacement.
12781 if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012782 unsigned LHSInNElts =
12783 cast<VectorType>(LHSSVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012784 std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
12785 for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
Mon P Wangfe6d2cd2009-01-26 04:39:00 +000012786 if (NewMask[i] >= LHSInNElts*2) {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012787 Elts.push_back(Context->getUndef(Type::Int32Ty));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012788 } else {
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012789 Elts.push_back(Context->getConstantInt(Type::Int32Ty, NewMask[i]));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012790 }
12791 }
12792 return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
12793 LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012794 Context->getConstantVector(Elts));
Chris Lattner7b2e27922006-05-26 00:29:06 +000012795 }
12796 }
12797 }
Chris Lattnerc5eff442007-01-30 22:32:46 +000012798
Chris Lattnera844fc4c2006-04-10 22:45:52 +000012799 return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
12800}
12801
12802
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000012803
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012804
12805/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
12806/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
12807/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
12808/// end of its block.
12809static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
12810 assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
12811
Chris Lattner108e9022005-10-27 17:13:11 +000012812 // Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
Duncan Sands7af1c782009-05-06 06:49:50 +000012813 if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayHaveSideEffects() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
Chris Lattnerbfc538c2008-05-09 15:07:33 +000012814 return false;
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000012815
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012816 // Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
Dan Gohmanecb7a772007-03-22 16:38:57 +000012817 if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
12818 &DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012819 return false;
12820
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012821 // We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
12822 // the end of block that could change the value.
Chris Lattner2539e332008-05-08 17:37:37 +000012823 if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
12824 for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012825 Scan != E; ++Scan)
12826 if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
12827 return false;
Chris Lattner96a52a62004-12-09 07:14:34 +000012828 }
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012829
Dan Gohman02dea8b2008-05-23 21:05:58 +000012830 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012831
Dale Johannesenbd8e6502009-03-03 01:09:07 +000012832 CopyPrecedingStopPoint(I, InsertPos);
Chris Lattner4bc5f802005-08-08 19:11:57 +000012833 I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000012834 ++NumSunkInst;
12835 return true;
12836}
12837
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012838
12839/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
12840/// all reachable code to the worklist.
12841///
12842/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
12843/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
12844/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
12845/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
12846/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
12847///
12848static void AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012849 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012850 InstCombiner &IC,
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012851 const TargetData *TD) {
Chris Lattner2806dff2008-08-15 04:03:01 +000012852 SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012853 Worklist.push_back(BB);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012854
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012855 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12856 BB = Worklist.back();
12857 Worklist.pop_back();
12858
12859 // We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
12860 if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012861
12862 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Prev = NULL;
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012863 for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
12864 Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012865
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012866 // DCE instruction if trivially dead.
12867 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
12868 ++NumDeadInst;
12869 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst;
12870 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12871 continue;
12872 }
12873
12874 // ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012875 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, BB->getContext(), TD)) {
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012876 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *Inst;
12877 Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
12878 ++NumConstProp;
12879 Inst->eraseFromParent();
12880 continue;
12881 }
Chris Lattner3ccc6bc2007-07-20 22:06:41 +000012882
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012883 // If there are two consecutive llvm.dbg.stoppoint calls then
12884 // it is likely that the optimizer deleted code in between these
12885 // two intrinsics.
12886 DbgInfoIntrinsic *DBI_Next = dyn_cast<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(Inst);
12887 if (DBI_Next) {
12888 if (DBI_Prev
12889 && DBI_Prev->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint
12890 && DBI_Next->getIntrinsicID() == llvm::Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint) {
12891 IC.RemoveFromWorkList(DBI_Prev);
12892 DBI_Prev->eraseFromParent();
12893 }
12894 DBI_Prev = DBI_Next;
Zhou Sheng8313ef42009-02-23 10:14:11 +000012895 } else {
12896 DBI_Prev = 0;
Devang Patel7fe1dec2008-11-19 18:56:50 +000012897 }
12898
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012899 IC.AddToWorkList(Inst);
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012900 }
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012901
12902 // Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
12903 // constant, only visit the reachable successor.
12904 TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
12905 if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
12906 if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
12907 bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012908 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012909 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012910 continue;
12911 }
12912 } else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
12913 if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
12914 // See if this is an explicit destination.
12915 for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12916 if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
Nick Lewycky91436992008-03-09 08:50:23 +000012917 BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
Nick Lewycky280a6e62008-04-25 16:53:59 +000012918 Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
Chris Lattner2c7718a2007-03-23 19:17:18 +000012919 continue;
12920 }
12921
12922 // Otherwise it is the default destination.
12923 Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
12924 continue;
12925 }
12926 }
12927
12928 for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
12929 Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012930 }
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012931}
12932
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012933bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000012934 bool Changed = false;
Dan Gohmance9fe9f2009-07-21 23:21:54 +000012935 TD = getAnalysisIfAvailable<TargetData>();
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000012936
12937 DEBUG(DOUT << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
12938 << F.getNameStr() << "\n");
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012939
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012940 {
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012941 // Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
12942 // the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
12943 // track of which blocks we visit.
Chris Lattner1f87a582007-02-15 19:41:52 +000012944 SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012945 AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
Jeff Cohen00b168892005-07-27 06:12:32 +000012946
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012947 // Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
12948 // unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
12949 // the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
12950 for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
12951 if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
12952 Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
12953 while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
12954 BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
Chris Lattner6ffe5512004-04-27 15:13:33 +000012955
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012956 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Dale Johannesenff278b12009-03-10 21:19:49 +000012957 // A debug intrinsic shouldn't force another iteration if we weren't
12958 // going to do one without it.
12959 if (!isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(I)) {
12960 ++NumDeadInst;
12961 Changed = true;
12962 }
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012963 if (!I->use_empty())
Owen Andersond672ecb2009-07-03 00:17:18 +000012964 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Context->getUndef(I->getType()));
Chris Lattnerb3d59702005-07-07 20:40:38 +000012965 I->eraseFromParent();
12966 }
12967 }
12968 }
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012969
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012970 while (!Worklist.empty()) {
12971 Instruction *I = RemoveOneFromWorkList();
12972 if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000012973
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012974 // Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012975 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012976 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012977 if (I->getNumOperands() < 4)
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012978 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012979 ++NumDeadInst;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012980
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012981 DOUT << "IC: DCE: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012982
12983 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012984 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000012985 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000012986 continue;
12987 }
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012988
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012989 // Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000012990 if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, F.getContext(), TD)) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000012991 DOUT << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I;
Chris Lattnerad5fec12005-01-28 19:32:01 +000012992
Chris Lattner8c8c66a2006-05-11 17:11:52 +000012993 // Add operands to the worklist.
Chris Lattner7bcc0e72004-02-28 05:22:00 +000012994 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattnerc736d562002-12-05 22:41:53 +000012995 ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
12996
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000012997 ++NumConstProp;
Chris Lattnerf4f5a772006-05-10 19:00:36 +000012998 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000012999 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000013000 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013001 continue;
Chris Lattner62b14df2002-09-02 04:59:56 +000013002 }
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013003
Eli Friedmanfd2934f2009-07-15 22:13:34 +000013004 if (TD) {
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000013005 // See if we can constant fold its operands.
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000013006 for (User::op_iterator i = I->op_begin(), e = I->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
13007 if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i))
Owen Anderson50895512009-07-06 18:42:36 +000013008 if (Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE,
13009 F.getContext(), TD))
Chris Lattner1e19d602009-01-31 07:04:22 +000013010 if (NewC != CE) {
13011 i->set(NewC);
13012 Changed = true;
13013 }
Nick Lewycky3dfd7bf2008-05-25 20:56:15 +000013014 }
13015
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013016 // See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
Dan Gohmanfc74abf2008-07-23 00:34:11 +000013017 if (I->hasOneUse()) {
Chris Lattnerea1c4542004-12-08 23:43:58 +000013018 BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
13019 BasicBlock *UserParent = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back())->getParent();
13020 if (UserParent != BB) {
13021 bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
13022 // See if the user is one of our successors.
13023 for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
13024 if (*SI == UserParent) {
13025 UserIsSuccessor = true;
13026 break;
13027 }
13028
13029 // If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
13030 // only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
13031 // otherwise), we can keep going.
13032 if (UserIsSuccessor && !isa<PHINode>(I->use_back()) &&
13033 next(pred_begin(UserParent)) == pred_end(UserParent))
13034 // Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
13035 Changed |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
13036 }
13037 }
13038
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013039 // Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it...
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000013040#ifndef NDEBUG
13041 std::string OrigI;
13042#endif
13043 DEBUG(std::ostringstream SS; I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013044 if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
Chris Lattner3dec1f22002-05-10 15:38:35 +000013045 ++NumCombined;
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013046 // Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000013047 if (Result != I) {
Bill Wendlingb7427032006-11-26 09:46:52 +000013048 DOUT << "IC: Old = " << *I
13049 << " New = " << *Result;
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000013050
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013051 // Everything uses the new instruction now.
13052 I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
13053
13054 // Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013055 AddToWorkList(Result);
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013056 AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013057
Chris Lattner6934a042007-02-11 01:23:03 +000013058 // Move the name to the new instruction first.
13059 Result->takeName(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013060
13061 // Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
13062 BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
Chris Lattnerbac32862004-11-14 19:13:23 +000013063 BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
13064
13065 if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
13066 while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
13067 ++InsertPos;
13068
13069 InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013070
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000013071 // Make sure that we reprocess all operands now that we reduced their
13072 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013073 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner216d4d82004-05-01 23:19:52 +000013074
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013075 // Instructions can end up on the worklist more than once. Make sure
13076 // we do not process an instruction that has been deleted.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013077 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner4bb7c022003-10-06 17:11:01 +000013078
13079 // Erase the old instruction.
13080 InstParent->getInstList().erase(I);
Chris Lattner7e708292002-06-25 16:13:24 +000013081 } else {
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000013082#ifndef NDEBUG
Reid Spencera9b81012007-03-26 17:44:01 +000013083 DOUT << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI
13084 << " New = " << *I;
Evan Chengc7baf682007-03-27 16:44:48 +000013085#endif
Chris Lattner0cea42a2004-03-13 23:54:27 +000013086
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013087 // If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
13088 // if so, remove it.
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000013089 if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
13090 // Make sure we process all operands now that we are reducing their
13091 // use counts.
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013092 AddUsesToWorkList(*I);
Misha Brukmanfd939082005-04-21 23:48:37 +000013093
Chris Lattner00d51312004-05-01 23:27:23 +000013094 // Instructions may end up in the worklist more than once. Erase all
Robert Bocchino1d7456d2006-01-13 22:48:06 +000013095 // occurrences of this instruction.
Chris Lattnerdbab3862007-03-02 21:28:56 +000013096 RemoveFromWorkList(I);
Chris Lattner2f503e62005-01-31 05:36:43 +000013097 I->eraseFromParent();
Chris Lattnerf523d062004-06-09 05:08:07 +000013098 } else {
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013099 AddToWorkList(I);
13100 AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
Chris Lattner90ac28c2002-08-02 19:29:35 +000013101 }
Chris Lattnerb3bc8fa2002-05-14 15:24:07 +000013102 }
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013103 Changed = true;
Chris Lattner8a2a3112001-12-14 16:52:21 +000013104 }
13105 }
13106
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013107 assert(WorklistMap.empty() && "Worklist empty, but map not?");
Chris Lattnera9ff5eb2007-08-05 08:47:58 +000013108
13109 // Do an explicit clear, this shrinks the map if needed.
13110 WorklistMap.clear();
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013111 return Changed;
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000013112}
13113
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013114
13115bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000013116 MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
Owen Andersone922c022009-07-22 00:24:57 +000013117 Context = &F.getContext();
Chris Lattnerf964f322007-03-04 04:27:24 +000013118
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013119 bool EverMadeChange = false;
13120
13121 // Iterate while there is work to do.
13122 unsigned Iteration = 0;
Bill Wendlinga6c31122008-05-14 22:45:20 +000013123 while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
Chris Lattnerec9c3582007-03-03 02:04:50 +000013124 EverMadeChange = true;
13125 return EverMadeChange;
13126}
13127
Brian Gaeke96d4bf72004-07-27 17:43:21 +000013128FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
Chris Lattnerdd841ae2002-04-18 17:39:14 +000013129 return new InstCombiner();
Chris Lattnerbd0ef772002-02-26 21:46:54 +000013130}